Yeoman Basic - NAVY BMR material/NAVEDTRA 14261.pdf · i PREFACE By enrolling in this self-study...
Transcript of Yeoman Basic - NAVY BMR material/NAVEDTRA 14261.pdf · i PREFACE By enrolling in this self-study...
DISTRIBUTION STATEMENT A: Approved for public release; distribution is unlimited.
NONRESIDENTTRAININGCOURSEDecember 2001
Yeoman BasicNAVEDTRA 14261A
Notice: NETPDTC is no longer responsible for the content accuracy of the NRTCs. For content issues, contact the servicing Center of Excellence: Center for Service Support (CSS Athens); (706) 355-7501, Ext. 7642 or DSN: 354-7501, Ext. 7642
DISTRIBUTION STATEMENT A: Approved for public release; distribution is unlimited.
Although the words “he,” “him,” and “his” are used sparingly in this course to enhance communication, they are not intended to be gender driven or to affront or discriminate against anyone.
i
PREFACEBy enrolling in this self-study course, you have demonstrated a desire to improve yourself and the Navy.Remember, however, this self-study course is only one part of the total Navy training program. Practicalexperience, schools, selected reading, and your desire to succeed are also necessary to successfully roundout a fully meaningful training program.
COURSE OVERVIEW : In completing this nonresident training course, you will demonstrate aknowledge of the subject matter by correctly answering questions on the following: the Navy Yeoman,official publications and directives, correspondence/message system, processing correspondence/messages,correspondence/message files and disposal, directives issuance system, reports and forms managementprograms, security, legal, awards, officer distribution control report (ODCR), officer service records, travel,leave procedures, pay and allowances, and technical administration.
THE COURSE: This self-study course is organized into subject matter areas, each containing learningobjectives to help you determine what you should learn along with text and illustrations to help youunderstand the information. The subject matter reflects day-to-day requirements and experiences ofpersonnel in the rating or skill area. It also reflects guidance provided by Enlisted Community Managers(ECMs) and other senior personnel, technical references, instructions, etc., and either the occupational ornaval standards, which are listed in the Manual of Navy Enlisted Manpower Personnel Classificationsand Occupational Standards, NAVPERS 18068.
THE QUESTIONS : The questions that appear in this course are designed to help you understand thematerial in the text.
VALUE : In completing this course, you will improve your military and professional knowledge.Importantly, it can also help you study for the Navy-wide advancement in rate examination. If you arestudying and discover a reference in the text to another publication for further information, look it up.
2001 Edition Prepared byYNC(SW) Ebonnee E. Dinkins
NAVSUP Logistics Tracking Number0504-LP-100-7213
ii
Sailor’s Creed
“I am a United States Sailor.
I will support and defend the Constitution of the United States of America and I will obey the orders of those appointed over me.
I represent the fighting spirit of the Navy and those who have gone before me to defend freedom and democracy around the world.
I proudly serve my country’s Navy combat team with honor, courage and commitment.
I am committed to excellence and the fair treatment of all.”
iii
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER PAGE
1. The Navy Yeoman ................................................................................................. 1-1
2. Official Publications and Directives ...................................................................... 2-1
3. Correspondence/Message System.......................................................................... 3-1
4. Processing Correspondence/Messages................................................................... 4-1
5. Correspondence/Message Files and Disposal ........................................................ 5-1
6. Directives Issuance System.................................................................................... 6-1
7. Reports and Forms Management Programs ........................................................... 7-1
8. Security .................................................................................................................. 8-1
9. Legal....................................................................................................................... 9-1
10. Awards ................................................................................................................... 10-1
11. Officer Distribution Control Report (ODCR) ........................................................ 11-1
12. Officer Service Records ......................................................................................... 12-1
13. Travel, Leave Procedures, and Pay and Allowances.............................................. 13-1
14. Technical Administration....................................................................................... 14-1
APPENDIX
I. Glossary ................................................................................................................. AI-1
II. References Used to Develop the NRTC................................................................. AII-1
iv
INSTRUCTIONS FOR TAKING THE COURSE
ASSIGNMENTS
The text pages that you are to study are listed atthe beginning of each assignment. Study thesepages carefully before attempting to answer thequestions. Pay close attention to tables andillustrations and read the learning objectives.The learning objectives state what you should beable to do after studying the material. Answeringthe questions correctly helps you accomplish theobjectives.
SELECTING YOUR ANSWERS
Read each question carefully, then select theBEST answer. You may refer freely to the text.The answers must be the result of your ownwork and decisions. You are prohibited fromreferring to or copying the answers of others andfrom giving answers to anyone else taking thecourse.
SUBMITTING YOUR ASSIGNMENTS
To have your assignments graded, you must beenrolled in the course with the NonresidentTraining Course Administration Branch at theNaval Education and Training ProfessionalDevelopment and Technology Center(NETPDTC). Following enrollment, there aretwo ways of having your assignments graded:(1) use the Internet to submit your assignmentsas you complete them, or (2) send all theassignments at one time by mail to NETPDTC.
Grading on the Internet: Advantages toInternet grading are:
you may submit your answers as soon asyou complete an assignment, andyou get your results faster; usually by thenext working day (approximately 24 hours).
In addition to receiving grade results for eachassignment, you will receive course completionconfirmation once you have completed all the
assignments. To submit your assignmentanswers via the Internet, go to:
https://courses.cnet.navy.mil
COMPLETION TIME
Courses must be completed within 12 monthsfrom the date of enrollment. This includes timerequired to resubmit failed assignments.
v
PASS/FAIL ASSIGNMENT PROCEDURES
If your overall course score is 3.2 or higher, youwill pass the course and will not be required toresubmit assignments. Once your assignmentshave been graded you will receive coursecompletion confirmation.
If you receive less than a 3.2 on any assignmentand your overall course score is below 3.2, youwill be given the opportunity to resubmit failedassignments. You may resubmit failedassignments only once. Internet students willreceive notification when they have failed anassignment--they may then resubmit failedassignments on the web site. Internet studentsmay view and print results for failedassignments from the web site. Students whosubmit by mail will receive a failing result letterand a new answer sheet for resubmission of eachfailed assignment.
COMPLETION CONFIRMATION
After successfully completing this course, youwill receive a letter of completion.
STUDENT FEEDBACK QUESTIONS
We value your suggestions, questions, andcriticisms on our courses. If you would like tocommunicate with us regarding this course, weencourage you, if possible, to use e-mail. If youwrite or fax, please use a copy of the StudentComment form that follows this page.
NAVAL RESERVE RETIREMENT CREDIT
If you are a member of the Naval Reserve, youmay earn retirement points for successfullycompleting this course, if authorized undercurrent directives governing retirement of NavalReserve personnel. For Naval Reserveretirement, this course is evaluated at 8 points.(Refer to Administrative Procedures for NavalReservists on Inactive Duty, BUPERSINST1001.39, for more information about retirementpoints.)
vii
Student Comments
Course Title: Yeoman Basic
NAVEDTRA: 14261A Date:
We need some information about you:
Rate/Rank and Name: SSN: Command/Unit
Street Address: City: State/FPO: Zip
Your comments, suggestions, etc.:
Privacy Act Statement: Under authority of Title 5, USC 301, information regarding your military status is
requested in processing your comments and in preparing a reply. This information will not be divulged without
written authorization to anyone other than those within DOD for official use in determining performance.
NETPDTC 1550/41 (Rev 4-00)
CHAPTER 1
THE NAVY YEOMAN
Whether you have made the decision to strike for
Yeoman (YN) or want more knowledge to perform
your administrative duties better, this nonresident
training course (NRTC) is designed to help.
Information from people surveyed throughout the
Navy is used to set minimum standards of knowledge
and skill needed to perform in each rating and
paygrade. These are the Navy occupational standards
(OCCSTDs). This NRTC is written to provide the
knowledge needed to perform as a YN third or second
class in a way that will encourage learning and provide
a solid base from which you can grow professionally.
Review the OCCSTDs to get an idea of what this
NRTC will teach you. Keeping them in mind as the
course progresses will help you understand why
information is included and where the information will
lead you.
The word Yeoman has several definitions, but the
best for our purposes is “an administrative assistant.”
Nearly every office in every command in the Navy will
have a YN assigned. Ever since the day it was decided
help was needed to keep things in order, YNs have
existed. Duties have changed and branched out to
other specialties, such as supply and pay, but the YN
remains as a key person to organize and maintain
communications for the department or division where
assigned. The better you do your job, the better the
whole organization will run.
To function well as a YN, you must understand
how the Navy is organized and how each area functions
and interacts with every other area. This goes along
with the ability to administer and organize yourself,
your job , your office , and, eventual ly, the
administrative functions of an entire command. The
knowledge you need to support this ability increases
all the time. There are always changes and
improvements to keep track of. The better you do that,
the more effective you will be.
Your advancement to petty officer depends, in part,
on your ability to take on the role of leader as well as to
show specific knowledge of your job. You will be
responsible to senior personnel for your own actions
as well as the actions of those who work for you. The
best way to meet this responsibility is to learn all you
can, teach others, and set the example to be followed.
Don’t forget, though, that you are a member of the
armed forces. We are responsible to a much greater
goal––the safety of our country and way of life. As
such, we are sometimes called upon to fight for that
security. As a YN aboard ship, you will be assigned to
a general quarters station that will in some way be
connected with maintaining communications during
battle––as a phone-talker on the bridge, a messenger
for a damage-control party, or maybe a status board
writer in the combat information center (CIC).
Remember the word communicate. Traditionally, and
in fact, YNs are considered to be experts in
communicating. We “pass the word” and through that
act affect every aspect of naval life and operations. It’s
an important responsibility.
OCCUPATIONAL AREAS
As said before, YNs can be assigned to a large
number of different offices. Despite the various areas
each office oversees, administrative procedures are
fairly constant. With a basic understanding of these
procedures, you will fit easily into the routine of any
office.
THE CAPTAIN’S OFFICE
Aboard ship one of the most important work areas
for the YN is the captain’s office. Here, working under
the ship’s secretary, YNs control incoming and
outgoing mail, maintain career-related documents of
the ship’s officers, perform legal and disciplinary
actions, and maintain the ship’s master instructions
and notices. The size of the ship determines the size
and manning of the office. On larger ships, such as
aircraft carriers, responsibility is split between other
offices employing several YNs. There could be a
separate legal/discipline office and possibly a separate
office for classified material processing. On smaller
vessels, there may be only one or two YNs in one office
to do it all. Fortunately, the workload is smaller, even
though the tasks are the same.
1-1
THE SHIP’S OFFICE
Ships generate a great deal of internal paper work
and reports. To deal with this, the executive officer
(XO) maintains the ship’s office. The XO keeps track
of reports, personnel functions, special services, and so
on, and filters information to the commanding officer
(CO). Generally, Personnelmen (PNs) are assigned to
the ship’s office, but on larger ships YNs may be
assigned to handle the administrative workload.
OTHER OFFICES
Overall, though, central administrative offices are
in the minority. Most offices are at the departmental
and divisional level, such as the engineering logroom,
the weapons office, and the operations office. Here
you would be concentrating on correspondence,
reports (muster reports, custody reports, and so on),
helping with requisit ioning, and, of course,
maintaining the files and records of the division or
department. The thing to keep in mind is, while the
area of concern may be specia l ized , your
administrative skills and knowledge will be the same.
OFFICE APPEARANCE AND
ARRANGEMENT
The amount of control you will have over the
physical conditions in your office will vary with the
location and the type of duty to which you are assigned.
Aboard ship and ashore, conditions outside your
control may determine the kind of office and
equipment you will have. Regardless of the
conditions, however, you will be expected to take your
share of the responsibility for the general appearance
and neatness of your office. We will discuss more
about the appearance of your office in the next
paragraph and in the section pertaining to customer
service. We want to point out your responsibilities for
your office and how you should perform these duties as
a routine part of your job––and not wait to be asked to
perform them. Take the initiative yourself and carry
out these duties.
NEATNESS AND CLEANLINESS
The general appearance of an office can be greatly
affected by a simple practice such as putting things
away from day to day. It will be one of your
responsibilities to see that articles used during the day
are put back where they belong. In securing your ship’s
admin office for the night, you should properly secure
and stow all gear and supplies to prevent damage to
equipment or injuries to personnel from flying objects
if your ship should encounter heavy weather. If you are
serving ashore, it is no different––you should still put
away articles and clean up your work area before you
secure for the day.
Whether your office is ashore or afloat, you should
go through your correspondence basket daily to see
that work does not pile up. When you handle classified
documents, be especially careful. After using
classified documents, make sure you store them
according to the guidelines set forth in the Department
of the Navy Personnel Security Program Regulation,
OPNAVINST 5510.30 series.
Make sure all supplies, such as ink and correction
fluid that may stain other materials, are put away
properly. Do not leave any equipment on the deck that
might be damaged when the office is cleaned. Avoid
accumulations of loose papers or other objects that
may create a fire hazard. Desks should be dusted
frequently. Do not allow dirt to build up until field day.
In putting away things others have been using or in
dusting someone else’s desk, use care and good
judgment so that you do not lose or misplace anything.
Do not disturb the arrangements they have made of
their papers.
ARRANGING YOUR DESK
Your own desk is one item for which you are
always responsible. Arrange it in a manner that is neat
and organized. Set the example for those individuals
who are less organized than yourself.
The following suggested plan is suitable if you
spend most of your time typing letters or other
correspondence and forms. Your work may require
that you provide space for other types of supplies, but
the general principle will still apply.
• Keep pencils, erasers, paper clips, and other
small articles in shallow drawers or trays.
• Insert slanted stationery trays in one of the upper
drawers. Use a separate tray for each type of
stationery or form. Place the most frequently
used stationery or forms at the front, with the
additional trays similarly containing forms
according to frequency of usage.
• Keep carbon paper in its box to keep it from
curling or from soiling the stationery.
1-2
• If you keep any personal belongings such as
clothes in your desk, place them in a drawer
away from public view.
• At the end of the day, clear everything possible
from the top of your desk. You should straighten
any articles that remain on top of your desk and
close all drawers. Make sure all classified or
sensitive material is properly stored.
OFFICE ARRANGEMENT
If you have an opportunity to arrange the furniture
in your office, do some advance thinking and planning
before you start moving it. You should place desks so
that those who work at them will have enough light
without having to face the light. Avoid arranging desks
so that anyone’s back is to the reception area. Everyone
in the office should be in a position to see and assist
customers. Also make sure there is enough working
space for your office coworkers to move around.
Chairs should be adjusted so that typists’ feet rest
firmly on the floor and chair seats are at least 12 inches
below the base of the typewriters or computer
keyboards. Think of the work that has to go on
regularly and place equipment where it can be used
most conveniently and where work will flow in one
direction rather than in a crisscross manner.
You should place tables or counters conveniently
for handling supplies or assembling papers. You
should place files where they are handy for those who
use them.
SKILLS AND KNOWLEDGE
So far we have talked about what a YN is. But what
do you need to know? The rest of this NRTC will
provide information to teach you what is needed to
function as a YN third and second class petty officer.
TYPING
Typing is, of course, an absolutely necessary skill,
and it cannot be learned simply by using a book. To
qualify for YN3, you must pass a performance test by
typing 30 words per minute and for YN2, you must
type 40 words per minute. There are specialized typing
textbooks available if you need to improve your typing
skills. You should look for opportunities to practice in
one of your command’s offices. By showing a genuine
desire to learn, you will get encouragement from the
senior YNs in your command.
OFFICE MACHINERY
You will need to know how to operate the
laborsaving devices available in offices today. These
are typewriters, copying machines, computers,
scanners, and communications systems (such as fax
machines). All are being influenced by technological
improvements, but basic procedures remain very much
the same.
FILING
The Navy has a filing system based on standard
number codes and standard procedures. The Navy is
big, but if you learn the standard filing system, you will
be able to function at any duty station anywhere with
only a little orientation in local practices.
CORRESPONDENCE
As with filing, the same standardization applies to
correspondence. Standard procedures keep
information flowing effectively. You will learn the
standard letter format, the business letter format,
messages, memorandum formats, and variations. You
will also learn to identify the proper circumstances for
using the different types of correspondence.
LANGUAGE SKILLS
It cannot be repeated too often: YNs are
communicators. Your language skills must be sharp.
Your verbal and writing skills must be above average.
YNs are expected to keep an eye on what they are doing
(remember, attention to detail). If you are typing and
find a grammar or spelling error or a format problem,
you should tactfully point it out to the author and be
ready to offer a substitute or correction.
FORMS
As in most large and diverse organizations, the
Navy seems to have a form for everything. This is one
of the prices of standardization. While there may be a
large number of forms, you will find that once you have
been introduced to them, how they are identified, and
what they accomplish, it is fairly easy to keep them
straight in your mind and know when they are needed.
PUBLICATIONS AND DIRECTIVES
There is a “trick to the trade” that all good YNs
understand. A great deal of information can be stored
1-3
in your memory, but it is impossible to know
everything. The trick is to know where to find
pertinent information. Once you become familiar with
the Navy’s publications and directives system, you will
have all the answers available to you.
LEGAL
While all personnel are made aware of the Uniform
Code of Military Justice (UCMJ) and legal and
disciplinary procedures that affect them, you will get a
much more detailed look at the paper work and
processing involved in nonjudicial punishment (NJP)
and other legal functions. Most commands are not
large enough to have Legalmen (LNs) assigned, which
puts the responsibility for complete and accurate
records on the YNs assigned.
CAREER OPPORTUNITIES
As your career progresses there wil l be
opportunities for specialization or career change.
Navy Enlisted Classifications (NECs) and schools will
be available to you during your career as a YN.
NAVY ENLISTED CLASSIFICATIONS
The NEC coding system identifies special
qualifications based on an individual’s education
and/or experience. As a YN, you can qualify for one
NEC: YN-2514, Flag Officer Writer. The flag officer
writer NEC is given after completion of YN “C”
school, which trains you to work on flag officers’
personal staffs.
LEGALMAN
One career change that may be of interest later on
is becoming an LN. Entry into that rating is at the E-4
through E-6 level after successful completion of the
Naval Justice School. Conversion may be authorized
for E-3s fully eligible for E-4; however, conversion is
not effective until after successful completion of the
Naval Justice School and an advancement-in-rate
examination. LNs are assigned to naval legal service
offices, on larger ships, and at most major shore
commands.
SCHOOLS
The key to classification is training and schools.
Information on qualifications can be found in section II
of the Navy Enlisted Manpower and Personnel
Classification and Occupational Standards Manual.
Information on schools may be found in the Catalog of
Navy Training Courses (CANTRAC).
PERSONAL QUALITIES
Do you know what is expected of you personally as
a YN? You need more than technical knowledge.
There are personal qualities with which you must be
concerned. In almost any job you are assigned to, you
will meet other people, in person or on the phone. Part
of your responsibilities will be to provide them with
whatever help you can. You may be in a customer-
service position as a receptionist for a command with
many offices and functions. You will be expected to
handle questions or refer them to the proper authority.
You will be presenting the first impression of your
place of work and influencing other people’s attitudes
in dealing with your command.
VOICE
The most important personal quality is your voice.
Whether in person or on the phone, it is your primary
means of communication––and always remember that
YNs are communicators. Clear and concise speech
habits accomplish more than you sometimes think.
Unfortunately, proof of this is found through the use of
bad speech habits. More problems are caused by
unconcern for how we say things. Have you ever called
somewhere and heard, “Goodmorningsirormaam.
OpsofficeYNFrostspeaking thisisnotasecureline.
CanIhelpyousirormaam?” This is delivered while
holding the phone with the shoulder, inserting paper
into a typewriter, and listening to the supervisor read
the plan of the day. All the necessary information has
been given––but no one can understand it. Other
problems that make conversations one-sided are
volume (mumbling or talking too loud), lack of
emphasis (you can use your voice to make a point by
stressing important information), or a high-pitched,
shrill voice. Also, learn to pronounce your words
correctly. Local dialects can be confusing. Listen to
others and use a dictionary to make sure you are saying
words correctly.
APPEARANCE
Appearance goes hand in hand with your speaking
skills. As a point of contact in your office, other people
will come to you for information or answers. Your
credibility will be greatly strengthened if you look
clean-cut and squared away. People will anticipate
1-4
competence from you and will be ready to listen to
what you have to say.
ATTITUDE AND PERSONALITY
Your attitude toward your work goes far in making
you a truly professional YN, and it will have an effect
on those with whom you interact. Since attitude is a
frame of mind, it shows itself in different ways. Your
personality itself will generally determine your overall
attitude. By looking forward to working and dealing
with other people, you will have that positive attitude
others will notice. Likewise, if you are not happy with
yourself or your position, you can be sure it shows also.
Being a service member, your military bearing and
attitude will be used as an indicator of what kind of
worker you are.
A large part of military bearing comes from
common courtesy in addition to the military courtesies
and customs observed by fellow Navy members.
Always put yourself in the shoes of the persons you are
dealing with. Help them as you would like to be helped
and, in turn, they will respond to you positively.
How you perform in the office is another part of
how you will be judged. Always think about the job
you are doing: Are you doing it right? Can it be done
better or more efficiently? Paying attention to details
will ensure a job is done right. There are always
different circumstances influencing even the most
routine task. You should always keep yourself
thinking ahead, checking for the right answer to make
sure you are right.
One trait that is looked for, required, and even
demanded of a YN is honesty. You will be working in
offices with sensitive and/or classified material. The
officers you work for will put you in positions of trust.
The information that you see, hear, or handle must not
be discussed outside the office. It may be tempting to
“show off” a bit to your friends about what you know
that they don’t know––but don’t let that happen. Your
personal integrity is one of the most important parts of
being successful in your career, and it is very much a
concern of those you work for. The records you keep
affect others’ careers, their lives after the Navy, and
become a part of the Navy’s history. You must reject
any attempts to falsify or change these records. You
may be asked by a friend or offered bribes to do this.
The answer is always no! No matter how small the act,
you will be letting down your shipmates and the Navy
and leaving yourself open to legal prosecution.
CUSTOMER SERVICE: THE ART OF
DEALING WITH PEOPLE
As a YN, almost everything you do will involve
dealing with people. In this section we will tell you
about the importance of providing good customer
service to all individuals regardless of their status. We
will describe what can happen whenever you provide
good (or bad) customer service and the effects you will
have on the image of your office, your rating, your
command, and the Navy as a whole. As a YN, you are
one of the most important customer-service
representatives in the Navy. We will tell you about
some of the ways in which you, the YN, can improve
the customer-service environment of your office so
that your office can effectively provide the type of
customer-service Navy personnel need and deserve.
We will talk about your role as a customer service
representative and the ways in which your attitude,
personal appearance, and pride in your job and
yourself play a big part in providing good customer
service. We will also tell you about some of the pitfalls
you must avoid so you can provide the type of service
that your customers need and deserve.
EFFECTS OF FACE-TO-FACE CONTACT
As a customer, have you ever waited in line only to
be told when you finally reach the window, “Come
back tomorrow. The person who takes care of that is
not here today”? Have you ever tried to get a question
answered and had the feeling that the person to whom
you were talking resented being bothered? Have you
ever walked into an office and waited and waited for
service? Did you feel as though office personnel who
were just standing around were ignoring you? Did you
notice that some of them realized that you were
standing there waiting for service, but just looked the
other way? Most importantly, have you ever acted
toward a customer in an inappropriate manner, a
manner that is not consistent with your professional
responsibilities as a YN?
As you think about these questions, are you
convinced that there were some good reasons (not
excuses) for these situations to happen? The Chief of
Naval Operations will not be convinced, and a great
many other individuals in the Navy, both juniors and
seniors alike, won’t be convinced either..
Only a wishful dreamer would expect all Navy
members to be 100 percent dedicated to their work, but
only a confirmed pessimist would declare that the
Navy is as good as it will ever be. There must be a point
1-5
between these two extremes at which the problems and
requests of naval personnel, their dependents, and of
Navy employees can be and should be handled
correctly, promptly, and courteously––a point at which
members will be satisfied with the service they receive
without reducing the efficiency of those providing the
service.
Providing excellent customer service is the
responsibility of everyone in the Navy. A few of the
Navy’s ratings, however, are involved primarily with
providing services directly to personnel. These ratings
include DK, DT, HM, LI, LN, MS, NC, PC, PN, RP,
SH, SK, and YN. Although this chapter is intended for
you, the YN, personnel in other ratings who are reading
this NRTC can apply the same principles of providing
good customer service while performing their jobs.
Think back to some recent contact you have had
with one or more of the personnel service ratings. How
would you rate the service you received? You are a
member of one of these ratings. How do you think your
service as a YN would be rated by those you have
served?
Now, carry this one more step. What effect did this
good or bad service from other people have on you?
How would you respond to courteous treatment and
efficient action as opposed to a “don’t-care” attitude?
YOUR ROLE IN THE ADMIN OFFICE
A customer seeking assistance in the admin office
can still be given good service even though it may be
impossible for you to provide the desired results.
People may ask for things or services to which they are
not entitled or which you may not be authorized to
approve or grant. In these cases, providing good
customer service refers to the quality of service you
can provide rather than whether or not you are able to
comply with all the person’s wishes. When a person
seeks assistance in the admin office and you do not
provide it or you give the person the “runaround,” “fast
shuffle,” or a “don’t-bother-me” response, you are
relaying to this person any one of the following
impressions about your attitude concerning his or her
needs:
“You are not an important individual.”
“Your request or problem is not important to me.”
“You don’t know what you are talking about; I do!”
“I don’t care about your problems; I’ve got
problems of my own.”
“I have more important things to do.”
“I am having a bad day today.”
The effect of bad service in an admin office is
much more lasting than the momentary anger or
disgust felt by the recipient. You can be sure the
customer will remember you if you provided him or
her with bad service. You can also be sure the customer
will tell his or her friends about the bad service you
provided. The frustration and resentment bad service
can cause will stay with that person in the form of his or
her general attitude toward the Navy.
On the other hand, good service contributes to a
good attitude in a person. Good service is a qualitative
and enviable characteristic that is indicative of a
person’s human relations capabilities, knowledge,
interest, and concern for others. These qualities are
especially important for you, the YN. By providing
good service you build an excellent rapport between
you and the customer. The Navy person who receives
good service will remember you as being a
professional customer-service representative who is
always willing and able to help. You can be sure this
person will tell his or her friends about you and
recommend you to them whenever they need to come
to the admin office.
In your career, the importance of providing
excellent service to Navy people cannot be overstated.
Always strive to be professional and provide the
best customer service possible to Navy members,
regardless of their status.
Recognizing the Customer’s Needs
Everyone in the Navy has needs. People’s
problems must often be met by someone else. As a YN,
you will encounter many individuals who have a
variety of needs. You most likely will know the
answers to many of the problems or, if not, you will
know where to find them. You have the key to the
information chest that contains the facts you need to
help a person seeking assistance. Recognize that the
personal service requirements are not the same for
everyone. The senior petty officer will come to you for
service, but, because of his or her experience, will not
require the same explanations, interpretations, or
advice that a younger, less experienced member
requires. Since the more experienced members are
aware of the services to which they are entitled, they
are less likely to accept poor service. Although all
members depend on others for service, the young men
1-6
and women serving their first enlistment probably feel
the greatest need.
Improving Your Contact Skills
To have a skill is the ability to do something well as
the result of talent, training, practice, or a combination
of these. A multitude of skills comes into play in your
day-to-day life––the professional skills of your rating,
your military skills, and the skills you use in your
off-duty activities.
We are concerned here with yet another type of
skill: face-to-face skills. These are skills that enable
you to deal effectively with people. Basically, these
skills include the ability to listen attentively,
effectively use eye contact, and work with and speak to
every individual as a person and not as an object.
The structure of the Navy tends to foster an
impersonal attitude in its members. We go where we
are sent. We do what we are told. People we never even
see make most of the decisions that affect our lives.
This type of relationship does not involve face-to-face
contact. This is not the relationship that exists aboard
ships or at shore stations, however. Here you are in
face-to-face contact with the customer; here the
relationship becomes personal.
It is because of this personal interaction that you
are required to have face-to-face skills if you are to be
an effective YN. Listen to the customer to understand
his or her needs; speak to the customer in a way the
customer understands; and respond to the customer by
making every effort to satisfy the customer.
Your effectiveness as the contact point depends on
how well you listen, speak, and respond to the
customer’s needs and how well you acquire and use
face-to-face skills.
Examining Your Attitudes
Our attitudes cannot be measured or graded, but
the effects or results of our attitudes can be. The effects
of our attitudes are apparent in our actions, words, and
deeds. You may have said or heard someone else say,
“That person has a bad attitude.” What does this mean?
How was this opinion formed? Was it formed as the
result of the way that person has acted toward
coworkers or customers, or as a result of not having
completed his or her assigned work?
Why are we bothering to talk about attitudes?
After all, people are people, and you cannot change
human nature. This is not true! Human nature is
constantly changing as attitudes change. How do
attitudes change? First, it takes you to recognize that a
need for change in attitude is desirable. Second, you
have to do something about it or take appropriate
action to make the change. Only you can do it! No
other person can force you to change. Changing your
attitude is just like setting goals for yourself: You must
combine vision with action. It is like wanting to do
something, determining what needs to be done, and
doing it.
ROLE OF THE CUSTOMER
Before we talk about the role of the customer, let’s
first consider the term customer. It is a familiar word,
and all of us in the Navy are frequently considered to be
customers. We often go to other offices for assistance.
As customers, we always expect to be provided the
very best possible service. In reality, we do not always
receive the kind of service we deserve or expect from
those serving behind the counter.
Your role as a customer is to be courteous, tactful,
and respectful to the person providing assistance to
you. When you make the person assisting you feel
important, you are encouraging that person to be more
aware of the expected service he or she needs to
provide. If you feel that the person is not providing you
with the assistance that you seek or expect, it is your
responsibility to bring the matter to the attention of a
more senior and knowledgeable individual, such as the
person’s supervisor. As the customer, you should
never leave an office unsatisfied. You should leave
that office feeling that you can always return at any
time and be confident that they will provide you with
the assistance you need. This is a realistic expectation.
Now, let’s change your position from the person
seeking assistance to that of the person behind the
counter providing assistance. Just imagine how
customers feel when they come to your office and they
do not receive the help they need or deserve.
Remember one thing: Always put yourself in the
customer’s shoes. Think of how you, as a customer,
would like to be treated. If you remember this, you will
become a more conscientious YN and you will
certainly try to provide the very best customer service
possible. Take care of those who need help. If you do
not have the answers, find out who does, and get the
answers.
1-7
THE CUSTOMER’S FIRST
IMPRESSION
Customers form first impressions about you and
your office the very first time they come in for help.
Therefore, it is important for you to create a positive,
lasting impression. You may handle many customers
in the course of a day. Remember that every customer
deserves the same courteous treatment. Take care of
each customer in a professional manner. The fact that
you must handle many customers during the course of
a day may affect your mood. If you are in a bad mood,
the customer will sense it and feel very uncomfortable
around you. Therefore, you should learn to control
your moods and your temper.
If you feel that you cannot provide the service a
customer needs because you are having a bad day, get
someone else who will, and excuse yourself. This is in
the best interest of you and the customer. A customer’s
impression of you will usually extend to the entire
office. For example, if a customer has a particularly
complicated problem, and you are able to help him or
her solve it by looking up the applicable reference, the
comment from the customer to shipmates might be,
“YN3 John Doe in the admin office is on the ball.” It is
even more likely that the customer’s comment will be,
“The admin office is on the ball. They solved my
problem because they know what they are doing.”
ANALYZING THE CUSTOMER
We have been analyzing your actions as the
customer-service representative so that you may see
some reasons, within yourself, why you may not be
providing as good a service as you are expected to do.
To do this, we have assumed that the customer was in a
good mood, had trust in your ability, and was willing to
accept your solution. This is not always the case.
There are several factors that often stand between
you and the customer. They can complicate the
customer’s problem and your efforts to provide a
solution. In the following paragraphs, we will take a
look at some of these barriers.
State of Mind
Regardless of the nature or seriousness of the
customer’s problem, certain negative factors may serve
to complicate it. The customer may exhibit the
following behaviors:
• Be angry, worried, or frustrated
• Lack confidence in your abilities
• Be unwilling to accept anything less than the
desired solution to a problem
However, if you can recognize these factors and make
appropriate allowances for them, you may avoid further
complicating the customer’s problem.
The customer who is emotionally upset (angry,
worried, or frustrated) may have difficulty in stating a
problem accurately or completely. Significant
information may be omitted; opinions may be
confused with facts; or there may be a feeling that the
information you are requesting is too personal.
Usually, it will help if you can first determine the cause
and target of the customer’s emotional upset. What
caused the anger? To whom is it directed? You may be
able to sort out this information by asking leading
questions.
The old adage “The customer is always right” is
not true in all situations. Personal abuse is not a “right”
of the customer. But the customer who is allowed to
“blow off steam” (within reason) may then become
apologetic and ready to accept your help.
When you are faced with an upset customer,
remember that your purpose is to serve that customer’s
needs. Any other response on your part that may cause
the customer to become more irritated is not
appropriate. Maintain your self-composure and try
to calm the customer down. If you start shouting
back because the customer has upset you, you will not
be able to provide the service that the customer needs.
If you feel that the customer has crossed the boundaries
and is being verbally abusive to you, excuse yourself
and bring the problem to the attention of your
supervisor. Your supervisor has more experience in
dealing with angry or irritated customers and will take
whatever action is necessary to resolve the customer’s
problem.
A calm, confident manner is the best approach.
When you do not respond with anger or rudeness to a
customer’s emotional outburst, you have taken the first
step toward solving the customer’s problem, whatever
its nature.
Complicated Problems
Most of the customers will have rather routine,
easily identifiable problems. These problems will not
present any great difficulty. However, there are
exceptions. To resolve a complicated problem, both
the customer and you, the YN, must have a mutual
1-8
desire to achieve results and take whatever appropriate
action is necessary to solve the problem. The problems
you encounter that are beyond your control because of
your lack of experience must be brought to the
attention of a more knowledgeable individual, such as
your supervisor, for appropriate action.
Your Response
Earlier we discussed your attitudes toward
customers, but we were thinking about customers in
general. It is not difficult to be pleasant when you are
dealing with pleasant people. It may become more
difficult when the person is unpleasant.
Occasionally, you will have a customer who just
seems to rub people the wrong way. No matter how
hard you try, you cannot remain pleasant or friendly
because of the customer’s attitude or manner of
speaking. In this situation, it is usually best to keep the
contact as impersonal as possible. Ignore the
person’s manner and attitude and concentrate on
the problem. It will be difficult, but it can be done.
The customer, your coworkers, and your
supervisor will view your performance. If you are to
do your best work, as rated by them, you must maintain
your self-control. When patience runs out and tempers
flare, your ability to think and act properly is greatly
reduced. Be a professional customer-service
representative and think before you act.
PITFALLS TO AVOID IN CUSTOMER
SERVICE
In the previous section we discussed why a good
attitude is important to customer satisfaction. We will
now talk about some specific mistakes YNs can make
in their handling of customer needs. For the most part,
these mistakes will tend to result from any attitudes
you project toward the customer, the customer’s
problem, the Navy, your job, or yourself.
JUMPING TO CONCLUSIONS
Jumping to a conclusion means that, in your
opinion, you already possess sufficient facts upon
which to base your judgment. As a result, you end up
ignoring additional information provided by the
customer. This tendency is often caused by a lack of
concern for the customer and the desire to end the
contact as quickly as possible. It may also occur
because you normally have a better knowledge of your
field than does the customer, and you may assume that
you know the customer’s need before it is completely
expressed.
If a customer has a vague idea as to the nature of a
problem, you should not jump to conclusions. This
does not help the customer. You should use tactful,
skillful questioning to properly identify what the
customer is trying to tell you.
PERSONAL REACTIONS
Occasionally, you may experience an adverse
reaction to a customer––to his or her appearance,
speech, or attitude. Because of your reaction, you may
not be able to provide the quality of service that the
customer needs or deserves. Most often, the cause of
your adverse reaction will be the customer’s attitude.
When the customer is overbearing, cynical, or is
flippant, it may be difficult for you to maintain a
professional manner. Nevertheless, you must remain
professional. A customer who has a bad attitude is also
an individual who deserves the same courtesy and
respect as an individual who is nice and courteous.
You must also be aware of your feelings regarding
a previous episode in which you had to deal with a
difficult customer. You will remember the customer
who gave you a rough time on a previous visit. Do not
let this memory affect your response when you are
called upon again to serve this customer. Showing
your feelings may give you some temporary
gratification, but it will not solve your problems with
this customer and it will have an adverse effect on your
performance.
STEREOTYPING
Stereotyping is forming a standardized,
oversimplified mental picture of members of a group.
Stereotyping involves a fixed or general pattern
that is attributed to the members of a particular
group—disregarding individual, distinguishing
qualities or characteristics. In stereotyping, we form
mental pictures of people, things, and events according
to the classification or group in which we feel they
belong.
Consciously or unconsciously, we may have gone
to a lot of effort to build up these stereotypes in our
mind to make it easier to classify people. Some of
these stereotypes may carry such labels as race,
nationality, sex, religion, length of hair, and many
others. Stereotyping eliminates the need for us to
know the person as an individual. How convenient it is
1-9
to have these ready-made niches in which we can place
the person and thereby “know all about them.” But
what an injustice this is! This implies that the person is
no different from anybody else in the same group or
category. This in itself is bad enough, but it is even
more offensive when that person is placed in a category
that we regard as inferior, and we, in turn, reflect this
opinion in our attitude toward the customer.
LANGUAGE BARRIERS
There are several types of language barriers that
interfere with effective communications. Some are
cultural, some are physical, some are habit, and some
are just intended to confuse you. The barrier may exist
because of the customer, you, or both.
The first two barriers––cultural and physical––are
the most difficult for the speaker to overcome. Persons
for whom English is a second language often have
difficulty with pronunciation, meaning, and sentence
structure. English is considered to be one of the most
difficult languages to learn (words that sound alike
have completely different spellings and meanings, and
words with similar spelling are pronounced
differently). You cannot change the English language,
but there are ways you can help your customer to
overcome this barrier. First, you must listen very
carefully to what the customer is saying. The best way
to do this is by being honestly concerned. Next, be
absolutely sure you know the nature of the need or
problem. Then, carefully phrase your questions so that
you use relatively simple words and ask only one thing
at a time. By first determining the nature of the
problem, you can then gain additional information by
asking questions.
The customer who has difficulty speaking English
may also have trouble understanding it. When it is
apparent that the customer is having difficulty
understanding, you should speak more distinctly and,
in most cases, more slowly. You can usually tell by the
customer’s expression whether or not you are being
understood.
Speech impediments, such as stuttering or lisping,
can also cause misunderstanding. In cases such as
these, your problem will be understanding the
speaker’s words rather than the speaker’s choice of
words.
We have been speaking of language barriers as
though they exist only on the part of the customer. This
is not always the case. Language barriers also exist
with customer-service representatives. If you have a
language barrier, your first step is to be aware of it.
Your next step is to make a conscious effort either to
eliminate it or to compensate for it. To compensate for
a language problem, try to speak slowly and give the
listener time to follow and interpret what you are
saying. Be sure to ask questions and encourage your
customer to do the same.
Some speech patterns that interfere with
understanding are not impediments but just habits.
Some of these speech habits are slurred pronunciation,
running words together, speaking too fast, an
exaggerated drawl or brogue, and profanity. Again,
these are not physical impediments or intentional
barriers; they are just habits. You should analyze your
own speech patterns and determine whether or not you
need to improve your manner of speaking. It is
possible that you may have one or more of these habits.
Normally, we do not listen to our own speech, but you
can obtain a reasonably accurate sample of your
speaking voice if you record an informal conversation
and then listen to it carefully. Speech habits are not too
hard to change, but you must first be aware of the habits
you need to change.
You, the YN, through the use of slang, technical
terms, and acronyms that may confuse the customer,
most often set up the final barrier. Although you will
routinely use these terms and acronyms among your
coworkers, your coworkers are already familiar with
this language. You should remember that these words
or expressions are not appropriate when your
customers may not be familiar with them. If you must
use technical terms, you must explain what they are as
you refer to them in your conversation. Remember that
customers from other ratings are not as well informed
about your rating and work as you are. Therefore, you
must remember to speak to your customers in terms
that they can understand. Periodically ask the
customer if he or she understands. If the customer does
not understand, ask your customer to tell you what he
or she does not understand, and repeat yourself in
simpler terms, if appropriate.
AMIABLE RUNAROUND
The emphasis on being friendly to the customer is a
means to an end––not an end in itself. You must also
provide good customer service. You do not have the
choice of providing either the friendly atmosphere or
the good service––you must provide both.
When a fr iendly, helpful a tmosphere is
encountered at the contact point, the customer is put at
1-10
ease and may be able to state the problem more
accurately. Then you are expected to take constructive
action to help the customer correct his or her problem.
But, some customer service representatives think that
their job is to keep the customers smiling and get rid of
them as soon as possible. True, the customer goes
away happy, but the happy attitude will not last.
Sooner or later, that customer will have to return
because nothing was done about the problem. You can
bet this customer will not be in a good frame of mind.
In helping people, you will discover that a
considerable amount of time and effort is required to
deal with some customers’ problems or needs. In such
instances, you may decide that it will be easier for you
if you convince the customer that no action is really
necessary. But this response will have an even worse
effect than denying the service to the customer because
you are, in fact, denying the reality of the customer’s
problem. If a customer requests and is entitled to a
service, it is your responsibility to provide it. When
you can say to a customer, “It’s all taken care of,” you
are promising that person that all necessary actions
have been completed. This is a good response if it is the
truth. If it is not true, you have done a disservice––not a
service––to your customer, your office, your rating,
and the Navy. Have you ever said to a customer, “Yes,
everything is taken care of” when, in fact, it was not? If
so, you should realize that this is a bad way of doing
business. Remember, you should be both tactful and
truthful when you deal with your customers.
GOING BEYOND YOUR REALM
If you seldom make a mistake, you may find it
difficult to understand why other people frequently
make more mistakes. Mistakes can result from many
different situations. For example, heavy workloads,
inexperienced personnel, unfamiliar situations, and
carelessness can all contribute to the likelihood of
errors. Errors may disappear, but they do not go away.
The problem with all errors is that they must be
corrected––often at some later date, at a different
command, or by someone else. When you have to
correct an error that someone else made, you will be
tempted to “sound off” about the person who made the
mistake. But whether or not you express your feeling,
you must spend the same amount of effort to correct the
error. It is proper to tell your customer that a mistake
was made and explain the conditions––where and
when––the error was made. Although you may feel
embarrassed to explain to your customer that your
office made a mistake, you nevertheless must do this as
soon as the problem is identified. Appropriate steps
must be taken to correct the problem immediately. If
the problem was made by another office, correct it
promptly. In both cases, there is no need to “cry over
spilled milk.” Just correct the problem.
Another area in which we sometimes overstep our
bounds is expressing criticism or disapproval of
official Navy policy, command policy, and divisional
procedures and instructions. You do not have to agree
with all of them. In fact, discussing them among your
coworkers can have positive results––a change in
procedures, a better flow of information, a better
understanding of policy, or the improved ability to help
the customer. Expressing your adverse opinion about
them to the customer, however, serves no good
purpose.
When a customer requests something that must be
denied because of current policy or regulations,
frustration and resentment are natural reactions. If you
express your disapproval or criticism of this policy or
regulation, it only serves to increase the feeling of
resentment or frustration in the customer. You have not
helped. You have just made it harder for the customer
to accept the inevitable answer. On the other hand, if
you know the policy is a temporary matter, or if you
have reason to believe a change may be coming out
soon, it is permissible (in fact, it is desirable) for you to
explain this so that the customer may renew the request
later.
You may have some customers whose problems
are only imaginary. They want to complain about their
petty officers, duty assignments, working conditions,
or life in general. In these situations, you must
maintain a very careful balance. You should not refuse
to hear them out. There should be a point, however,
when you must politely tell them that you wish you
could stay there and listen, but that you have some
important work to do.
SUMMARY
In this chapter, we have tried to acquaint you with
the general requirements of the YN rating. We have
mostly described how important it is for you to provide
good customer service to all individuals. We stressed
that if you have a good attitude and pride in your job
and in yourself, these qualities will contribute to your
ability to provide good customer service. If you are
providing good customer service right now, the Navy
appreciates it and thanks you for your efforts.
Remember also, that there is always room for
improvement. The most important thing you should
1-11
get out of this chapter is that you should put yourself in
the customer’s shoes. Ask yourself, “How do I want to
be treated?” In answering this question, you will most
likely say, “I always want to be treated with courtesy
and respect.” You see, that is just how all customers
want to be treated––with courtesy and respect. You
should always treat customers the way you would want
to be treated.
Now you have a broad idea of what a YN is, what a
YN does, and what is expected of you. Keep this in
mind as you take this course. As in most things, you can
be good, mediocre, or bad at what you do, and rewards
are given accordingly. A trusted YN who gains and
holds the confidence of seniors can be in a position to
influence command actions and attitudes much more
than other ratings in the same paygrade. A good YN
doing a good job stands out above all others.
1-12
CHAPTER 2
OFFICIAL PUBLICATIONS AND DIRECTIVES
Using publications and directives are part of the
daily routine of any Navy office. The efficiency of the
office depends on how well this is done. This makes it
important for you to recognize various publications, to
understand their contents, and how to store and retrieve
them as they are needed. As stated before, you can’t
remember everything; the trick is to know where to
find information. In this chapter, we will tell you about
the publications you will need to do your job as a YN
responsible for managing a great deal of information,
and providing it to a great number of people.
GENERAL REGULATORY
PUBLICATIONS
The Constitution of the United States, the treaties
this nation enters into, and laws passed by the Congress
comprise the fundamental law governing the Navy.
These, however, give only the broad outlines. For
express directions setting forth procedures under the
law, the Navy has various publications and official
directives.
The principal general regulations, directives,
orders, and instructions issued for the guidance of
persons throughout the Department of the Navy
(DON) are found in the following sources.
UNITED STATES NAVY REGULATIONS
Foremost in general importance among official
publications is the United States Navy Regulations
(Navy Regs), 1990. This regulatory document of the
DON states policy as to the duties, responsibilities,
authorities, distinctions, and relationships of various
commands, officials, and individuals. It outlines the
organizational structure of the DON and issues the
principles and policies by which the Navy is governed.
The chapters set forth, among other things, the
responsibility, purpose, authority, and relationship of
each bureau and office of the Navy Department;
headquarters organizations; and the senior executives
(military and civilian) of the DON.
The Chief of Naval Operations (CNO) is
responsible for making changes to Navy Regulations,
and the Secretary of the Navy approves the changes. It
is published in loose-leaf form and kept in an
adjustable binder so that changes may be inserted as
necessary.
STANDARD ORGANIZATION AND
REGULATIONS OF THE U.S. NAVY
The Standard Organization and Regulations of the
U.S. Navy (SORM), is issued as OPNAVINST 3120.32
series by the CNO. This publication issues regulations
and guidance governing the conduct of all members of
the U.S. Navy. These regulations use two types of
print: the material in uppercase is regulatory, and the
material printed in plain type is for the guidance of
commanders, commanding officers (COs), and
officers in charge. These regulations apply to each
member of the Navy individually. Violation of any
provision of these regulations is punishable under the
Uniform Code of Military Justice (UCMJ).
As a YN, you should be generally familiar with the
entire publication, but you will want to be particularly
familiar with chapter 3, “The Unit Organization”;
chapter 5, “Regulations”; chapter 6, “Unit Bills”; and
chapter 10, “Unit Directives System.” You will refer
frequently to this publication during the course of
everyday activities. This is especially true if you are
serving aboard ship.
MANUAL FOR COURTS-MARTIAL
By enactment of the UCMJ, approved 5 May 1950,
as amended by the Military Justice Act of 24 October
1968, Congress established a single set of laws for
administering justice to all the armed forces. Under the
authority of this act, the President issued the Manual
for Courts-Martial (MCM), United States, 2000.
The MCM describes the types of courts-martial
established by the UCMJ, defines their jurisdiction,
and prescribes their membership and procedures. It
also covers such matters as nonjudicial punishment
(NJP), review of court-martial proceedings, new trials,
and limitations on punishments. The MCM was
prepared in the Office of the Secretary of Defense and
was approved and signed by the President. It is a
2-1
loose-leaf volume issued to the Navy through the
Office of the Judge Advocate General.
MANUAL OF THE JUDGE ADVOCATE
GENERAL
The Manual of the Judge Advocate General
(JAGMAN), JAGINST 5800.7 series, prepared by the
Navy Judge Advocate General and authorized by the
Secretary of the Navy, covers legal and judicial matters
that apply only to the naval service. It also includes
instructions regarding administrative investigations
and examining boards, their composition, authority,
and procedures.
The JAGMAN is prepared by the Office of the
Judge Advocate General and prepared in a loose-leaf
volume for ease in making changes. This publication
is discussed further in chapter 9.
NAVAL MILITARY PERSONNEL MANUAL
The Naval Mi l i tary Personnel Manual
(MILPERSMAN), NAVPERS 15560, is issued under
Navy Regulations, 1990. It contains policy, rules, and
practices for administration of military personnel
within the Navy.
A seven-digit identification number, consisting of
the Standard Subject Identification Code (SSIC) and a
three-digit extension number (e.g., Article 1070-010),
identifies each article. The first four digits identify the
SSIC, and the last three digits identify the article
placement within the section.
Changes and distribution are authorized and
published by the Deputy Chief of Naval Personnel with
approval of the Chief of Naval Personnel
(CHNAVPERS), published in loose-leaf form for
convenience in making changes.
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
INFORMATION SECURITY PROGRAM
REGULATION AND DEPARTMENT OF
THE NAVY PERSONNEL SECURITY
PROGRAM REGULATION
The Department of the Navy (DON) Information
Security Program (ISP) Regulation, SECNAVINST
5510.36 series, and Department of the Navy (DON)
Personnel Security Program (PSP) Regulation,
SECNAVINST 5510.30 series, both approved and
issued by Secretary of the Navy, are together
commonly referred to as the Security Manuals. These
manuals are established to ensure that classified
information is protected from unauthorized disclosure.
They also ensure that appointment or retention of
civilian employees of the DON, acceptance or
retention of military personnel in the Navy or Marine
Corps, and the granting of access to classified
information or assignment to other sensitive duties are
clearly consistent with the interests of national
security. Each individual, military or civilian, in or
employed by the Navy or Marine Corps is responsible
individually for compliance with these regulations in
all respects.
The ISP regulation contains procedures for
classifying, marking, and handling classified
information. The PSP regulation contains procedures
for authorizing personnel access to classified
information. The aspects of these publications that are
applicable to you as a YN are discussed further in
chapter 8.
MANUAL OF THE MEDICAL
DEPARTMENT
The Manual of the Medical Department
(MANMED), NAVMED P-117, is issued by the Bureau
of Medicine and Surgery and contains material on
general instructions for medical care of personnel of the
Navy and Marine Corps; directions for procurement,
storage, issue, and accounting of medical supplies and
for training medical and dental personnel; information
regarding physical requirements and examinations for
personnel of the Navy and Marine Corps; procedures for
keeping health records and submitting reports; and
special instructions for procedures and reports in cases
of death.
The Chief, Bureau of Medicine and Surgery,
prepares the MANMED. It is published in loose-leaf
form for the convenience of making changes.
NAVY CASUALTY ASSISTANCE CALLS
PROGRAM
The Navy Casualty Assistance Calls Program
(CACP) Manual, BUPERSINST 1770.3 series, is
published to assist in the proper discharge of the
functions of the program. The CACP provides that a
commissioned officer of the Navy on active duty be
officially designated a CACP officer (or CACO) to
personally contact the primary next of kin of naval
personnel, exclusive of Marine Corps personnel, who
die on active duty or training duty. The purpose of the
program is to assist and advise the next of kin about the
rights, benefits, and privileges to which they are
2-2
entitled as a result of the death of members of the naval
service.
DECEDENT AFFAIRS MANUAL
The Bureau of Medicine and Surgery publishes the
Decedent Affairs Manual, NAVMEDCOMINST
5360.1 series. The Decedent Affairs Program is
defined as the recovery, identification, care, and
disposition of remains of deceased persons for whom
the DON is responsible. This program is applicable
during peacetime, in time of war, and in support of
major military operations.
MANUAL OF NAVY OFFICER MANPOWER
AND PERSONNEL CLASSIFICATIONS
The Manual of Navy Officer Manpower and
Personnel Classifications (NOMPC), NAVPERS
15839, is published by the Bureau of Naval Personnel
(BUPERS) and is issued in two volumes. Volume I
contains the Navy Officer Occupational Classification
System (NOOCS) and is used to identify skills,
education, training, experience, and capabilities
related to both officer personnel and manpower
requirements. Volume II contains a description of the
Officer Data Card (ODC) and a l i s t ing of
nonoccupational manpower and personnel codes that
provide foreign language, ship and station, service
school, education, and other identifiers on the ODC.
BUPERS uses these classifications to identify
billet experience and special qualifications of each
naval officer. This information is required for
personnel administration, including procurement,
training, distribution, manpower planning, and career
management. NOMPC codes are also used by CNO to
identify qualitative officer requirements in manpower
authorizations. Changes are issued by CHNAVPERS.
OFFICERS REGISTERS
The Register of the United States Navy on Active
Duty, NAVPERS 15018; Register of Commissioned
and Warrant Officers of the United States Naval
Reserve, NAVPERS 15009; and Register of Retired
Commissioned and Warrant Officers, Regular and
Reserve, of the United States Navy, NAVPERS 15939,
are published by Bureau of Naval personnel on a
quarterly basis and issued to all ships and stations via
the BUPERS CD-ROM or the BUPERS website. In
your capacity as a YN, you will probably only deal
routinely with the Active Duty Register; however, you
should be aware of the existence of all of them.
In addition to an alphabetical list of all officers, the
Active Duty Register contains a complete lineal list.
The purpose in assigning an officer a lineal number
is to establish his or her seniority with his or her grade
and corps. A lineal number consists of a six-digit
whole number and a two-digit subnumber. Using
subnumbers makes it possible to add or take away
names without renumbering the whole list. The system
works inversely: the lower the lineal number, the
higher the seniority.
THE UNITED STATES NAVY UNIFORM
REGULATIONS
The United States Navy Uniform Regulations is
prepared and distributed by CHNAVPERS. It
describes and lists the various uniforms for personnel
in all categories, lists the uniforms required, and
contains lists of articles worn or used together. It also
describes occasions when the various uniforms should
be worn; methods of wearing medals, decorations,
ribbons, rating badges, and special markings; and
gives notes on the care of the uniform.
Changes are issued by the CHNAVPERS as
changes in the uniform occur.
OFFICER TRANSFER MANUAL
The Officer Transfer Manual (OFFTRANSMAN),
NAVPERS 15559, is the official manual for the
distribution and assignment of officers in the U.S.
Navy. This publication supplements basic regulations
and instructions issued by the MILPERSMAN,
NAVPERS 15560.
The primary purpose of this manual is to improve
awareness of proper officer distribution procedures and
to make the assignment process more efficient. This
manual is also a quick reference and an easy-to-read
compilation of instructions and information pertaining
to all areas of officer distribution.
ENLISTED TRANSFER MANUAL
The Enlisted Transfer Manual (ENLTRANSMAN),
NAVPERS 15909, is the official manual for the
distribution and assignment of enlisted personnel of
the U.S. Navy. The ENLTRANSMAN supplements
basic regulations and instructions issued by the
MILPERSMAN. The purpose of the ENLTRANS-
MAN is to provide a quick reference of instructional
and informational material relative to all facets of
enlisted distribution. It is primarily intended to reduce
the clerical workload and generally to promote
administrative efficiency.
2-3
JOINT FEDERAL TRAVEL REGULATIONS
The Joint Federal Travel Regulations (JFTR),
NAVSO P-6034, is issued in three volumes. Volume 1
is issued by the Per Diem, Travel, and Transportation
Allowance Committee, which operates under the
cognizance of the Department of Defense (DOD), and
deals with travel of members of the uniformed
services. Volume 2 is published by General Services
Administration and applies to all federal civilian
employees. Volume 3 is published by the State
Department and applies to all foreign-service
personnel.
The JFTR interprets the laws and regulations
concerning travel, the manner in which transportation
is furnished to personnel, provisions for travel of
dependents, transportation of household goods,
reimbursement for travel expenses, and similar
information. This publication is discussed further in
chapter 13.
U.S. NAVY TRAVEL INSTRUCTION
The U.S. Navy Travel Instruction (NTI), NAVSO
P-1459, is a joint publication of the CNO and the
Comptroller of the Navy that interprets for Navy use
the travel regulations issued by the JFTR, volume 1. It
sets forth the manner in which transportation is
furnished and reimbursement made for travel expenses
incurred. In any case where instructions in the NTI and
the JFTR conflict, the JFTR takes precedence.
DEPARTMENT OF DEFENSE MILITARY
PAY AND ALLOWANCE ENTITLEMENTS
MANUAL
The Department of Defense Military Pay and
Allowance Entitlements Manual (DODPM), DOD
7000.14-R, is issued by the Comptroller of the
Department of Defense in coordination with the
Director, Defense Finance and Accounting Service
(DFAS). This manual applies to all DOD activities and
is issued for the information, guidance, and
compliance of all personnel in the administration of
military pay.
SOURCE DATA SYSTEMS PROCEDURES
MANUAL
The Source Data Systems Procedures Manual
(SDSPROMAN), NAVSO P-3069, volumes I and II, is
issued jointly by the Comptroller of the Navy and the
CHNAVPERS, and contains procedural instructions
for reporting pay and personnel events for Regular and
Reserve members of the U.S. Navy. Volume I provides
information on the SDS procedures as a whole, and
volume II gives details for terminal operation and event
reporting.
PASSENGER TRANSPORTATION MANUAL
The Passenger Transportation Manual (PTM),
NAVMILPERSCOMINST 4650.2 series, provides a
single, comprehensive manual covering all aspects of
Navy-sponsored passenger transportation. CNO has
designated BUPERS as the manager of the
Navy-sponsored passenger transportation. The PTM
is designed to ensure that Navy-sponsored passengers
who are entitled to, or eligible for, transportation at
government expense will travel in the most responsive,
efficient, and economical manner. The manual
consists of nine chapters. As a YN, you should
familiarize yourself with chapter 1, “General
Information”; chapter 2, “Procedures for Arranging
Passenger Transportation”; and chapter 3, “Passports
and Visas.”
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY SOCIAL
USAGE AND PROTOCOL HANDBOOK
The Department of the Navy Social Usage and
Protocol Handbook, OPNAVINST 1710.7 series,
provides current information on formal and informal
activities that have a distinctly naval, military, and/or
diplomatic setting. The handbook consists of 12
chapters that address official entertainment,
invitations, seating arrangements, formal dining,
toasting, receptions, cards and calls, dining-ins, ships’
ceremonies, change-of-command and retirement
ceremonies, arranging visits for dignitaries, and forms
of address.
NAVY AND MARINE CORPS AWARDS
MANUAL
The Navy and Marine Corps Awards Manual,
SECNAVINST 1650.1 series, is issued by the
Secretary of the Navy for the information and guidance
of the Navy and Marine Corps in all matters pertaining
to decorations, medals, and awards (with the exception
of detailed information on the manner of wearing
them, which is contained in Uniform Regulations).
This publication is discussed further in chapter 10.
2-4
MANUAL OF ADVANCEMENT
The Manual of Advancement, BUPERSINST
1430.16 series, is published by CHNAVPERS to
provide for the administration of the advancement
system. It supports and enlarges on the basic policies
for advancement as outlined in the MILPERSMAN,
and further provides instructions for determining
eligibility requirements for advancement; preparation
of necessary forms; ordering, custody, and disposition
of Navywide examinations; administration of all
examinations for advancement; changes in rate or
rating; and procedures for effecting advancements.
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY STANDARDSUBJECT IDENTIFICATION CODES
CNO is responsible for preparing the Department
of the Navy Standard Subject Identification Codes
(SSIC), SECNAVINST 5210.11 series, and for
preparing and providing for changes and presenting
them to the Secretary of the Navy for signature. The
SSIC is prescribed for use in classifying subjects and
identifying correspondence directives, blank forms,
and reports (assigning report control symbols); setting
up filing and retrieval systems; routing computer
messages; and for use with any other documents to
which reference is made by subject. This publication is
discussed further in chapter 5.
STANDARD NAVY DISTRIBUTION LIST
The Standard Navy Distribution List (SNDL),
OPNAVNOTE 5400, is published by CNO to provide
for the proper addressing and distribution of mail to all
activities of the DON, and to provide a central
distribution system for directives and correspondence.
The SNDL is published as six enclosures:
• Enclosure (1): Forward to the SNDL
• Enclosure (2): Fleet Address Listings
• Enclosure (3): Shore Address Listings
• Enclosure (4): Fleet Chain of Command List
• Enclosure (5): Homeports and Permanent Duty
Station List
• Enclosure (6): SNDL Serial Changes for the
current month
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
CORRESPONDENCE MANUAL
The Department of the Navy Correspondence
Manual, SECNAVINST 5216.5 series, is prepared in
the Office of CNO and approved by the Secretary of the
Navy. It contains instructions for preparing letters,
endorsements, memorandums, and messages.
Instructions cover all parts of correspondence, such as
address, subject, references, paragraphing, and
signature, together with directions for assembling
correspondence for signature and mailing.
Changes to the Correspondence Manual are
prepared by CNO and signed by the Secretary of the
Navy. This publication is discussed further in
chapter 3.
NAVAL TELECOMMUNICATIONS
PROCEDURES AND USERS MANUAL
The Naval Telecommunications Procedures and
Users Manual, NTP-3, was developed under the
direction of the Commander, Naval Computer and
Telecommunications Command, and was designed to
explain procedures for the drafting and preparation of
naval messages. This publication is further discussed
in chapter 3.
NAVY AND MARINE CORPS RECORDS
DISPOSITION MANUAL
The Navy and Marine Corps Records Disposition
Manual, SECNAVINST 5212.5 series, prescribes
policy and procedures for the DON relating to records
creation, maintenance and disposition. Within the legal
framework provided by the Records Disposal Act of
1943, as amended; the Federal Records Act of 1950; and
Navy Regulations, the DON has four specific goals:
1. Creation of records that adequately document
the organization, function, policies, procedures,
decisions, and essential transactions of the
DON.
2. Preservation of records having long-term
permanent worth because of their continuing
administrative, legal, scientific, or historical
values.
3. Destruction of temporary records as they
outlive their usefulness.
4. Retirement and transfer of those records no
longer required in the conduct of daily business
to more economical storage.
2-5
This publication is discussed further in chapter 5.
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
DIRECTIVES ISSUANCE SYSTEM
The Department of the Navy Directives Issuance
System, SECNAVINST 5215.1 series, provides a
standard method of issuing directives by all activities
in the Navy. The system contains two parts and two
tables:
Part I - Definitions, Criteria, and Responsi-
bilities
Part II - Preparation and Maintenance of
Directives
Table 1 - Preparation of Letter-Type Directives
Table 2 - Preparation of Special-Type Directives
The Directives Issuance System contains the
standard procedures and formats used to issue policy,
procedural, and informational releases in the DON.
This publication is discussed further in chapter 6.
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY FORMS
MANAGEMENT PROGRAM
The Department of the Navy Forms Management
Program, SECNAVINST 5213.10 series, ensures that
forms provide needed information effectively,
efficiently, and economically. Information is vital to
the success of any organization and provides the basis
for management decisions. Specific types of data are
needed to meet particular requirements, and forms are
a major means for providing a fast and easy method of
collecting information. Forms management provides
for improvement and control of forms to ensure
minimum burden is expended and maximum
effectiveness obtained. This publication is discussed
further in chapter 7.
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
INFORMATION REQUIREMENTS
(REPORTS) MANAGEMENT PROGRAM
The Department of the Navy Information
Requirements (Reports) Management Program,
SECNAVINST 5214.2 series, sets forth the policy and
responsibilities for the management of information
requirements of the DON. Information is vital to the
success of any organization and provides the basis for
management decisions. Specific types of data are
needed to meet particular requirements. Reports
management encompasses the development of reports
and reporting systems. This publication is discussed
further in chapter 7.
NAVY PERFORMANCE EVALUATION AND
COUNSELING SYSTEM
The Navy Per formance Evaluat ion and
Counseling System, BUPERSINST 1610.10 series,
requires that records be maintained on officer and
enlisted personnel that reflect their fitness for the
service and performance of duties. Evaluations are
used in many personnel ac t ions , inc luding
advancement in rate, selection for responsible
assignments and specialized training, award of the
Good Conduct Medal, qualification for retention and
reenlistment, and characterization of service upon
discharge.
DIARY MESSAGE REPORTING SYSTEM
USERS MANUAL
The Diary Message Reporting System Users
Manual (DMRSMAN), 1080#1 UM-02, is the official
manual for submitting officer and enlisted personnel
diaries in coded format via naval message. It reduces
preparation time and eliminates delays so that we have
more accurate personnel management and manpower
information.
FORMAT AND PROCEDURES FOR
VALIDATING THE OFFICER
DISTRIBUTION CONTROL REPORT
The Format and Procedures for Validating the
Officer Distribution Control Report (ODCR),
BUPERSINST 1301.40 series, provides each Navy
activity with a routine system for verifying the ODCR.
BUPERS prepares the ODCR for each naval activity
with officer billets authorized or officers on board in a
temporary duty status. Officer billet and assignment
information in the ODCR represents the computer data
bank input by CNO, BUPERS, DFAS, Enlisted
Personnel Management Center (EPMAC), and SDS.
This publication is discussed further in chapter 11.
ORDERING FORMS AND
PUBLICATIONS
To order new forms or publications (with the
exception of those issued through the Directives
Issuance System) or to replace those that have become
damaged or mutilated, all you need do is notify your
supply officer. The method of informing the supply
2-6
officer of your needs varies with the activity or size of
your ship. The supply officer will let you know how the
information is to be given.
The supply department prepares a DOD Single
Line Item Requisition System Document, DD Form
1348, and sends it to the supply activity responsible for
the supply support of your ship or station.
Many of these forms can be obtained electronically
via www.bupers.navy.mil, “Instructions.”
FINDING STOCK NUMBERS
The basic directive on how the system works can
be found in Navy Stock List of Forms and Publications,
NAVSUP P-2002. This instruction tells the supply
officer where to send the DD Form 1348 and gives the
ordering number for the item.
COMMISSIONING ALLOWANCES
To assist new commands, the Navy Supply Depot,
Philadelphia, assembles a commissioning allowance
of forms and publ ica t ions for each newly
commissioned ship before the commissioning date,
and provides the prospec t ive CO with a
commissioning allowance listing. All the items on the
listing, including a 90-day supply of forms, are
automatically shipped to the prospective CO or the
fitting-out officer. This one-time allowance eliminates
the need and paper work of ordering each form and
publication separately. For further instructions
concerning commissioning allowances of publications
and directives authorized by BUPERS, you may refer
to the MILPERSMAN.
SUMMARY
This chapter has given you information about
publications that cross the whole spectrum of naval
administration. Try to become familiar with these
publications. By knowing and understanding their
contents, you can find any procedure and do any job
you are given. Other chapters in this manual will teach
you how to do some specific jobs and give more
detailed information on certain aspects of the YN
rating. This one chapter will set you up to perform not
only in your present job, but also in jobs throughout
your career.
2-7
CHAPTER 3
CORRESPONDENCE/MESSAGE SYSTEM
One of your most important tasks as a YN is the
preparation of correspondence and messages. You will
be expected to produce properly formatted letters with
no uncorrected errors quickly and efficiently—and not
just letters, either. The term official correspondence
includes all written material—publications, messages,
memorandums, and so on—that are sent to or from the
command. This chapter will teach you standard
formats, variations to the standard letter, other forms of
formal and informal letter correspondence, and
message preparation.
CORRESPONDENCE
First, we will describe the different types of Navy
correspondence you will prepare: the standard letter,
the joint let ter, the mult iple-address let ter,
endorsements, memorandums, and business letters.
THE STANDARD LETTER
Instructions for typing standard letters are
contained in the Navy Correspondence Manual,
SECNAVINST 5216.5 series. It is important to follow
these instructions exactly. This is the “Navy way” of
doing it, and uniformity is essential to an accurate and
expeditious information flow. Figure 3-1 illustrates a
sample standard letter.
Stationery
The first page of a naval letter contains the
letterhead (name and address) of the activity, printed
on bond paper. The second and succeeding pages of a
letter are typed on plain white bond paper that is the
same size and quality as the letterhead paper.
Copies
Copies to each Via addressee and Copy to
addressee can be photocopied. In all instances,
photocopies may be used as long as copy quality is
high and associated costs can be kept down.
General Style
A 1-inch margin is required at the top, bottom, and
sides of each page, except for the top of letterhead
paper and the bottom of the last page. A larger pica
(12-point) type is preferred over elite (10-point) type;
script or italic type is used for occasional emphasis,
never for a whole document. Indentation of
subparagraphs is always four spaces. Ink should be
black or blue-black for typing and signature.
Sender’s Symbols
Include the following three sender’s symbols in the
upper-right corner blocked one below the other:
• Standard subject identification code (SSIC)
• Originator’s code by itself or in a serial number
• Date
This information goes right under the In reply
refer to line, if it is printed on your letterhead. If “In
reply refer to” is not printed on your letterhead, the
information starts on the second line below the
letterhead, starting 2 inches from the right edge of the
paper.
The SSIC is determined by checking the
Department of the Navy File Maintenance Procedures
and Standard Subject Ident i ficat ion Codes ,
SECNAVINST 5210.11 series, for the SSIC that most
closely represents the subject matter contained in the
letter.
The originator’s code is usually the office symbol
of the drafter, but it may be the hull number of a ship.
All classified material must be serialized, and
unclassified material may be serialized if volume or
local practice requires it. Starting with the notation
Ser, followed by a space, your originator’s code is
followed by a slash (/) . The classification
abbreviation, C, S, or T, and the next unused serial
number for your current calendar year complete the
line. For example:
Ser N13/271
3-1
Dates
Letters are dated, either stamped or typed, the
same day they are signed. Follow a day-month-year
order with no punctuation. The month is abbreviated
using the first three letters, capitalizing only the first,
and the year is represented by its last two digits (25 Sep
00). In the text of the letter, however, the month and
year are not abbreviated or shortened.
Special Postal Service
If special postal service is to be used, the
appropriate designation (registered mail or certified
mail) is typed in capitals or stamped at the left margin
on the second line below the date.
From Block
Every standard letter must have a From block.
Give your CO’s title, your activity’s name, and, for a
command based ashore, its geographic location
(without the state or ZIP Code). Use the Standard
Navy Distribution List (SNDL) for the exact wording.
Type the word From and a colon at the left margin
on the second line below the date. Two spaces follow
the colon before the title. If a second line is needed to
complete identification, start it directly under the first
word after “From:”
To Block
Address correspondence to the CO of an activity as
if you are composing a From block. Give the complete
mailing address, and include the ZIP Code if you want
the address recorded on your file copy.
Type the word To and a colon at the left margin on
the first line under the From block. Four spaces must
follow the colon. Show the office that will act on your
letter by including a code or person’s title in
parentheses right after the activity’s name if the
information is available. Add the word Code before
codes that start with numbers. A code that starts with a
letter is readily identifiable as a code without the added
word.
Via Block
The Via block is used when one or more activities
outside your own should see a letter before it reaches
the Action addressees. List COs in the Via block the
same way you list them in the To block.
Type the word Via and a colon at the left margin on
the first line below the To block. Three spaces must
follow the colon. Continuation lines start under the
first word after the heading. Number the addressees
(1), (2), (3), and so forth, if you list two or more. A
single Via addressee is not numbered. Mail the letter to
the Via addressee listed first.
Subject Block
The subject is a sentence fragment that tells
readers what the letter is about, usually in 10 words or
less.
Type the abbreviation Subj and a colon at the left
margin on the second line under the last line of the
previous block. Two spaces must follow the colon.
Normal word order is used and all letters are
capitalized. For example:
Subj: REQUEST FOR A REVIEW OF
YEOMAN THIRD AND SECOND
CLASS TRAINING MANUAL
Reference Block
References are other documents to which the
reader is directed to assist in dealing with the subject
matter of the letter.
Type the abbreviation Ref and a colon at the left
margin on the second line below the Subject block. A
lowercase letter in parentheses (such as (a), (b), (c),
and so on) is used to identify each reference, even if
only one is listed. Three spaces must follow the colon
before the designation, and one space must follow the
last parentheses. The following table gives examples
of how to construct reference blocks based on the type
of reference.
To prevent confusion, avoid the pronoun your in
the Reference block of a letter that has more than one
action addressee. At times, a reference will be given
that is not available to all the addressees. In such a
case, the abbreviation NOTAL (not to all), enclosed in
parentheses, is added following the reference.
Enclosure Block
Enclosures to a letter are used to avoid lengthening
the letter with too many details or to include nontextual
matter such as lists or charts. List enclosures in an
Enclosure block by following the order of their
appearance in the text.
3-2
3-3
Type of Reference Requirements Examples
Correspondence
• SNDL short title of originator
• Type of correspondence (ltr ormemo)
• SSIC
• Originator's code by itself or in aserial number as shown in thereferenced correspondence
• Date
USS DAVID R. RAY (DD 971) ltr 5216Ser DD 971/437 of 9 Sep 00
ORCNO memo 5216 Ser 09B33/317731 of11 Sep 00
Messages
• Title of originator as shown in Fromblock of message
• Date-time-group (DTG) month andyear
[NOTE: When you reference generalmessages, include the message title(ALNAV, NAVOP, ALNAVSTA, and soon) and the serial number/year inparentheses.]
USS DAVID R. RAY 091300Z Sep 00OR
CNO Washington DC 111300Z Sep 00(NAVOP XXX/00)
EndorsementsAppropriate emphasis, depending onwhether you want to mention them inpassing or highlight a particular one
ENS Jack R. Frost, USNR, 111-11-1111/[designator] ltr of 1 Apr 00 w/ends
ORCOMNAVSURFPAC third end 1070 SerN1/3124 of 22 Apr 00
ORENS Jack R. Frost, USNR, 111-11-1111/[designator] ltr of 1 Apr 00
TelephoneConversations
• PHONCON
• Individuals and their activities
• Date
PHONCON OPNAV (OP-09B 15) Mrs.Brush/NAVSUP (Code 01222B) CDRPistol of 16 Nov 00
Instructions
• SNDL short title of issuer
• INST
• SSIC with consecutive number anda revision letter, if any
• Subject (if not clear from the subjector text of your letter)
• Chapter or paragraph of a longinstruction if only that part applies
SECNAVINST 5216.5, Department of theNavy Correspondence Manual, Ch. 2,Par. 14
Notices
• SNDL short title of issuer
• NOTE
• SSIC
• Serial number, if any
• Date (because notices lackconsecutive numbers)
• Subject (if not clear from the subjector text of your letter)
• Chapter or paragraph of a longnotice if only that part applies
OPNAVNOTE 5216 Ser 9B1/0920 of 20Apr 00
Reports, Forms,and Publications
• Reports must include subjects
• Forms and publications may excludesubjects
Reports: Injury Report (NAVJAG5800-19)
Forms: NAVJAG 5800/15 (Rev.7-81)
Publication: NAVPERS 15018
"My" and "Your"optional
To cite an earlier communicationbetween your activity and the actionaddressee, you may substitute apersonal pronoun for the issuingactivity
My ltr 5216 Ser G12/4959 of 2 Jun 00OR
Your 221501Z Jul 00
Table 3–1.—Reference Format Examples
Type the abbreviation Encl and a colon at the left
margin on the second line below the previous block.
Use a number in parentheses in front of the description
of every enclosure, even a single one. Two spaces must
follow the colon, and one space must follow the closing
parentheses. For example:
Encl: (1) List of Reserve Officers Selected
for Promotion to Colonel
(2) CMC ltr 5216 Ser MMPR/1451 of
6 Jan 95
Normally, all addressees are sent a copy of all
enclosures listed in the basic letter. When sending
more than one copy of an enclosure to all addressees,
note the number of copies mailed in parentheses. For
example:
Encl: (1) OPNAV 5216/10 (100 copies)
When varying the normal distribution of
enclosures to Copy to addressees, follow these
examples:
• Copy to: (w/o encl)
• Copy to: (w/o encls (2) and (3))
• Copy to: (w/2 copies of encl (1))
When varying the normal distribution of
enclosures to Via addressees, show the variation beside
the affected Via addressee as follows:
Via: Commander, Naval Surface Force, U.S.
Atlantic Fleet (w/o encl)
Identify an enclosure on the first page only. The
marking goes in the lower-right corner. The notation
Encl plus its number in parentheses is typed, stamped,
or written.
The standard letter practice of numbering only the
second and later pages is followed. Each enclosure’s
pages are numbered independently of the other
enclosures.
If an enclosure is to be mailed separately from
the basic letter, the notation (sep cover) is placed
after the enclosure’s description in the Enclosure
block.
Text
The text or main body of the letter begins on the
second line below the preceding line of typing on the
first and all succeeding pages. Paragraphing in the text
is identified by numbers or letters, as follows:
Finally, start a paragraph near the end of a page
only if that page has room for two lines or more.
Continue a paragraph on the following page only if two
lines or more can be carried over. Signature pages must
have at least two lines of text.
Signature Block
The signature is typed or stamped in block style,
starting at the center of the page, four lines below the
last line of the text. All the names are typed in capitals.
The grade of the signer is not included, and the title is
included only for a chief of staff, a deputy, an assistant
chief, or an official authorized to sign correspondence
or another official authorized to sign orders affecting
pay and allowances.
Copy To Block
The Copy to block is placed at the left margin on
the second line below the Signature block. Copy to
stands alone with the Copy to addressees listed starting
on the first line below. The addressees are listed by
abbreviated titles.
Copy to addressees receive the complete letter,
unless it is determined they hold certain enclosures
3-4
1. A main paragraph starts flush on the left margin
and is identified with a whole number followed by a
period.
a. The subdivisions of a paragraph are identi-
fied by lowercase alphabetical letters followed by a
period. These subdivisions are indented four spaces
from the left margin.
b. If you need to use subparagraphs, use at least
two of each type of subparagraph.
(1) Therefore, if subparagraphing reaches
this level, another paragraph is also required.
(2) The only time you do not need at least
two divisions is when there is only one main
paragraph in the letter.
(a) This is the limit to subparagraphing.
You should never subparagraph past this point.
Either reorganize the information to make new
major paragraphs, or continue on at this level.
(b) Each level of subparagraphing is
indented four spaces more than the previous level.
already, or have no need for a specific enclosure. (The
notation required in these cases was discussed earlier
in this chapter.)
You can review figure 3-1 and see where all the
previous information fits together.
Identifying Second and Later Pages
Repeat the subject shown on the first page on the
sixth line from the top of the second and all later pages.
Text continues on the second line following the
subject. Center page numbers 1/2 inch (three lines)
from the bottom edge of the paper, starting with
number 2. No punctuation accompanies a page
number. Figure 3-2 illustrates a continuation page.
Drafter’s Identification on File Copies
Figure 3-2 also il lustrates how drafter’s
identification is noted on file copies. Type, stamp, or
write the name of the writer, the writer’s office code,
the date of typing, the writer’s phone or room number
(or both), and the typist’s identification, if desired. The
previous information is placed on the last page.
JOINT LETTER
The joint letter shown in figure 3–3 is a variation of
the standard letter, where two or more commands wish
to issue information that establishes an agreement or
discusses a matter of mutual concern. Several changes
occur in preparation of such a letter.
The originators of the joint letter will be identified
two spaces below the letterhead. The senior
originating command’s information will appear on the
normal line, but will end flush with the right margin.
The words JOINT LETTER are typed two lines
below the date.
Signature blocks are arranged across the page,
with the senior official’s signature ending flush with
the right margin and the most junior official’s signature
beginning at the left margin. A third cosigner would be
centered on the page.
MULTIPLE-ADDRESS LETTER
A multiple-address letter is addressed to two or
more activities individually identified in the To block
or as a group in the Distribution block. It is typed in the
usual manner of a standard letter, with the exception
that more than one title is listed in the To block in
seniority order. Begin each new title on its own line.
Each addressee must receive a letterhead copy
with a signature. It can be an original copy or a
photocopy. If carbon copies are used, make sure
letterhead information is typed or stamped on each
copy and have each copy signed as an original. See
figures 3-4 and 3-5 for examples of multiple-address
letters.
ENDORSEMENTS
When a letter comes to your activity because you
are a Via addressee, your command must acknowledge
its receipt and provide comments to the other
addressees. For this purpose an endorsement is
prepared rather than another letter. Same-page
endorsements (fig. 3-6) are appropriate when
comments are brief and few or no record copies are
required. A new-page endorsement is necessary if
comments are long and multiple record copies are
required. A Via addressee may endorse a letter and
signify no comment by signing and placing the date
opposite the appropriate title in the Via block.
A new-page endorsement shown in figure 3-7 is
prepared on letterhead paper, and a typed endorsement
is prepared the same way as a standard letter except as
indicated.
Copies
In addition to the required file copies, a copy of the
endorsement is prepared for each remaining Via
addressee and for the originator of the basic letter.
When the endorsement is of particular significance, a
copy is provided to each prior endorser also.
Format
Each endorsement is numbered in the sequence in
which it is added to the basic letter. The number of the
endorsement, FIRST, SECOND, THIRD, and so on,
followed by the word ENDORSEMENT is typed at
the left margin on the second line below the date. This
is followed by the word on and identification of the
basic letter. The basic letter is identified in the same
way as in a normal Reference block. When the number
of the endorsement and the identification of the basic
letter exceed one line, the second and succeeding lines
begin flush with the word on.
Via Block
Only the remaining Via addressees, if any, are
listed in the endorsement’s Via block. They are left in
the same order, although they can be modified, if
necessary, and renumbered (1), (2), (3), and so on.
3-5
3-6
1
2
3
4 *DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
*Name of Activity
*Address
1
2 SSIC
Code/*Serial
*Date
1
2 From: Title of activity head, name of activity, location when needed
To: Title of activity head, name of activity, location when needed (Code)
Via: (1) Title of activity head, name of activity, location when needed
(not numbered if only one)
(2) Pattern of (1) repeated for next endorser
1
2 Subj: NORMAL WORD ORDER, ALL LETTERS CAPITALIZED
1
2 Ref: (a) Earlier communication that bears directly on subject at hand
1
2 Encl: (1) Material enclosed with letter identified in same way as reference,
single enclosure numbered
(2) Notation added for material sent separately (sep cover)
1
2 1. This example shows all the elements that might appear on the original of
a one-page standard letter.
2. If you omit the date when you type the letter, start the From block on
the fourth line below the code/serial to allow for an oversized date stamp.
3. Other examples in this chapter show the spacing to follow for
correspondence that variously omits Via, Reference, and Enclosure blocks.
1
2
3
4 *NAME OF SIGNER
*By direction
1
2 Copy to:
Short title of information addressee (see SNDL)
Short title of second information addressee
ITALICS: OPTIONAL ITEMSASTERISKS: ITEMS YOU MAY STAMP
UNDERLINED NUMBERS: TYPEWRITER LINES
Figure 3–1.—Sample standard letter.
3-7
1
2
3
4
5
6 SUBJ: NORMAL WORD ORDER, ALL LETTERS CAPITALIZED
1
2 This sample illustrates a file copy of a standard
letter's signature page. A second page should have at
least two lines of text.
a. If you use a Copy to block, type it on all copies.
b. If you use a Blind copy block, add it to internal
copies only.
c. If you identify the writer and typist, do so on the
file copy only.
d. A standard letter uses no complimentary close.
1
2
3
4 F. A. BRUSH
By direction
1
2 Copy to:
USS CLARK (FFG 11)
USS HALYBURTON (FFG 40)
1
2 Blind copy to:
387.2
967
Writer: P. T. Boat, 385.6, X74366
Typist: W. T. Door, 14 Oct 00
1
2
3
4
5
6 SUBJ: NORMAL WORD ORDER, ALL LETTERS CAPITALIZED
1
2 This sample illustrates a file copy of a standard
letter's signature page. A second page should have at
least two lines of text.
a. If you use a Copy to block, type it on all copies.
b. If you use a Blind copy to block, add it to
internal copies only.
c. If you identify the writer and typist, do so on
the file copy only.
d. A standard letter uses no complimentary close.
1
2
3
4 F. A. BRUSH
By direction
1
2 Copy to:
USS CLARK (FFG 11)
USS HALYBURTON (FFG 40)
1
2 Blind copy to:
387.2
967
Writer: P. T. Boat, 385.6, X74366
Typist: W. T. Door, 14 Oct 00
Figure 3–2.—Sample file copy of continuation page.
Reference Block
The references listed in the basic letter and in the
previous endorsement are not repeated. If a new
reference is introduced in your endorsement, it is
lettered in a continuous sequence from the basic letter
and/or preceding endorsements.
Enclosure Block
The enclosures listed in the basic letter and
previous endorsements are also not repeated. New
enclosures added are numbered in sequence from the
basic letter and/or preceding endorsements.
3-8
1
2
3
4 DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
Naval Sea Systems Command
Naval Supply Systems Command
Washington, DC 20314
1
2 NAVSUP NAVSEA
5216 5216
Ser 02/318 Ser 07/207
9 Mar 01 25 Mar 01
1
2
3 JOINT LETTER
1
2 From: Commander, Naval Sea Systems Command
Commander, Naval Supply Systems Command
To: Chief of Naval Operations
1
2 Subj: HOW TO PREPARE A JOINT LETTER
1. Use. A joint letter may be used to establish an
agreement between two or more commands or for other
matters of mutual concern.
2. Letterhead. On plain bond, list the command titles
in the letterhead area so the senior official is at the
top. If the activities are in different cities or
states, follow each title with its address.
3. Signatures. Arrange Signature blocks so the senior
is at the right. Place the Signature block of a third
cosigner in the middle of the page.
4. Copies. If your command is the last to sign, send
copies of the signed letter to all cosigners.
1
2
3
4 M. L. CHRISTMAS W. T. DOOR
Acting Deputy
Figure 3–3.—Sample joint letter.
Paging
The page number on an endorsement follows the
numbering of the basic letter and preceding
endorsements; that is, a two-page endorsement to a
three-page basic letter would be numbered 4 and 5.
MEMORANDUM
A memorandum provides an informal way to
correspond within an activity or between several
activities. Subordinates may use it to correspond
directly with each other on routine business.
3-9
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
COMMANDER IN CHIEF
UNITED STATES PACIFIC FLEET
PEARL HARBOR, HI 96860
1
2 5216
Ser N43/2735
8 Jul 00
1
2 From: Commander in Chief, U.S. Pacific Fleet
To: Commander, Third Fleet
Commander, Naval Air Force, U.S. Pacific Fleet
Commander, Naval Surface Force, U.S. Pacific Fleet
Commander, Submarine Force, U.S. Pacific Fleet
1
2 Subj: WHEN TO USE THE TO BLOCK BY ITSELF
1
2 1. If you have four addressees or less, list all of them in
a To block. If you have more than four addressees, list all
of them in a Distribution block.
2. Use only long titles in the To block.
1
2
3
4 P. T. BOAT
By direction
1
2 Copy to:
CHNAVMAT (MAT-05)
COMNAVSEASYSCOM (SEA-06)
Figure 3–4.—Sample multiple-address letter with to block.
3-10
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVYCOMMANDER NAVAL AIR FORCEUNITED STATES PACIFIC FLEET
NAVAL AIR STATION, NORTH ISLANDSAN DIEGO, CALIFORNIA 92123
1
2 5216
Ser N31/2406
7 Jun 00
1
2 From: Commander, Naval Air Force, U.S. Pacific Fleet
Subj: WHEN TO USE THE DISTRIBUTION BLOCK BY ITSELF
1. Drop the To block and add a Distribution block if you
have more than four individual action addressees or if you
vary the number of copies to any of the addressees. You
may list addressees in the Distribution block by SNDL short
titles or collective titles or both.
2. Like addressees shown in a To block, those shown in a
Distribution block are action addressees.
3. Arrange distribution and Copy to addressees in columns
if doing so will keep a letter from going to another page.
1
2
3
4 F. A. BRUSH
By direction
1
2 Distribution:
SNDL
42J2 (COMCARAIRWING PAC) (4 copies)
42K2 (ATKRON PAC)
42L2 (FITRON PAC)
USS ENTERPRISE (CVN 68)
1
2 Copy to:
CINCPACFLT (N35)
COMSEVENTHFLT (N3)
Figure 3–5.—Sample multiple-address letter with Distribution block.
3-11
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
NAVAL AIR STATION
PENSACOLA, FL 32508
1
2 5216
Ser 11/352
13 Jun 01
1
2 From: Commanding Officer, Naval Air Station, Pensacola
To: Commander in Chief, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
Via: (1) Commander, Sea Based ASW Wings, Atlantic
(2) Commander, Naval Air Force, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
1
2 Subj: HOW TO PREPARE ENDORSEMENTS
Encl: (1) Orientation Schedule for Newcomers
1. Same-page endorsements may be added to a basic letter, like this one, or
to a previous endorsement. This sentence cites enclosure (1).
1
2
3
4 J. T. BOAT
1
2 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
1
2 Ser 019/98
17 Jun 01
1
2 FIRST ENDORSEMENT
1
2 From: Commander, Sea Based ASW Wings, Atlantic
To: Commander in Chief, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
Via: Commander, Naval Air Force, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
1
2 1. Start an endorsement on the same page as the latest communication if the
answer to all three questions is yes:
a. Is the latest communication less than a page?
b. Will all of the endorsement fit on that page?
c. Is the endorsement sure to be signed without revision?
2. A same-page endorsement may omit the SSIC, subject, and basic letter's
identification as long as the entire page will be photocopied. These elements
also are required on all new-page endorsements, such as the one in figure 3-7.
1
2
3
4 MARY CHRISTMAS
1
2 Copy to:
NAS Pensacola (Code 11)
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
NAVAL AIR STATION
PENSACOLA, FL 32508
1
2 5216
Ser 11/352
13 Jun 01
1
2 From: Commanding Officer, Naval Air Station, Pensacola
To: Commander in Chief, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
Via: (1) Commander, Sea Based ASW Wings, Atlantic
(2) Commander, Naval Air Force, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
1
2 Subj: HOW TO PREPARE ENDORSEMENTS
Encl: (1) Orientation Schedule for Newcomers
1. Same-page endorsements may be added to a basic letter, like this one, or
to a previous endorsement. This sentence cites enclosure (1).
1
2
3
4 J. T. BOAT
1
2 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
1
2 Ser 019/98
17 Jun 01
1
2 FIRST ENDORSEMENT
1
2 From: Commander, Sea Based ASW Wings, Atlantic
To: Commander in Chief, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
Via: Commander, Naval Air Force, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
1
2 1. Start an endorsement on the same page as the latest communication if the
answer to all three questions is yes:
a. Is the latest communication less than a page?
b. Will all of the endorsement fit on that page?
c. Is the endorsement sure to be signed without revision?
2. A same-page endorsement may omit the SSIC, subject, and basic letter's
identification as long as the entire page will be photocopied. These elements
also are required on all new-page endorsements, such as the one in figure 3-7.
1
2
3
4 MARY CHRISTMAS
1
2 Copy to:
NAS Pensacola (Code 11)
Figure 3–6.—Sample same-page endorsement.
3-12
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVYCOMMANDER NAVAL AIR FORCEUNITED STATES ATLANTIC FLEET
NORFOLK, VA 23511
1
2 5216
Ser N72/4201
24 Jun 00
1
2 SECOND ENDORSEMENT on NAS Pensacola ltr 5216 Ser 11/352
of 3 Jun 00
1
2 From: Commander, Naval Air Force, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
To: Commander in Chief, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
1
2 Subj: HOW TO PREPARE ENDORSEMENTS
1
2 Encl: (2) SECNAVINST 5216.5D
1
2 1. Start an endorsement on a new page if the answer to one or
more of these questions is no:
a. Is the latest communication less than a page?
b. Will all of the endorsements fit on that page?
c. Is the endorsement sure to be signed without revision?
2. Number every page; continue the sequence of numbers from the
previous communication, as explained in enclosure (2).
3. Every new-page endorsement must
a. Repeat the basic letter's SSIC.
b. Identify the basic letter in the Endorsement-Number
block.
c. Use the basic letter's subject as its own.
1
2
3
4 V. C. PISTOL
By direction
1
2 Copy to:
NAS Pensacola (Code 11)
*COMSEABASEDASWWINGLANT (Code 019)
*Prior endorser appears because second endorsement is significant.
Figure 3–7.—Sample new-page endorsement.
The four formats from which you can choose are as
follows, starting with the most informal:
1. Printed Memorandum Form (OPNAV
5216/144)
2. Plain-paper memorandum
3. Letterhead memorandum
4. Memorandum For
Use the format that best suits the subject, occasion,
and audience.
Printed Memorandum Form
As the most informal, the printed memorandum
(fig. 3-8) is used among individuals and offices of the
same activity. Information is typed or written beside
preprinted entries, and the text is prepared the same
way as in a standard letter.
Plain-Paper Memorandum
When the required heading information (more
than one addressee or when Via addressees are needed)
prevents use of the printed memorandum, the
plain-paper memorandum is used (fig. 3-9). It is
prepared on plain white bond, placing the date at the
right margin, 1 inch from the top of the page. The word
MEMORANDUM is typed at the left margin on the
second line below the date. The From line is typed on
the second line below MEMORANDUM, and all
subsequent lines follow the rules of the standard letter.
Letterhead Memorandum
When a subordinate office is authorized direct
liaison outside the command, the letterhead
memorandum is used (fig. 3-10). It provides more
formality and information to the recipient that is not
available in the plain-paper memorandum. Standard
letter rules apply, once again adding the word
MEMORANDUM after the date and before the From
block. A sender’s Information block is usually used in
this case.
Memorandum For
The memorandum for is the most formal
memorandum (fig. 3-11). It may be used in writing to
senior officials who traditionally have used it.
Among them are the Secretary of Defense and the
Secretary of the Navy. A sender’s Information block is
used. The From and To blocks, however, are not. The
words MEMORANDUM FOR THE followed by the
title of the official to receive the memorandum are
typed on the second line below the date. If more than
one official is to be sent the memorandum, second and
subsequent titles are listed directly under the first word
after “THE.”
Since this format does not have a From block, show
the signer’s title below the typed name in the Signature
block. Use all other rules of the standard letter.
BUSINESS LETTER
The business letter (fig. 3-12) is used to correspond
with agencies or individuals outside the Department of
the Navy who are unfamiliar with the standard naval
letter. It may also be used for correspondence between
individuals within the Navy when the occasion calls
for a personal approach. The business letter is always
prepared on letterhead paper.
Since the business letter has no From block, all
copies going outside the command must have the
letterhead information stamped or printed on them.
The determining factor in setting the margins is the
letter’s length. A letter less than one page long is
centered to give it a well-balanced appearance (fig.
3-13). The text may even be double-spaced to aid in
balancing if it runs eight lines or less.
Sender’s Information and Markings
The sender’s Information block is the same as a
standard letter. Special postal service markings are
placed on the left margin two lines below the date. Any
classification markings are placed on the line below the
special postal instruction, if any. All other
classification marking requirements are the same as in
a standard letter.
Address
The address begins at the left margin and,
depending on the length of the letter, should be placed
on the second line below the previous block. The
exception to this is when the letter is short (fig. 3-13)
and the body of the letter must be lowered to balance it
on the paper. The address is typed block style,
single-spaced, and should be at least three but no more
than four lines long.
Salutation
The salutation, followed by a colon, is typed at the
left margin on the second line below the address. A list
3-13
of standard salutation formats is contained in the Navy
Correspondence Manual.
Text
The text begins on the second line after the
salutation. It is normally single-spaced within
paragraphs; avoid indenting or numbering main
paragraphs. Indent the first lines of subparagraphs four
spaces; subparagraphs may be lettered and numbered
in standard letter fashion.
Complimentary Close
Use “Sincerely,” for the complimentary close of a
business letter. Start typing at the center of the page on
the second line below the text.
3-14
OPNAV 5216/144A (Rev.8-81) DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVYS/N 0107-LF-052-2320
MemorandumDATE: 3 Mar 00
FROM: OP-09BR (77256)
TO: OP-09B
SUBJ: PRINTED MEMORANDUM FORM
Ref: (a) SECNAVINST 5216.5D
Encl: (1) Personnel Roster
1. This printed form is the most informal memorandum. Use it among individuals and offices
of the same activity.
2. The memorandum comes in three sizes.
a. OPNAV 5216/144A (8 1/2 by 11 inches)
b. OPNAV 5216/144B (8 1/2 by 5 1/2 inches)
c. OPNAV 5216/144C (5 1/2 by 8 1/2 inches)
3. Except for the date, no sender's symbols are necessary.
4. Use names, titles, or codes in the From block and To block.
5. Allow a 1-inch margin.
6. Type reference and enclosure headings under the printed headings. Note the headings for
reference (a) and enclosure (1).
7. The writer signs his or her name without an authority line.
8. Very informal memorandums may be penned.
9. No file copy is necessary when the matter is insignificant or shortlived.
Figure 3–8.—Sample printed memorandum form.
Signature
Start all lines of the Signature block at the center of
the page on the fourth line below “Sincerely.” Type or
stamp the following information:
• Name of signer in all capital letters
• Military grade (if any) spelled out
• Functional title
• By direction of the (senior official’s title), if
appropriate
References and Enclosures
The business letter does not provide for a
Reference block. Any references are mentioned in the
text only. Enclosures are both mentioned in the text
and then described briefly in an Enclosure block. Type
Encl: at the left margin on the second line below the
Signature block and list the enclosures beneath the
heading. The rules for marking special distribution of
enclosures are the same as in a standard letter.
Copy to Block
If everyone should know that a particular
addressee will receive an information copy, show that
addressee in the Copy to block. Use long titles for
activities listed in the SNDL. Type the words Copy to
with a colon at the left margin on the second line below
the previous block (Enclosure block, if any, or the
3-15
1
2
3
4
5
6 10 Sep 00
1
2 MEMORANDUM
1
2 From: Head, Organization and Directives Branch (Code 211)
To: Head, Technical Library Branch (Code 111)
Head, Mail and Files Branch (Code 112)
Via: Head, Office Services Division (Code 110)
1
2 Subj: PLAIN-PAPER MEMORANDUM
1. The plain-paper memorandum may be used within your
activity.
2. It is no more formal than the memorandum form, but it is
more flexible when there are multiple addressees, via
addressees, or both.
3. Prepare a plain-paper memorandum on white bond.
1
2
3
4 P. T. BOAT
Figure 3–9.—Sample plain-paper memorandum.
Signature block). Addressees are listed beginning on
the next line at the left margin.
MESSAGES
This portion of the chapter will introduce you to
basic message traffic format (MTF). Although there
are many types and modes of communications, the
basic naval message must conform to a standard format
with few exceptions. As a YN, you need to be familiar
with all of them.
COMMON MESSAGE ELEMENTS
Before covering the basic format of military
messages, we will first discuss the time system,
precedence categories, and speed-of-service
objectives used in naval communications.
Time
Time is one of the most important elements in
communications. Messages are normally identified
and filed by either a date-time-group (DTG) or a Julian
date, depending on the method of transmission.
Date-Time-Group
The DTG is assigned for identification and file
purposes only. The DTG consists of six digits. The
first two digits represent the date, the second two digits
represent the hour, and the third two digits represent
the minutes. For example,
221327Z AUG 00
means the 22nd day of August, plus the time in
Greenwich Mean Time (GMT). The dates from the first
to the ninth of the month are preceded by a zero.
This designation is followed by a zone suffix and
the month and year. The month is expressed by its first
three letters, and the year by the last two digits of year
of origin; for example,
081050Z AUG 00
3-16
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVYNAVAL AIR STATION
PENSACOLA, FL 32508
1
2 5216
Memo 28/95
18 May 00
1
2 MEMORANDUM
1
2 From: Head, Management Services Department
To: Operations Officer, Navy Regional Data Automation
Center, Pensacola
1
2 Subj: LETTERHEAD MEMORANDUM
1. When direct liaison is authorized and the matter is
routine, a memorandum (on letterhead paper) may be sent
outside your activity.
2. When used within an activity, the letterhead memorandum
provides more formality than the printed memorandum form.
1
2
3
4 P. T. BOAT
Figure 3–10.—Sample letterhead memorandum.
The zone suffix ZULU (Z), for GMT, is used as the
universal time for all messages.
Greenwich Mean Time
In naval communications, the DTG is computed
from a common worldwide standard. To meet the need
for worldwide time standardization, the international
GMT system was developed. Greenwich, England, is
the location from which all worldwide time is
determined. The GMT system uses a 24-hour clock
instead of the two 12-hour cycles used in the normal
civilian world.
Julian Date
The Julian date consists of three digits. They
represent the day of the year. The first day of the
calendar year is Julian 001, and each day is numbered
consecutively thereafter. For example, in Julian, “032”
would be the 32nd day of the calendar year (February 1).
Precedence
The message drafter indicates the desired
writer-to-reader delivery time through the assignment
of a message precedence. Although the drafter
determines the precedence, the releaser should either
confirm or change it.
The following paragraphs list the various
precedence categories, their indicators, and basic
definitions:
ROUTINE (R). Processed within 6 hours. This
category is assigned to all types of traffic that justify
electrical transmission but which are not of sufficient
urgency to require a higher precedence.
PRIORITY (P). Processed within 3 hours. This
category is reserved for messages that furnish essential
information for the conduct of operations in progress.
This is the highest precedence normally authorized for
administrative messages.
3-17
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVYOFFICE OF THE CHIEF OF NAVAL OPERATIONS
WASHINGTON, DC 20350
IN REPLY REFER TO
5216
Ser 943D/34507
11 Mar 01
1
2 MEMORANDUM FOR THE DEPUTY CHIEF OF NAVAL OPERATIONS
1
2 Subj: THE MEMORANDUM FOR
1. The memorandum for is the most formal memorandum. It may
be used in writing to senior officials who traditionally have
used it. Among them are the Secretary of Defense and the
Secretary of the Navy.
2. Because the memorandum for lacks a From block, show the
signer's title below the typed name.
3. Multiple addressees are listed as shown above.
1
2
3
4 W. T. DOOR
Director, Navy Space Systems
Division
Figure 3–11.—Sample memorandum for.
IMMEDIATE (O). Processed within 30 minutes.
This category is reserved for messages relating to
situations that gravely affect the national forces or
populace and that require immediate delivery to
addressees.
FLASH (Z). Processed as fast as possible with an
objective of less than 10 minutes. This category is
reserved for initial enemy contact reports or
operational combat messages of extreme urgency;
message brevity is mandatory.
Precedence is assigned according to urgency,
based solely on writer-to-reader time, not according to
the importance of the subject matter or the text. For
example, an unclassified message may be assigned an
IMMEDIATE precedence, whereas a Secret message
may be assigned a ROUTINE precedence. In this
situation, the unclassified message requires fast action
or response, whereas the Secret message may not
require any action at all.
Address Component
The address component contains the designation
of the originating station identified by the originator
prosign FM (meaning “from”). Prosign TO contains
3-18
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVYUSS CUSHING (DD 985)
FPO AP 96662
1
2 5216Ser DD 985/28January 5, 2001
1
2 Coover Precision, Inc.Attn: J. Doe6923 W. Hobson Blvd.New York, NY 11378
1
2 Gentlemen:1
2 When writing to a company in general but directing your letter to a particular person oroffice, use an attention line between the company's name and its address. Type Attn: and then aname or title.
Make the salutation agree with the first line of the address. If the first line is a companyname, the salutation is Gentlemen even if the attention line directs the letter to an individual.Note the inside address and salutation in this letter.
1
2 Sincerely,1
2
3
4 F. A. BRUSHCommander, U.S. NavyExecutive OfficerBy direction of theCommanding Officer
1
2 Encl:(1) Correspondence Manual (sep cover)
Figure 3–12.—Sample business letter.
the designation(s) of the action addressee(s), if any.
Prosign INFO contains the designation(s) of the
information addressee(s), if any.
Addressee designations in the address component
may be call signs, address groups, plain language
designators, or a combination of routing indicators and
plain language designators.
The separation sign BT, meaning “break,”
provides a distinct separation between the heading and
the text and between the text and the ending.
Text
The text is the part of the message that contains the
thought or idea that the drafter desires to communicate.
3-19
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVYNAVAL EDUCATION AND TRAINING
PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT AND TECHNOLOGY CENTERPENSACOLA, FL 32509
1
2 5216
Code 53
8 Apr 01
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 Ms Mary Christmas
J. M. Corporation
287 Duke Street
Newton, CA 93333
Dear Ms Christmas:
Use any or all of three techniques to balance the appearance of a letter that would run
eight lines or less if typed normally. Start the address more than two lines below the date,
use side margins as wide as 2 inches, and double-space throughout the text of the letter.
Indent paragraphs of a short business letter if you have two or more.
1
2 Sincerely,
1
2
3
4 FLOSS A. BRUSH
Head, Management Services
By direction of the Commander
Figure 3–13.—Sample short business letter.
In drafting the text for transmission, the drafter
should strive for brevity through the proper choice of
words and good writing technique. However, brevity
must never be achieved at the expense of accuracy or
clarity. Uncommon phrases and modes of expression
can render the meaning of a message ambiguous or
obscure.
The text must be worded so that it unmistakably
expresses the thoughts to be conveyed. All
abbreviations must be limited to those meanings that
are self-evident or those that are recognizable by virtue
of long-established use. We will now discuss some of
the more important requirements concerning the text
of a message.
CLASSIFICATION LINE.—The classification
line is the first line of the text and immediately follows
the BT that separates the heading and text. This line
indicates the message classification and, when
applicable, special-handling markings, codes, or flag
words. This line also provides the SSIC.
For United States use, the three security
classification designators are Confidential, Secret,
and Top Secret. The acronyms FOUO (For Official
Use Only) and EFTO (Encrypt For Transmission
Only) are not classification designators. They are used
with the designation UNCLAS in the classification
line.
Restricted Data and Formerly Restricted Data
are similar except that they are used with classification
designators. You can find information concerning the
criteria and handling of FOUO and EFTO messages in
the Telecommunications Users Manual, NTP 3.
SPECIAL-HANDLING MARKINGS .—
Certain types of messages require special handling in
addition to that provided by the security classification.
These special markings are placed in the classification
line immediately following the classification. Some of
the more common special-handling markings that you
will see are the following:
• Special Category (SPECAT)
• Limited Distribution (LIMDIS)
• PERSONAL FOR
SPECAT messages come in two variations. One
type includes both the general SPECAT and the
SPECAT Single Integrated Operat ional
Plan—Extremely Sensitive Information (SPECAT
SIOP-ESI).
The other type of SPECAT message is SPECAT
EXCLUSIVE FOR (SEF). SEF is used only within
the naval community for highly sensitive matters,
high-level policy, or when politically sensitive
information is to be passed only to a particular
individual. The classification line would then contain
the name of that individual. For example, a Secret
message destined exclusively for Admiral W. T. Door
would read:
SECRET SPECAT EXCLUSIVE FOR
ADM W. T. DOOR //N00000//
SEF messages are reserved for use by flag officers
and officers in a command status. These messages are
not intended for use in operational matters, and they
may not be readdressed or referenced in other narrative
messages.
Only those personnel who are authorized to view
them, as approved in writing by the CO, handle
SPECAT messages.
LIMDIS messages are associated with special
projects, cover names, or specific subjects. These
messages require limited distribution within the
addressed activity to those personnel with a need to
know and who are specifically authorized by the
command to have access to the information. Only
classified messages qualify for the special-handling
marking LIMDIS. However, the classification is still
assigned according to the subject matter. The
classification line of a Secret LIMDIS message would
read SECRET LIMDIS.
PERSONAL FOR messages may be unclassified
or classified and are reserved for flag rank and
command status officers. Distribution of these
messages is limited to the named recipient (who may
direct further distribution). In PERSONAL FOR
messages, the classification line always shows the
name or title of the intended recipient and may show
the name or title of the originator.
PERSONAL FOR messages are used only by and
addressed only to Navy commands.
STANDARD SUBJECT IDENTIFICATION
CODE.—The SSIC identifies the subject matter of the
message. The SSIC is preceded and followed by two
slant signs. For example:
UNCLAS E F T O FOUO //N02000//
The SSIC always contains five digits corresponding to
the particular subject matter, preceded by the letter N.
With few exceptions, an SSIC is required on all naval
messages. Those messages without SSICs are normally
3-20
returned to the drafter. Many automated systems route
message traffic by the SSIC.
SSICs are contained in Department of the Navy
File Maintenance Procedures and Standard Subject
Identification Codes, SECNAVINST 5210.11 series.
PASSING AND DELIVERY INSTRUCTIONS.—
The majority of naval automated message processing
systems rely on specific elements at the beginning of
the text. These elements may be flag words, code
words, subject lines, and outgoing/incoming message
references. These elements serve as guides and assist
the automated internal routing of messages. Special
delivery instructions, such as FOR, FROM, and PASS
TO are additional means of indicating that the text of
the message is to receive the attention of the indicated
individual or office without necessarily limiting the
normal distribution.
Special delivery instructions, when used, follow
the SSIC. These instructions are used for exceptional
cases not covered by use of office codes in the address.
Passing instructions must not be separated into an
individual paragraph of the text. They should follow
the SSIC and can continue on the line immediately
following the classification and SSIC.
SUBJECT LINE.—The subject line indicates the
basic contents of the message. Internal message
routers and Navy automated message processing
systems key on the subject to determine internal
message distribution. Therefore, messages containing
similar information should be assigned a standard
subject whenever possible to facilitate message
identification and internal distribution.
The subject line of a message begins at the
left-hand margin immediately following the
classification line with the characters SUBJ.
REFERENCE LINES.—Reference lines are
used to avoid repeating lengthy quotations or
references within the text of a message. A reference
may be any message, document, correspondence, or
telephone conversation that is pertinent to the message.
When a reference is referred to in the text, it would
be called REF A, REF B, or REF C, as applicable.
INDENTING.—The classification, subject, and
reference set lines will always begin at the left-hand
margin. Textual material may be indented a maximum
of 20 spaces for clarity.
REMARKS.—The RMKS (remarks) set begins
the actual text. The message may contain several
subjects or several aspects of one subject. For this
reason, textual material is divided into paragraphs and
subparagraphs (numbered and lettered consecutively).
CLASSIFICATION AND PARAGRAPH
MARKINGS.—When a message is classified, the
subject line, all paragraphs, and subparagraphs are
marked with the appropriate classification symbol.
This eliminates any doubt in the reader’s mind as to the
classification of a particular paragraph.
PUNCTUATION.—Punctuation is used within
the text of a message when essential for clarity.
MINIMIZE CONSIDERED.—During an actual
or simulated emergency, it may become necessary to
reduce the volume of record and/or voice
communications ordinarily transmitted over U.S.
military telecommunications circuits. This action,
known as MINIMIZE, is des igned to clear
communications networks of messages that are not
considered urgent. Only those messages that affect the
accomplishment of a mission or safety of life are
considered essential and, therefore, require electronic
transmission during MINIMIZE periods.
The releasing officer must review messages that
have not been released during MINIMIZE periods.
The releasing officer must determine if a message can
be sent via another means or if it must be sent
electrically via telecommunications circuits. If the
releasing officer releases a message for transmission,
the words MINIMIZE CONSIDERED and
RELEASED BY must be included.
DOWNGRADING INSTRUCTIONS.—All
classified messages must contain a downgrading or
declassification instruction with the exception of
Restricted Data and Formerly Restricted Data
messages.
GENERAL MESSAGES
General messages provide a standard distribution
to a large group of addressees and are identified by a
repetitive short title (for example, ALNAV, NAVOP,
JAFPUB).
All commands to whom general messages are
distributed are action addressees. However, each
command receiving a general message is responsible
for determining what action, if any, it needs to take on
the message.
Although general messages have a wide,
standardized distribution, all addressees may not need
3-21
to take action. However, commands are required to
keep a continuous numerical file of all general
messages for which they are on the distribution list and
that they receive. Consequently, the general message
files should contain every general message received
during the calendar year, in numerical order. The
general message files are separate from all other files
and are subdivided according to identifying title or
type.
PRO FORMA MESSAGES
Pro forma messages are messages whose subject
matter and sequence of textual content are preset and
cannot be changed by the originator.
MINIMIZE MESSAGES
Minimize means, “It is now mandatory that normal
message and telephone traffic be reduced drastically so
that vital messages connected with the situation
indicated will not be delayed.”
A message ordering MINIMIZE consists of the
word MINIMIZE, followed by the area affected
(scope), reason, and duration of the MINIMIZE
condition (when known).
COMMUNICATIONS GUARD SHIFT
MESSAGES
Communications guard shift (COMMSHIFT)
messages are required when a command shifts its
guard from one broadcast or servicing communica-
tions center to another. When possible, the shift takes
effect at 0001Z of the new radio day. When broadcasts
are shifted, an overlap period before and after the
effective time is observed to ensure continuity of
t ra ffic . Deta i led informat ion concern ing
communications guard shift messages and formats is
contained in Naval Telecommunications Publication 4
(NTP-4).
MESSAGE AND ROUTING ADDRESSEES
Messages may be divided into types, according to
the way they are addressed, as follows:
SINGLE-ADDRESS. A message that has only
one addressee, which may be either for action or
information.
MULTIPLE-ADDRESS. A message that has two
or more addressees, which may be either action or
information and where each addressee is informed of
all other recipients.
BOOK. A message destined for two or more
addressees but where the drafter considers it
unnecessary that each addressee be informed of other
addressees. Book messages are routed according to
each addressee’s relay station. All unnecessary
addressees are deleted from the face of the message
before being sent to the addressee(s) served by that
particular relay station.
GENERAL MESSAGE. A message that has a
wide, predetermined, standard distribution. General
messages are normally titled with a sequential number
for the current year; for example, ALCOM 28/01,
NAVOP 30/01. The title indicates distribution and
serves as the address designator.
Address Indicating Groups
The purpose of address indicating groups (AIGs)
is to increase the speed-of-traffic handling. They
shorten the message address by providing a single
address group to represent a large number of
addressees. This eliminates individual designators for
each address used in the heading.
Message Addresses
Absolute consistency in the format and spelling of
a plain language address (PLA) was not critical before
the implementation of automated message-processing
systems. Because communications personnel
processed all messages, deviations in address spelling
were tolerated. This is no longer true. Message
drafters must now verify the PLA for each addressee in
the Message Address Directory (MAD) and not rely on
memory or copy PLAs from incoming messages.
Message Address Directory
The MAD contains authorized message addresses
and is divided into sections: Joint Department of
Defense (JDOD PLAD); U.S. Military Communi-
cations—Electronics Board Publication (MCEB Pub
6), Army, Air Force, and Navy. The Navy section,
“U.S. Navy Plain Language Address Directory (USN
PLAD 1),” includes message addresses for Marine
Corps and Coast Guard activities. MAD updates are
published four times a year to ensure all addresses are
current.
3-22
Plain Language Addresses
The PLAs listed in USN PLAD 1 are the only
designators authorized for use in message addressing
to Navy, Marine Corps, and Coast Guard activities.
Deviations from USN PLAD 1 in spelling, spacing, or
formatting cannot be tolerated because automated
message-processing systems are keyed to USN PLAD
1 entries.
Office Codes
Office codes are required for all Navy shore
activity PLAs. Office codes follow the PLA and are
enclosed in double slants; for example, CNO
WASHINGTON DC//094//. There is no limit on the
number of office codes that can be used with a PLA.
When multiple office codes are used with a PLA, the
first code is the action code. A single slant separates
multiple codes. For example:
CNO WASHINGTON DC//094/611//
If an office code is not known, the code //JJJ// is used after
the PLA. Office codes are not used with AIGs, CADs, or
PLAs in pro forma messages. NTP-3 has further
information concerning office codes used with PLAs.
MESSAGE USER RESPONSIBILITIES
A message user is any individual authorized to
draft , release, and/or process electronically
t ransmi t ted messages . There are cer ta in
responsibilities associated with the origination of a
message. These responsibilities are separate and
distinct and concern the following parties:
• Originator
• Drafter
• Releaser
Occasionally, the responsibilities may overlap,
especially if one person is serving a dual capacity. For
example, administrative officers may occasionally
draft and release messages, thus making them both
drafters and releasers.
Originator
The originator is the authority (command or
activity) in whose name the message is sent. The
originator is presumed to be the CO of the command or
activity. Most often, the originator and the releaser are
one and the same. In some cases, the drafter, releaser,
and originator are all the same person. For example, if
the CO drafts a message for transmission, he or she is
the drafter as well as the releasing authority for the
activity in whose name the message is sent.
Drafter
The drafter is the person who actually composes
the message. According to NTP-3, the drafter is
responsible for the following:
• Addressing and using PLAs correctly
• Ensuring clear, concise composition
• Selecting the precedence
• Ensuring the proper format
• Assigning the proper classification
• Ensuring the application of proper downgrading
and declassification instructions to classified
messages, except those containing Restricted
Data or Formerly Restricted Data
Releaser
The releaser is a properly designated individual
authorized to release messages for transmission in the
name of the command or activity. The releasing
individual makes sure that the drafter has complied
with the requirements contained in the NTP-3. In
addition to validating the contents of the message, the
signature of the releaser affirms compliance with
message-drafting instructions. The signature of the
releaser authorizes the message for transmission.
MESSAGE FORMAT
General administrative (GENADMIN) is the
format used for most narrative messages. The
exceptions are those narrative messages for which a
publication, instruction, or other directive requires a
different format. There are other formats for
special-purpose messages. These messages include
casualty reports (CASREPs), movement reports
(MOVREPs), and Status of Resources and Training
System (SORTS). Instructions for preparing these
messages are found in appropriate publications.
SUMMARY
This chapter has reviewed the formats used in
naval correspondence and messages. Although some
of these formats may seem complicated, the more you
type them, the easier they will become. Refer to the
references listed in this chapter frequently; they will
answer any question you may have.
3-23
CHAPTER 4
PROCESSING CORRESPONDENCE/MESSAGES
In chapter 3, we described how correspondence
and messages are prepared. In this chapter, we will deal
with the just-as-important step of making sure the
word is passed the methods of packaging,
addressing, and controlling the sending and receiving
of correspondence and messages.
OFFICIAL MAIL
Official mail consists of communications,
publications, and other material transmitted through
the postal system or other official distribution systems
that relate exclusively to the business of the
Department of the Navy. Official mail, when it is sent
through the postal system, is transmitted in an
envelope that is either “official mail” metered or bears
United States Postal Service (USPS) stamps. If the
contents are not exclusively Navy business, you cannot
use official mail postage. Do not enclose unofficial
material or personal material with official mail.
ENVELOPES
Envelopes are available through the supply
system. They will bear in the upper left-hand corner
the words Department of the Navy above the return
address and the printed words Official Business below
the return address. These endorsements must be
printed by a mechanical means. Envelopes come in
various sizes. Letter-size that accommodates 8
1/2-inch by 11-inch paper folded in thirds is used
unless the document is too bulky. If the document
cannot be folded or should not be folded (such as a
certificate), then sizes allowing flat mailing are
available.
PREPARATION OF ENVELOPES
The Standard Navy Distribution List (SNDL)
should be used for making sure you are using the
proper address. This cannot be overemphasized. If the
address is wrong, your correspondence will not be
delivered. Increased use of optical character readers
by the post office makes it important that envelopes be
addressed correctly. When you type envelopes, make
sure you single-space. Do not use italic or artistic
fonts. Type the address block style, in all caps,
beginning about one-third the length of the envelope
from the left side and halfway down from the top. The
return address is typed in the space indicated at the
upper-left corner.
The city, state, and full nine-digit ZIP Code appear
in sequence on the bottom line. Not less than two nor
more than six spaces should be left between the last
letter of the state and first digit of the ZIP Code. The
street address or box number is placed on the line
above the city, state, and ZIP Code line. Box numbers
and street addresses should never be combined on the
same line. An Attention line, if used, should be placed
above the street or box number so as not to interfere
with optical scanning, which generally begins
scanning the bottom line first.
TYPES OF MAIL SERVICE
The postal classification and type of mail service
determine the means of transmission, speed of
delivery, security, control, and cost of mailing.
Postcards and conventional letter-size sealed
envelopes automatically receive First-Class service
without special markings. Larger unsealed envelopes
and parcels containing printed matter must be marked
with the special mail service requirement.
FIRST-CLASS MAIL
First-Class Mail is given priority handling over
lower classes of mail throughout the postal service.
Transportation within the domestic system is by airlift
or expedited surface delivery. Official First-Class Mail
is normally sent by commercial air transportation from
the continental United States to overseas areas of
delivery when addressed to an activity with an FPO or
APO address.
REGISTERED MAIL
Registered mail receives added protection because
of its value and importance. It is the safest means of
any mail service since, from the time a piece is mailed,
someone is always personally responsible to account
for it.
4-1
The postal service provides the sender with a
receipt and an identification number for each article
received. The identification number is also placed on
the item at the time of mailing and is used throughout
the delivery process. Each person who handles the
article maintains a continuous chain of receipts. The
person who signed the receipt last is responsible for the
item until the person to whom the article is addressed
signs a receipt.
The post office that services your command
provides an incoming and outgoing registered mail
log. If this log is used properly, it will help you to
pinpoint the date a specific piece of mail was sent or
received. It should include the registered identification
number, identification of the subject matter, the
addressee, and the signature of the person receiving the
material from you. The Department of the Navy
(DON) Information Securi ty Program (ISP)
Regulation (SECNAVINST 5510.36 series) and
chapter 8 of this course provide more information on
how the registered mail system is used to transmit
classified information.
EXPRESS MAIL
Express Mail is the class of mail afforded the
highest priority in handling and provides highly
reliable service. Use Express Mail only when it is the
most cost-effective way to accomplish a mission
within time, security, and accountability constraints.
Heads of the Department of Defense are authorized to
approve the use of Express Mail. Tenant commands
must request approval from the host installation to use
Express Mail when the host provides the postage and
fees for the tenant’s mail.
CERTIFIED MAIL
Certified mail is a postal service that provides the
sender with a mailing receipt. A record of delivery is
kept at the post office. Service is limited to First-Class
mailing of material requiring restricted delivery. The
sender is given a receipt and a record is made of
delivery to the post office. The addressee completes a
record of delivery that accompanies the piece of mail
that is then returned to you.
CLASSIFIED MAIL
Chapter 8 of this NRTC gives the procedures for
processing classified material.
HANDLING INCOMING MAIL
You may be assigned to handle incoming mail in
any department or office to which you are attached. In
a departmental office aboard a ship, such an
assignment may not involve a very large amount of
mail. If you are in the captain’s office, however, you
will be handling all the official mail for the ship. In any
case, it is important that you know what happens to
incoming mail.
The volume of mail received by naval activities
today makes it desirable to eliminate unnecessary
operations wherever possible. In doing so, however, it
is important to make sure adequate records of all
important correspondence are maintained. Experience
and judgment are required to determine which mail
need not be controlled, which should be controlled,
and how the necessary controls can be maintained.
The steps that take place when official mail comes
aboard a Navy ship or shore activity are basically the
same. They are sorting and opening, routing, and
controlling (where required).
Although this process takes place everywhere,
differences between conditions aboard ship and those
of a shore-based office cause some of the operations to
be done differently. We will look at shipboard and
shore-based procedures separately.
INCOMING MAIL ABOARD SHIP
Mail delivered to a naval vessel falls into two broad
groups: official mail and personal mail for members of
the ship’s company. Personal mail is, of course, delivered
unopened to the individual to whom it is addressed.
Official mail addressed to the commanding officer (CO)
is taken to the captain’s office where the Yeoman (YN)
opens it. Standard Organization and Regulations of the
U.S. Navy (SORM), OPNAVINST 3120.32C, section
620.5, contains detailed guidance for processing
incoming and outgoing correspondence.
Classified Mail
Classified mail is logged in separate logs for
Confidential and Secret. The mail YN opens the outer
envelope, then delivers the inner envelope unopened to
the command security manager or clerk, who signs for
it in the mail log.
Unclassified Mail
Some ships maintain an unclassified logbook
containing similar information found in the classified
4-2
material logbooks. Other ships find this too bulky or
time-consuming and log only important documents,
such as those requiring action. Action correspondence
may be also tracked by correspondence control slips.
Your supervisor will train you in the specific
requirements of your ship.
Route Slips
Route (or control) slips are placed on mail as
required by local practice. Figure 4-1 is a sample
automated Navy route slip. You will fill in the blocks
identifying the material and the route slip number and
pass it to the office supervisor. This person indicates
on the slip the department heads to whom the
correspondence should go for action and those who
should see it for information.
Departmental Routing
Large shipboard departments sometimes indicate
internal routing to make sure the correspondence
reaches all within the department who should see it.
The additional routing is also indicated on the control
slip. This keeps track of the document to help keep it
moving and to make sure it is returned to the captain’s
office or to the next department without undue delay.
Copies of Incoming Correspondence
Sometimes more copies of a document are needed
to ensure proper action is being taken. You may also
need to retain a copy at your desk during the time the
original is being routed. If you do make a copy for this
purpose, you can destroy it when the original is
returned and action has been taken.
Attaching Background Material
Before you route correspondence to the person
who is to take action, make sure you attach all previous
related correspondence and documents such as charts
or blueprints. This preparation saves the time of the
person who must take action. If the background
materials are in the captain’s office, they are attached
before the letter goes to the department head. If they
are retained in the department, the YN assigned there
attaches them before delivering the letter to the
department head. Don’t delay delivery of mail while
you conduct a search for these papers, however.
INCOMING MAIL ASHORE
In large headquarters organizations, and in other
naval shore activities, there is much less personal mail.
However, the official mail load may be quite large and
require a large mailroom with several persons opening
and sorting.
Incoming mail may be given three sortings, at
which every effort should be made to separate out as
much as possible for delivery without further
processing. Small volume may result in sortings being
combined. Mail that passes on to the second and third
stage should do so only because it requires the
additional processing given at each of these steps. The
trick is to release it at the earliest possible sort to avoid
unnecessary handling.
Figure 4-2 shows the three sortings and action
generated by each, and each is explained more fully in
following paragraphs.
Initial Sorting
On receipt, mail is given an initial sorting that
separates mail that can be delivered without opening.
This is identified by “Attention To” lines in the
address, or knowing by experience that letters from
certain commands can be forwarded directly to a
specific department. The use of a sorting box comes in
handy for the initial sort. Letters to be opened go in one
place, and the others can be placed directly into a space
marked for the receiving department.
Secondary Sorting
After the initial sorting, the mail that was not
directly routed is opened. After opening, it is again
sorted. At this time, routine mail (mail that presents no
special problem) is separated from mail that is
nonroutine. The sorter does not read further than
necessary to determine if a letter is routine, and when
satisfied that no special action is required, the
document is forwarded directly to the appropriate
department. During secondary sorting, mail is checked
for enclosures, but mail should not be delayed awaiting
missing enclosures. Indicate on the control slip (if
used) that enclosures were not received, or make a
notation to that effect on the document itself if it is
forwarded directly to a department.
Time-stamping, if required, is done at the
secondary sorting. Use it only on congressional mail,
claims, or contracts. It is not recommended that all
mail be time-stamped. This just adds another event that
could delay delivery.
4-3
Sorting for Control
Mail that remains for the third sorting includes that
for which the action person is not readily apparent and
mail that requires control. The main purpose of this
sorting is to make sure mail requiring control receives
it.
Routing
Mail that does not require control is routed without
the use of a route slip or mail control form. The office
code and file symbol are placed on the letter itself.
When mail is being routed to several offices, a
stamp may be used with check boxes for several
addressees (fig. 4-3).
PRINCIPLES OF MAIL CONTROL
Mail control is defined in the Navy as any
procedure used to make a record of the receipt,
location, or dispatch of mail. The definition includes
logging or preparing other records to indicate receipt,
providing signature for classified and registered mail if
required, following up to ensure action, and providing
information on location of the item.
The mail control form, already mentioned as a
device for routing mail, is a combination of a mail log
and a route sheet. It may also serve as a follow-up
record and cross-reference sheet. The routing is
marked on the control form. Space is provided for the
initials of addressees and for their comments or notes
regarding action. The date of the letter and date of its
receipt are included. In the cases of mail requiring
action by a specific date, a follow-up date is added.
Maintaining a tickler system for action correspon-
dence is important. Whenever you use a control form,
retain one of the copies so you know when the response
is required to leave the command.
HANDLING OUTGOING MAIL
With outgoing mail, as with incoming, the same
basic functions are performed afloat and ashore, but
exactly how they are performed is governed by the
needs of the activity.
Generally, the shipboard procedures are simpler,
since a relatively small amount of mail is processed out
and most of it is signed by the captain.
Department heads and their assistants frequently
draft letters dealing with their departments, although
many letters are prepared completely in the captain’s
office.
4-5
Figure 4-2.—Sorting incoming mail in a Navy mailroom.
KEY INITCO
XO
NAV
OPS
COMM
WEAP
1ST LT
ENG
MPA
DCA
ERC
SUP
MED
CMAA
YN
DATE
DESTROY FILE:
Figure 4-3.—Stamp for routing routine mail.
REVIEWING OUTGOING MAIL
The person in charge of the captain’s office
usually is responsible for reviewing all outbound
correspondence before it is given to the captain for
signature. Sometimes a letter may require review and
approval by a number of persons before it is ready for
signature. In this case, a routing slip may be used.
Generally, persons whose approval is required indicate
this approval by initialing the official file copy.
RECORDS OF OUTGOING MAIL
All outgoing mail classified Secret must be
registered. Confidential material must be registered if
it is to be sent outside the continental United States or
to an FPO or APO address; otherwise, it may be sent
via First-Class Mail or certified mail. Specific
guidelines are contained in the DON Information
Security Program (ISP) Regulation and chapter 8 of
this course.
Once again, local practice may require that a log be
maintained for all outgoing correspondence.
However, this tends to be time-consuming and bulky.
A well-kept file of outgoing correspondence should be
sufficient for identification of when and where
correspondence was sent.
DISPATCHING
After a letter is signed, it is date-stamped or -typed,
serialized (if serial numbers are used), and given a final
check for enclosures. The file and information copies
are removed and appropriately filed and routed. The
letter is now ready to go into its envelope and on its
way. When a number of letters are addressed to the
same activity, they should be sent in the same envelope.
MESSENGER SERVICE
Since shore activities are generally spread out,
correspondence routing is usually handled through a
messenger system, usually known as guard mail or
yard mail. A messenger picks it up in the originating
office and carries it to the next person listed on the
envelope. The post office on base may have the
facilities to deliver guard mail. Where different
commands are located in the same geographical area,
official correspondence can also be sent via this
messenger system.
PROCESSING MESSAGE TRAFFIC
Messages are the quickest form of formal written com-
munications in theNavy.Our telecommunications system
is designed to get time-sensitive or critical information
to addressees rapidly for the effective use of
information. Complete procedures for processing
naval messages are contained in NTP-3. The
information provided in the next few paragraphs will
aid in the processing of message traffic.
INCOMING MESSAGE TRAFFIC
With the automation of message traffic (use of
computers), incoming message traffic has become
quite simple. Messages received by the communica-
tions center for delivery to over-the-counter (OTC)
command’s will be stored on diskettes provided by
each command. These diskettes will be placed in the
command’s message box for pickup. The messages are
retrieved from the diskette at the command. The
messages can either be run off on hard paper copy, or
the diskette be passed from reader to reader. Passing
the diskette from reader to reader will reduce the
amount of paper accumulated by making hard copy
messages and, thus, reduce the cost of message
preparation.
OUTGOING MESSAGE TRAFFIC
Diskettes containing outgoing messages must be
prepared according to the NTP-3 before delivery to the
communications center for transmission. Customers
are encouraged to use 3 1/2-inch floppy diskettes.
Commands are required to affix a write-protect tab to
each diskette and also to scan each one for computer
viruses before delivery. Commands are responsible for
ensuring all messages are properly formatted and
delivered by authorized courier. All previously used
diskettes must be cleared and reformatted before being
reused for message storage.
SUMMARY
This chapter has given you basics on how to
process correspondence and messages. You will
become better at this as you gain knowledge and
experience. However, it is always wise to refer to the
references listed in this chapter. Remember: When in
doubt, go to the manuals.
4-6
CHAPTER 5
CORRESPONDENCE/MESSAGE FILES
AND DISPOSAL
As a Yeoman (YN), you must be able to file
correspondence correctly and retrieve it quickly. The
amount of time it takes you to locate a certain piece of
correspondence will depend on how well you know the
Navy filing system.
This chapter introduces you to the Navy way of
filing, equipment commonly used by the YN, and
various procedures that will help you perform your
duties efficiently. The chapter then covers the
numerical subject identification coding system.
Finally, the records disposal system is discussed.
CENTRALIZED AND
DECENTRALIZED FILES
Your command has two options in the manner it
keeps incoming and outgoing correspondence readily
available: centralized or decentralized files.
Centralized filing, where all official copies of outgoing
correspondence and the originals of incoming
correspondence are maintained in the same office, is
used by ships, small shore commands, or commands
with a minimal amount of correspondence. A
decentralized system, where the originals and official
copies are maintained at the departmental level, is
appropr ia te when there is cons iderable
correspondence routed directly to a department or
division having responsibility over a specific subject.
Larger shore commands, Navy Department offices or
bureaus, or activities where offices are widely
separated use the decentralized system.
In either system, control and responsibility are
assigned to one or two YNs. In a central file, all
operations and control are under one person’s
immediate supervision. In a decentralized system, a
supervisor makes sure that uniform filing practices are
followed in each file location. Whichever system is
used, files should not be duplicated. There should be
only one official file.
FILE EQUIPMENT
Whether ashore or aboard ship, the equipment you
use is standardized. The following paragraphs give
you general knowledge of the types of filing equipment
used throughout the Navy.
CABINETS
The types and sizes of file cabinets vary to
accommodate the size of the material filed. Since
materials should be filed without folding, the size of
the cabinet is determined by the size of the individual
sheets, cards, or other records to be filed.
Four- or five-drawer, steel, letter-size cabinets are
the Navy standard for active correspondence and
documents. The Navy standard correspondence size is
8 1/2 by 11 inches, and file cabinets available through
the supply system are designed to accommodate this
size. Specialized file cabinets are available for larger
sized documents, such as drawings, charts, or
legal-sized documents.
Each file drawer is equipped with an adjustable
backstop, called a compressor. By adjusting the
position of the compressor, your files are kept in an
upright and orderly position when a file drawer is only
partially filled.
CARD FILES
In addition to regular filing cabinets, files of
appropriate size are used for filing various size cards.
The standard sizes used are 3 by 5 inches and 5 by 8
inches. Equipment for filing cards ranges from single
desk-top boxes to multidrawer and sectioned floor
cabinets.
VISIBLE FILES
Visible files of various sizes and types are common
in certain offices. This type of file is arranged so that
the data contained can be seen and read with minimum
handling. Examples of some of these files are shown in
figure 5-1.
5-1
FILE FOLDERS
Standard file folders are used to keep your
correspondence orderly. They are available in two
sizes: letter, 9 by 11 3/4 inches; and legal, 9 by 14 3/4
inches. Each folder has an area for labeling that
extends above any filed material. The area may run the
entire length of the folder, known as straight cut, or
may be cut in one of three positions; left, center, or
right, known as one-third cut. Straight-cut folders are
used, generally, when the files are thick enough to
make sure the labels of adjacent folders are easily seen.
One-third cut folders space the labels across the drawer
so that the folder in front of it will not hide a label.
Figure 5-2 shows files that are one-third cut tabs.
SECURITY FILES
The Department of the Navy (DON) Information
and Secur i ty Program (ISP) Regula t ion ,
SECNAVINST 5510.36 series, defines the security
requirements for file cabinets that contain classified
material. These requirements will be discussed in
chapter 8 of this NRTC.
STANDARD SUBJECT
IDENTIFICATION CODES
The Department of the Navy Standard Subject
Identification Codes (SSIC), SECNAVINST 5210.11
5-2
Figure 5–1.—Examples of visible files.
series, contains the numerical codes that provide the
basic classification structure for identifying and filing
records. These codes cover most subjects found in
general correspondence and other files. Since these
numbers are used for numbering other naval
documents (such as reports, forms, and directives) by
subject category, they also provide the basis for a single
Navywide subject numbering system.
NUMERICAL SUBJECT GROUPS
There are 14 major numerical subject groups,
called series, using groups of thousands. They are as
follows:
1000 Military Personnel
2000 Telecommunications
3000 Operations and Readiness
4000 Logistics
5000 General Administration and Management
6000 Medicine and Dentistry
7000 Financial Management
8000 Ordnance Material
9000 Ships Design and Material
10000 General Material
11000 Facilities and Activities Ashore
12000 Civilian Personnel
13000 Aeronautical and Astronautical Material
16000 Coast Guard Mission
Within the major groups are subdivisions using
the second, third, and sometimes fourth digit. For
example:
5000 General Administration and Management
5200 Management Programs and Techniques
5210 Office Methods and Paper Work
Management
5211 Files and Records Systems
or,
5300 Manpower/Personnel
or,
5400 Organization, Functions, Status,
and so on.
ASSIGNING THE RIGHT SSIC
Assigning the right SSIC is the most important
filing operation because it determines where the
document will be placed in the files. A properly
assigned SSIC can be readily identified and found
when needed. Read the document carefully, analyze
it, and then select the SSIC that most closely matches
the subject. Consider the following:
• The most important, definite, or concrete
subject mentioned
• The purpose or general significance of the
document
5-3
Figure 5–2.—File drawer showing folders and tab positions.
• The manner in which similar documents are
asked for
• The SSIC under which previous documents of a
similar nature are filed
Be specific when you assign the SSIC. Some of the
smaller subject groups are not subdivided beyond the
first breakdown, while larger groups may be broken
down to a second or third level, as in the example.
CROSS-REFERENCING MATERIAL
Most official correspondence, reports, or other
material only need to be filed under one SSIC. There
are times, however, when more than one code will
apply to the contents of the correspondence. In these
cases, a system of cross-referencing is desirable to
permit you to locate the document quickly. Instances
in which the cross-referencing may be needed would
include the following:
• When a document has more than one subject
• When the subject may be interpreted more than
one way
• When two or more other subject codes are used
within the document
• When any enclosures are separated from the
basic correspondence
By inserting a cross-reference sheet in each of the
files where the document could be kept, you will know
by glancing at the entry alongside the filed heading
where the original document is located.
For cross-referencing, use a plain sheet of paper
and include the following information:
1. Date of document
2. Index number (SSIC/serial number), if available
3. Addressee
4. Originator
5. Summary of document
6. Cross-file location (SSIC)
7. Initials of person filing/indexing
8. Any applicable remarks
Alternatively, you can sanitize the original
correspondence by covering the body of the letter
(leaving only the upper portion of the document visible)
for copying. The sanitized copy can then be used as the
cross-reference sheet. If the cross-referenced
document is supportive of more than one other
document, include information (by typing or placing a
label directly) on the cross-reference sheet identifying
the secondary document and its location. Figure 5–3
shows an example of a document sanitized for
cross-referencing.
Include a copy of the cross-reference sheet with
the original document to show that the document has
been cross-referenced and to what file(s).
OFFICIAL FILING METHODS
Documents are inserted loosely into the file folder
in SSIC order. The loose filing saves time and effort
when new material is inserted or documents are
returned to the file after they have been removed.
Material that cannot be folded to fit neatly into a
file folder should be filed separately in a suitably sized
container. The location of the removed material must
then be noted on the basic document or on a
cross-reference sheet maintained in the regular file.
REMOVING FILE MATERIAL
Any material removed from a file must be
accounted for, and the identity of the person holding it
must be recorded. This comes in very handy when the
commanding officer asks for a specific piece of
correspondence and wants it now.
The Chargeout Record, Optional Form 23, shown
in figure 5-4, is available for this purpose. The
identification of the material removed, the name and
location of the person borrowing it, and the date it is
borrowed are entered on the form. The form then
replaces the document in the file folder.
You should make periodic checks of the chargeout
records you have in your files to make sure no
documents have been out for an unreasonable period of
time. This check may help avoid loss or misplacement
if the borrower should forget to return the document
after it is no longer needed.
ESTABLISHMENT OF FILES
Each year, every command closes out the files of
the previous year: so a new set should be set up at that
time. There is nothing difficult about this task, but
some thought should be given to the process.
The importance of having files is already well
established. The accuracy of the filing system and the
ease in retrieving information are just as important.
5-4
The administration of a command is an ongoing
process that requires easy access to previous
correspondence either received or sent out. Without
efficiently managed files, time is lost and the
command’s overall effectiveness can be affected.
When starting up a new year’s files, always take a
look at last year’s files. Where was the most
information contained? Which SSIC files were really
bulky, and which contained only a few pieces of paper?
Use this review to prepare your new folders. Some
SSIC groups could be broken down further to make
them quicker to find. Some groups could be combined
in the same folder to save space. If you are setting up
the files for a brand new command, keep in mind the
basic mission of your command. If your command has
a basically logistic mission, those subject groups will
probably be used the most. Likewise, it could be
ordnance-related, operations-related, or personnel-
related, so those groups will see more use.
MESSAGE FILES
Messages are filed numerically in the order of the
date time group (DTG). The DTG is expressed as six
digits with a zone suffix plus an abbreviated month and
a two-digit year. The first pair of digits denotes the date
of the month, the second pair denotes the hours, and the
third pair the minutes, followed by a capitalized letter
that indicates the zone. For standardization, all naval
communications use Greenwich (Z) time. The month
and year are abbreviated by using the first three letters
of the month and the last two digits of the year. For
example:
172140Z MAY 01
Separate message files are maintained for
incoming and outgoing messages, with the most recent
message on top. Separate files are also maintained for
general messages such as ALNAV (All Navy) and
NAVOPS (Navy Operations). They are normally filed
5-5
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
NAVAL AIR STATION
PENSACOLA, FL 32508
5216
Ser 11/352
3 Jun 00
From: Commanding Officer, Naval Air Station, Pensacola
To: Commander in Chief, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
Via: (1) Commander, Sea Based ASW Wings, Atlantic
(2) Commander, Naval Air Force, U.S. Atlantic Fleet
Subj: HOW TO PREPARE ENDORSEMENTS
Encl: (1) Orientation Schedule for Newcomers
* If cross-referenced document is supportive of more than one other document, include
identifying data of the other documents it references.
CROSS-REFERENCED DOCUMENT:
SEE 7500
[OR] SEE 7500, Ser 09/004 of 15 May 00*
Figure 5–3.—Sanitized cross-referenced document.
in numerical order by calendar date. Other forms of
messages that are filed separately are CASREPs
(Operational reports), PERSONAL FOR, and
messages classified CONFIDENTIAL, SECRET, and
TOP SECRET.
Messages are usually destroyed 30 days after the
release date, or earlier if they have served their
purpose . However, message direct ives are
automatically canceled 90 days following the release
date except when the message provides earlier
cancellation, a subsequent release specially extends
the time, or if it is reissued in a letter-type directive
format.
With the introduction of the Navywide standard
message preparation program, MTF, messages can be
stored on computer disks instead of paper. This will
greatly reduce the amount of paper and files required to
handle message traffic.
Now, what do you do with all the old files? The
last part of this chapter gives you information on the
disposition of records no longer needed by your
command.
RECORDS DISPOSAL
The contents of your files are of such significance
that Congress has passed laws governing their
disposition, laws that apply to unclassified as well as
classified material.
All tasks connected with files, including their
disposition, must be taken seriously. Since you may be
responsible for the work of juniors, you may also be
directly involved in the proper disposal of files that
have served their purpose. Decisions to save—or not
save—must not be avoided by saving all your files. No
matter how firmly you believe that “If I throw this away
today, someone will want it tomorrow,” a decision must
be made.
The Navy and Marine Corps Records Disposition
Manual, SECNAVINST 5212.5 series, spells out the
retention period of official files and whether they must
be destroyed or forwarded to a Federal Records Center
(FRC). But, if you are in doubt about disposal of
certain records, consult with your seniors in deciding
which course of action to take.
RECORDS DEFINED
Your files may contain material that is not
considered official record material (pamphlets, extra
copies of letters, directives, and so forth) solely
because nobody made a decision about disposing of
them.
Government records are defined as a l l
documentary material, including books, papers, maps,
and photographs, made or received by an agency of the
U.S. Government in connection with the transaction of
public business and appropriate for preservation.
The Standard Organization and Regulations of the
U.S. Navy (SORM), OPNAVINST 3120.32 series,
defines official correspondence as all written material,
documents, publications, charts, messages, and so
forth, addressed to or sent from a command.
Nonrecord material is that which is not worth
keeping except for a limited time. Within this category
are such things as rough drafts, extra copies of letters,
some forms of publications received from other than
government agencies (catalogs, trade journals), and
reproduction materials such as stencils and offset
plates.
It isn’t always easy to determine a true distinction
between record and nonrecord material and then apply
a hard and fast rule to each item. You should make each
decision based on the retention standards contained in
the Records Disposition Manual. It may be determined
that, because of some special reason, items normally
scheduled for destruction should be kept indefinitely.
5-6
Figure 5–4.—Chargeout Record, Optional Form 23.
The term appropriate for preservation gives you a
good rule of thumb as to whether or not an item needs
to be destroyed.
WHAT GOVERNS DISPOSAL
The United States Criminal Code provides
penalties for unlawful removal or destruction of
federal records. The Records Disposal Act of 1943
established the means to obtain legal authority for
destruction of unneeded government records.
Authority for general procedures pertaining to
disposal of federal government records rests with the
National Archives, a part of the General Services
Administration.
Specifically pertaining to Navy members is Navy
Regulations, 1990, Article 1127, which provides that
no person without proper authority may withdraw
official records or destroy them.
AUTHORITY FOR DISPOSAL
The Records Disposition Manual provides the
authority for disposal of naval records, including naval
correspondence, accumulated by naval activities
ashore and afloat.
DISPOSAL RESPONSIBILITY
The individual responsible for custody of official
records at your act iv i ty has the addi t ional
responsibility of making sure that official files are
disposed of according to the appropriate disposal
standard. Your job is to assist the responsible person in
making sure that your records are complete and that the
proper standards from the Records Disposition
Manual are applied.
METHODS OF DISPOSAL
The two official methods of disposal are local
destruction or transfer to the nearest FRC. The types
of records transferred to the center are those designated
in the Records Disposition Manual for which you can
find no disposal authority (after they have served the
needs of your activity), and any inactive record of any
age or type, when it is determined that savings can be
realized by the transfer and the records are no longer
required for local operating purposes.
Destruction
Most unclassified records are destroyed locally at
the end of their retention periods. Classified material
must be destroyed by burning or other authorized
method. If you are at sea, your unclassified and
classified records should be destroyed by burning. At
ashore activities, unclassified records may be scrapped
or sold as wastepaper, provided the records are either
treated to destroy the word content, or a clause is
inserted in the contract prohibiting the resale or use of
the records or documents.
Transfer
Few records are actually transferred for
preservation. Those records that have a retention value
are transferred to the nearest FRC. An up-to-date
listing of FRCs is contained in the Records Disposition
Manual.
Appendix C of the Records Disposition Manual
outlines the procedures for transferring records. A
Records Transmittal and Receipt, SF-135, shown in
figure 5-5, is used to forward retention material to an
FRC. The FRC returns a copy to you acknowledging
receipt.
Preservation
Indefinite or permanent retention of official
records is known as preservation. This does not
include locally retained records, but does include all
official records retained at an authorized FRC.
REVIEWING
Using the Records Disposition Manual as your
guide, you will be able to alert the person having
responsibility for the files as to the proper procedure
for disposing of them. One way to keep ahead of this
process is to have a label placed on the file that lists the
date the file was originated, how long you need to
retain it locally, and what disposition action is
required. This helps to ensure that records are disposed
of at the correct time and in the proper manner.
Transfers
Records designated in the disposal instructions for
transfer to an FRC should be forwarded as scheduled,
or earlier. Records for which you cannot find a disposal
authority are transferred when they are of no further
value to your activity. A word of caution: Even though
5-7
a disposal date may have passed, do not dispose of
material on which action is pending.
Destruction
Federal law makes it mandatory that, except in
special cases, records scheduled for destruction must
be destroyed. This doesn’t mean, however, that each
and every item must be disposed of on the precise day
authorized for destruction. Individual commands may
set up any sort of destruction schedule they wish, such
as once every 3 months, semiannually, or annually as
convenient. As long as the records do not take up
valuable space over long periods of time, they may be
destroyed to fit your schedule.
WHERE AND HOW TO SHIP
Certain specialized record categories are
centralized at certain centers for convenience of
administration and reference. Records centralized like
this are listed in the Records Disposition Manual.
Nondesignated records go to the appropriate FRC
listed in appendix C of the manual.
Records are packed in their original file arrange-
ment in standard-sized cartons. (See figure 5-6.) Each
carton holds approximately 1 cubic foot of material.
Letter-size documents are packed on the 12-inch side
of the carton; legal-size documents are packed on the
long side. Odd-size items that will not fit in the
standard box may be shipped in any appropriately
sized container. Shipments of less than 1 cubic foot
may be sent in envelopes or small packages. Mark the
box or packages according to the guidelines contained
in appendix C of the Records Disposition Manual.
ACCESS TO FILES TRANSFERRED
TO AN FRC
You can request reference service by enclosing a
Reference Request–Federal Records Center, Optional
Form 11 (fig. 5–7), with a letter or memorandum.
Include in the request the name of the naval activity;
the name, location, and telephone number of the
person for whom the request is being made; a full
description of the information or records needed; and
the box number, the FRC location number, and the
accession number that can be found on the SF-135
returned to you by the FRC.
5-8
��������������� �������������������������� ���������������������������� ����������� �� �������� ����� ������� ��� ��� ����� �� ��������������� ��� ��������������������� ��������
����
�
��
�����
��� � �������������� ����� �� ��� ������� �� ������� � ������������
��������� !�"
����������������������
!� ���"�# ��"�����$ %��&'(� '�"
)� ���"�#��" ��
*� �����+���" ������'�
��"�����'"�� ���"�#� ,'�'��"� ���'�'�,� �#���$��������������������"
��"�����'"�� ���"�#� ���'�'�,� �%������ ���������" +� �
�����+�� ����'-�+� .#��%������ ���������" +� �
/� ���0�&��� ��������������������������� ������������� ��� ����� ��� ���'������� ��������
����� �����(������������� ���"
����������
������'�"� "$0.��
��
��"
�#
�("
"$0.��
��"
-�,$0��������"
��"
���"�#.�1
"$0.��
��"
���'��� +����'� '�"�)������������������ ��� ��"
��"
+'�����,� �$ %��' #�%����������������(� "
�"
+'�����,+� �
��"
��0�,� �+�.#������+�� ��" ��
,��� '�"
�*"
��� �'�&
'�"
��"
�%�,�
�,�"
�+"
��" �
#��
��"
�$ ��
+'���
��"
����,-��
"�"� 2/*3&33&4)*&*35) ��� �� �� �� �)/�6����� 2&7/8� ��� �9��� 9:�"���)4����� �!!7��/!
Figure 5–5.—Records Transmittal and Receipt, Standard Form 135.
5-9
Figure 5–6.—Packing records for shipment.
����������������������� �������������� ������������������������������������������
������������ ����!"����� #��������$� $���#
������������ �������� ������� ������������������������������
��
��������������������������������������������������
�������
����������������� #�������������
��������������������������������������
������������������������������������������������������������
���������������������� ����������������������������������������� ���������
������������������������������������������������������ �
�������
��
���������� !"#$�%�!$��"&'$(�)�#�*�*!$�
����������������������������� �����������������
������� ������������������������
�������������������������������������
���� �����������
����������������+���������
������������������ #������������������������������ ������������ ��� ����
�����"����������
�����������������������
���������������������������������������������� ��������������� ��������������������!"#��������
�$,"$-*$(�.!$)-$�-�/�0�#)*$�)�#�($*"(��*1�-�%2(&0�%2(
%�!$��*$&�-��!�-*$#�)'23$0��#�$%��%�*1$�'!2 4�*2�(�/1*
1)-�'$$�� 1$ 4$#�'5�*1$��$ 2(#-��$�*$(
�������� ����
����6789�99�:;<�:8<= ��������������>>���$3�6�;6���������������������������������������������
=:�����><<;>:<
"��%������������ ��
�����������������
�������������������������������
�������������������
�������������������������� ������
�������.$ �%5�
�����������
Figure 5–7.—Reference Request—Federal Records Center, Optional Form 11.
SUMMARY
Each office you work in will have its own unique
aspects. The leadership and management style of your
supervisor, the area of responsibility of the department or
division, and the type of equipment available will have an
effect on filing. But, throughout the Navy, the basic
functions of fil ing, classifying, coding, and
cross-referencing remain constant. Learn the SSIC
codes and understand the Navy filing system. You will
then be able to fit into any office and perform effectively
as a YN.
5-10
CHAPTER 6
DIRECTIVES ISSUANCE SYSTEM
The Department of the Navy Directives Issuance
System, SECNAVINST 5215.1 series, provides the
method of issuing directives for all activities in the
Navy. According to this instruction, a directive
prescribes or establishes policy, organization, conduct,
methods, or procedures; requires action or sets forth
information essential to the effective administration or
operation of activities concerned; or contains authority
or information that must be issued formally.
This chapter gives you information about the
directives issuance system. You will be dealing with
the directives issuance system on a daily basis in your
work. Become familiar with it; it will pay handsome
rewards.
DIRECTIVES ISSUANCE TERMS
The following terms and their definitions will help
you understand the material in this chapter.
DIRECTIVE. An instruction, notice, or change
transmittal. It prescribes or establishes policy,
organization, conduct, methods, or procedures;
requires action or sets forth information essential to the
effective administration or operation of activities; or
contains authority or information that must be passed
formally. The types of directives used in the Directives
Issuance System are instructions, notices, and change
transmittals.
INSTRUCTION . A directive containing
authority or information having continuing reference
value or requiring continuing action. It remains in
effect until superseded or otherwise cancelled by the
originator or higher authority.
NOTICE. A directive, effective for one time only
or for a brief period, that has the same force and effect
as an instruction. Usually, it will remain in effect for
less than 6 months, but is not permitted to remain in
effect for longer than 1 year. Any requirement for
continuing action contained in a notice, such as the
submission of a report, use of a form, or following a
specified procedure, is considered to be cancelled
when the notice is cancelled, unless the requirement is
incorporated into another suitable document. A notice
has a self-cancelling provision. The cancellation date
is always stated. When the exact length of time a notice
is to remain in effect cannot be determined at the time
of issuance, the specific date for record purposes is set
far enough in the future to allow all necessary use of the
notice. Cancellation determinations are indicated at
the top-right corner (Canc frp:) or as the last paragraph
preceded by the words Cancellation Contingency.
CHANGE TRANSMITTAL. The medium used
to transmit changes to an instruction or, under
extenuating circumstances, a notice. Each transmittal
describes the nature of the changes it transmits and
gives directions for making them.
CHECKLIST. A numerical list of effective
instructions. This list is used to verify the
completeness and accuracy of a master set of
instructions.
CROSS-REFERENCE SHEET . A sheet
distributed with a directive, and filed in the directives
binder, to assist users in locating the directive when
filed separately.
DISTRIBUTION LIST. A list of action and
information addressees of a directive.
ISSUING AUTHORITY. The chief official of an
activity, command, or independent component, by
whose authority and under whose title a directive is
issued.
JOINT DIRECTIVE. A directive issued jointly
by one authority in conjunction with one or more other
authorities.
LETTER-TYPE DIRECTIVE. An instruction
or notice prepared in a format similar to that of a naval
letter.
MESSAGE-TYPE DIRECTIVE. A directive
transmitted via the Naval Telecommunications
System.
PAGE CHANGE. An additional or replacement
page for an instruction or notice, transmitted under
cover of a change transmittal, for insertion by recipients.
PEN CHANGE. A change, usually short, that is
entered in the basic document in handwriting by the
6-1
recipient. Directions should state precisely where the
change occurs.
PREPARING AUTHORITY. The chief official
of a command, activity, or component who has
initiated the task of preparing a directive.
PUBLICATION-TYPE DIRECTIVE. An
instruction or notice whose content is best suited to a
publication format, such as parts, chapters, or sections.
It carries the same subject number as the assigned
transmittal and does not carry a separate publication
number.
REVISION. A reissuance of an existing
instruction in completely rewritten form.
SPECIAL DISTRIBUTION LIST. A list of
addressees, compiled by an issuing authority to meet
his or her special recurring needs, when use of the
Standard Navy Distribution List (SNDL) would be
impractical.
WEEKLY TRANSMITTAL SHEET. The
means by which the Navy Publications and Printing
Service makes initial distribution of directives
addressed to all ships and stations.
ALL SHIPS AND STATIONS. The To line of a
directive to be included in a special distribution system
from specified organizations in the Washington, D.C.,
area to all or most of the components of the Department
of the Navy listed in the SNDL.
ADMINISTRATION AND
MAINTENANCE
The Chief of Naval Operations administers the
Directives Issuance System and provides for possible
improvements and changes to the system.
ISSUING AUTHORITY
The issuing authority (the official by whose
authority and under whose title a directive is issued)
ensures compliance with the Directives Issuance
System. This official also issues internal procedures
necessary for administering the system.
An issuing authority ensures that directives are
issued to adequately document programs, functions,
organizations, policies, and procedures for which he or
she is responsible. This official ensures directives
conform to Department of the Navy policies and
regulations and to statutory and other requirements,
without policy or procedural gaps or overlaps.
The issuing authority conducts at least an annual
review, to ensure the system’s requirements and
standards are being met. This official also ensures a
review of all effective directives the organization has
issued to determine those which need to be cancelled,
updated, revised, or consolidated. One method is to
review instructions on their respective anniversary
dates, thus spreading the workload over the year.
The issuing authori ty ensures personnel
responsible for drafting, producing, reviewing, and
maintaining directives receive training as needed.
If practical, when the official name of an activity is
changed or when activities are consolidated or split,
the issuing authority issues a conversion table showing
the old and new identifications of directives. This
official also ensures the automatic distribution of
applicable directives to a newly established activity or
an activity moved from one command chain to another.
DIRECTIVES CONTROL POINT
Each command has a directives control point that
continuously analyzes directives, evaluates the
sys tem’s opera t ions wi th in the indiv idual
organization, and makes recommendations for
improvements when appropriate. The directives
control point is usually the ship’s secretary aboard ship
and the administrative officer at a shore activity.
Before it is signed, each directive is reviewed for
compliance with directives standards, including
preparation for proper signature, clearances, format,
identification, security requirements, editorial
standards, subject numbers, and references. The
directives control point ascertains currency, need,
completeness, and possible overlap of or conflict with
other directives. The control point assigns consecutive
numbers to new instructions after signature and
ensures dating before issuance.
Another function of the directives control point is
to review the proposed distribution of each directive to
ensure distribution is selectively appropriate and
accurate. This review allows the control point to
prevent overdistribution or underdistribution of
direct ives . The control point arranges for
reproduction, distribution, and stocking of directives.
The directives control point maintains, in standard
three-ring or post binders, a master up-to-date set of all
incoming and outgoing directives, including a copy of
each message directive. For classified directives, the
control point maintains locator cross-reference sheets.
Publication-type directives are filed elsewhere. The
6-2
directives control point also reviews checklists to
ensure the currency of directives addressed to the
organization. A ship’s directives control point obtains
a complete set of all applicable directives upon the
activation or commissioning of the ship.
The directives control point issues annual
numerical checklists, quarterly additions and
deletions, and annual alphabetical subject indexes of
currently effective instructions the organization has
issued. The Document Automation and Production
Service (DAPS) provides this service to Washington
headquarters organizations, except Headquarters
Marine Corps.
OFFICIAL CASE FILES
Each issuing authority maintains official
directives case files for directives issued. The files are
arranged numerically by the standard subject
identification code (SSIC) assigned the directives and
filed as a separate series, apart from other files. Each
case folder includes the following:
• The official copy of the basic directive
containing clearance initials or names and the
original or copy containing the actual signature
or other authentication.
• The official file copy or signature copy or other
designated official copy, of any change,
cancellation, cross-reference sheet, or revision
of the basic directive.
• Any reproduced (distribution) copy of the basic
directive and any change, cancellation,
cross-reference sheet, or revision of the basic
directive. Ships and small activities may
dispense with this requirement, if approved by
local authority.
• Supporting and other pertinent documents,
including those containing concurrence,
nonconcurrence, approval, and significant
comment.
FILING DIRECTIVES
Instructions normally are filed according to (1)
SSIC, (2) consecutive number, and (3) issuing
authority. Checklists of directives issued by
Washington headquarters organizations are organized
in this manner. If local conditions require, however,
directives may be filed primarily by issuing authority
or by a combination of SSIC and issuing authority.
Alphabetic prefixes (C and S, indicating security
classification) to the subject designation are
disregarded in determining the numerical filing
sequence.
Because of their brief duration, notices ordinarily
need not be filed in the master file. If they need to be
interfiled temporarily with instructions, the notices
should be tabbed so that each may be easily and
promptly removed as soon as its cancellation date is
reached. Copies may be filed in separate suspense
binders when necessary.
Cross- reference shee ts for ins t ruc t ions
permanently or temporarily removed from your office
are interfiled with instructions. Locator sheets are
inserted in normal sequence, in place of the
instructions they reference. A subject cross-reference
sheet is placed in front of those instructions that carry
the same SSIC. A second copy of the cross-reference
sheet should be placed in a suspense file for
instructions temporarily loaned out. An instruction
should usually be returned within 5 days.
When copies of directives are needed to complete a
record or to support or further document a specific
action, they may be filed in the activity’s general
subject files, pertinent case files (such as contract case
files), or other appropriate correspondence files.
ENTERING CHANGES
Proper notations, such as “Ch-l” for change 1, are
entered in the upper-right margin of the first page of
each directive changed. For publication-type
ins t ruc t ions , nota t ions are entered on the
record-of-changes sheet to indicate changes received
and incorporated.
REQUISITIONING DIRECTIVES
Required additional or replacement copies of
directives, excluding notices, are requisitioned from
the stocking point shown on each directive. More
recently, commands have been able to requisition
directives via electronic means.
DISPOSITION OF DIRECTIVES
Each activity maintains the directives it receives
only during the period of their effectiveness.
Cancelled directives, regardless of classification, are
destroyed by recipients without notification to the
originating office.
6-3
An activity maintains its official directives case
files for the same period it maintains its official
correspondence files. It disposes of them in the same
manner.
PREPARATION OF DIRECTIVES
The Directives Issuance System Manual ,
SECNAVINST 5215.1 series, contains complete
directions for the preparation of instructions and
notices. Figures 6-1 through 6-6 present the standard
format for directives and cross-reference sheets.
SUMMARY
This chapter has given you information that covers
the whole spectrum of the Directives Issuance System.
By knowing and understanding the contents of this
chapter, you can find any procedure and do any job
you are given. Other chapters in this manual will teach
you how to do other specific jobs and give more
detailed information on certain aspects of the YN
rating. This chapter will prepare you to perform well in
your present job as well as in other jobs throughout
your career.
6-4
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
Chief of Naval Education and Training
250 Dallas Street
Pensacola, Florida 32508-5220
CNETINST 1500.1B
N162
10 Jun 01
CNET INSTRUCTION 1500.1B
Subj: GENERAL MILITARY TRAINING
Ref: (a) OPNAVINST 1500.22C
(b) CNETINST 1540.36
(c) CNETINST 1540.8C
Encl: (1) Military Training Topics List
1. Purpose. To provide a military training program in accordance with references (a) through (c) for
all personnel attending preparatory schools.
2. Cancellation. CNETINST 1500.15A.
3. Background. Navy enlisted personnel receive initial military training and indoctrination during
recruit training. It is necessary . . .
4. Action.
a. Commanding officers will conduct a program of military training in compliance with this
instruction . . .
b. Enclosure (1) provides a list of GMT topics considered appropriate for inclusion in an A or C
School . . .
Figure 6-1.—Sample instruction.
6-5
CNETINST 1500.15B
10 Jun 01
c. Commanding officers may include, as required, additional topics from reference (a), or
other topics . . .
d. A desirable level of GMT instruction is an average of 4 hours per week for students
attending courses.
e. Activities are authorized to include GMT in the course master schedules, not to exceed the
limits established . . .
P. T. BOAT
Distribution:
CNETINST 5216.2V
List I, Case 2 (less A, E, FF, and GG)
List V
Copy to:
FT1
Stocked:
Supply Department
Naval Air Station, Pensacola
123 Front Street
Pensacola, FL 32508-0000
Figure 6-2.—Sample continuation page of an instruction.
6-6
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
Naval Education and Training
Professional Development and Technology Center
6490 Saufley Field Road
Pensacola, Florida 32509-5237
Canc frp: JUN01
NETPDTCNOTE 5000
Code 10
10 Jun 01
NETPDTC NOTICE 5000
From: Commanding Officer
Subj: TYPING OF NAVAL NOTICE
Ref: (a) SECNAVINST 5215.1C
Encl: (1) Example of a typed naval notice
1. Purpose. This paragraph will state the reason for issuing the notice. In this case, the purpose will
be to acquaint you with the correct format for typing a naval notice.
2. Background. This paragraph will provide you with helpful information so that you may better
understand the notice. In this instance, you are to use reference (a) for further information about
proper format when typing a naval notice.
3. Action. This paragraph normally states what action the addressee must take. For this example no
action is required.
4. Cancellation Contingency. This paragraph will tell you what will cause the cancellation of the
notice. Usually, completion of actions assigned is in previous paragraphs.
P. T. BOAT
Figure 6-3.—Sample notice.
6-7
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
Office of the Secretary
Washington, DC 20350-1000
SECNAVINST 5216.5C CH-2
PERS-09B
10 Jun 01
SECNAV INSTRUCTION 5216.5C CHANGE TRANSMITTAL 2
From: Secretary of the Navy
To: All Ships and Stations
Subj: DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY CORRESPONDENCE MANUAL
Encl: (1) List of Effective Pages for SECNAVINST 5216.5C
(2) Revised Page 2-2
1. Purpose. To promulgate Change 2 to subject manual.
2. Action.
a. Make the following pen change to subject manual:
Page 1-3, top of the page, delete entire line reading "Note: See paragraphs 7, 8, and 9. . .
sender's symbols."
b. Insert Enclosures (1) and (2) in place of existing pages.
P. T. BOAT
By direction
Figure 6-4.—Sample change transmittal.
6-8
LOCATOR CROSS-REFERENCE SHEET OPNAVINST 5510-1H
10 JUN 01
Subj: DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY INFORMATION AND PERSONNEL SECURITY
PROGRAM REGULATION
This directive is not filed in these directive binders, but may be found at the following location(s):
_____________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-5.—Sample locator cross-reference sheet.
SUBJECT CROSS-REFERENCE SHEET BUPERS 1001
See: BUPERSINST 1750.10A OF 7 JUL 99, IDENTIFICATION CARDS FOR MEMBERS OF
THE UNIFORMED SERVICES, THEIR FAMILY MEMBERS, AND OTHER ELIGIBLE
PERSONNEL
(Include a brief summary of content of the directive here if the subject is not sufficiently
descriptive.)
Figure 6-6.—Sample subject cross-reference sheet.
CHAPTER 7
REPORTS AND FORMS MANAGEMENT PROGRAMS
Reports control is a management tool designed to
ensure efficient response to local and higher echelon
requirements for information. Each activity is
required to establish a continuing and systematic
appraisal of reports.
The contents of your files are of such significance
that our Congress has passed laws governing their
disposition and fixing penalties for unauthorized
destruction. These laws apply to unclassified as well
as classified matter.
This chapter gives you a basic understanding of the
Department of the Navy Information Requirements
(Reports) Management Program, SECNAVINST
5214.2 series. This instruction gives direction for an
effective reports management program.
REPORTS MANAGEMENT PROGRAM
A single office within each Navy command should
be designated as the reports control point to review and
process existing and proposed reports, reporting
systems, and their related directives. Normally, the
reports control manager is a function of the ship’s
secretary (afloat) or the administrative officer (ashore),
with a senior YN as reports control point supervisor.
As a YN2, you may be that senior YN. A reports
manager is responsible for the following tasks:
• Reviewing reports for conformance with
reporting standards
• Approving reports by assigning report control
symbols (RCSs) or citing exemption authority
• Conducting periodic reviews of individual
reports
• Maintaining management data on reports
required and prepared by the organization
FOLLOW-UP PROCEDURES
Reports should be reviewed before their expiration
to determine if they continue to meet requirements
efficiently. The report originator performs this review
60 days before the third anniversary of the issuance
date. The report must include complete rejustification
of the requirement. Reports not approved for
extension are automatically cancelled on the third
anniversary date and should be omitted from any
subsequent effective reports listing.
REPORTS CANCELLATION/
REVALIDATION PROCEDURES
If an information requirement is to be cancelled, a
change transmittal to the existing directive canceling
the requirement should be prepared. If the information
requirement remains valid, a revised directive or
change transmittal should be submitted within 60 days
of the expiration date. The revised directive or change
transmittal should explain the revalidation and extend
the approval period for a maximum of an additional 3
years.
REPORTS ANALYSIS
The construction of report items should obtain all
information needed. Each item must satisfy a current
need or known future requirement. The collection of
information to meet some possible future need is not
justified. The recipient of the report must use each
reported item of information. Negative reports should
be required only when they serve an established
objective.
Arrangement of Report Items
Report data items should be arranged in a logical
format that allows the preparing organization to
complete the report easily.
Source of Information for Report Items
Information for report items should be obtained
from the organization that can furnish precise, usable
information in the easiest way.
Controlling Copy Distribution
Distribution of completed reports is based on a
“need-to-act” or “need-to-know” basis. Distribution
of courtesy copies is prohibited.
7-1
Timing Submissions
The submission of reports is based on the following
timing and frequency requirements:
MINIMUM FREQUENCY. The maximum time
possible between submissions.
AS-REQUIRED REPORTS . Information
available and furnished on request.
SITUATION REPORTS. Information required
on the occurrence of an event or situation or a
change in condition.
REALISTIC DUE DATES. Sufficient time
allowed for adequate compilation between the end
of the period covered and the due date.
DEFINITIONS
Various reports are required to provide information
about distribution, training, promotion planning,
statistical purposes, and so forth. The following are
definitions of the various reports used to provide such
information:
REPORT. A collection of data or information used
to determine policy; to plan, control, and evaluate
operat ions and performance; to make
administrative determinations; or to prepare other
reports. The data or information may be prepared or
transmitted by any method; for example, it may be a
narrative, statistical, or graphic report prepared on
magnetic tape or any other media.
AS-REQUIRED REPORT . Information
collected, stored, retrieved, and submitted when
requested.
STATUS REPORT. An interim report explaining
the amount of work completed or to be completed
on an established report.
SURVEY or PERSONNEL SURVEY. An
organized effort to obtain information from persons
about themselves, their attitudes, perceptions,
beliefs, opinions, or interests. The acquisition of
such information is not a normal administrative
requirement internal to the command.
ONE-TIME REPORT. A report prepared only
once. One-time reports should be assigned a report
control symbol according to the standard subject
identification code (SSIC) using the letters OT as
the suffix.
RECURRING REPORT. A report that conveys
essentially the same type of information at
prescribed intervals.
SITUATION REPORT. Reports prepared upon
occurrence of a specified event.
INFORMATION REQUIREMENT . The
expression of need for data or information to carry
out specified and authorized functions. These
functions require the establishment or maintenance
of forms, formats, or reporting or record keeping
systems, whether manual or automated.
REPORT CONTROL SYMBOL . An
organization abbreviation combined with an SSIC
and a numeric suffix that signifies a report has been
approved.
REVISED REPORT. An established report that
changes in any way. Revised reports have to be
cleared by the reports control manager.
COMPUTER-GENERATED REPORTS .
Reports generated by processing data residing in a
computerized database.
EXEMPT REPORTS. Reports that are not
subject to reports documentat ion and
symbolization procedures.
INTERNAL REPORT. A report that remains
within one organization for its own use.
LICENSED REPORT. A report that has been
justified by the originator, reviewed and approved
by the reports control manager, and assigned a
report control symbol or an exemption.
UNLICENSED REPORT. A report that has NOT
been justified and NOT assigned a report control
symbol.
REPORT CONTROL SYMBOLS
A report control symbol (RCS) is assigned by the
reports control manager. It indicates that the report has
been reviewed and approved as a valid requirement and
that the respondents have the responsibility of
providing the requested information.
The RCS of the highest authority responsible for
the submission of the report should appear on the
report. For example, if a DD symbol is assigned to a
report, all responding commands will use the DD
symbol, expiration dates as assigned, and the
associated report title. Reports control managers may
not substitute their own symbol for the RCS on a report
7-2
from higher authority. Commands are not required to
respond to unlicensed or expired reports.
It is important to note that, although similar in
nature, RCs and forms identification codes are separate
entities. Even though the originator and SSIC of both
may be the same, the consecutive number in each may
not coincide. The same holds true for the relationship
between the report and its requiring directive.
INVENTORY OF REPORTS
An accurate and current inventory of recurring
reports is essential for the effective operation of an
activity. The reports control manager maintains this
inventory. A case folder must be maintained on all
reports for which an activity is responsible.
The reports control manager should maintain a
close working relationship with points of contact
within the command who may be aware of new or
revised reports requirements. Points of contact may
include the directives control point, forms manager,
mail room, or publications review office.
ESTABLISHMENT AND
MAINTENANCE OF RECORDS
After all recurring reports have been inventoried
and classified by an RCS, one folder for each report
should be filed in a report case file. Every folder
should contain the following documents:
• A completed copy of the Reports Analysis Data,
OPNAV Form 5214/10
• A copy of the report form, format, or a copy of
the report
• A copy of the document requiring the report
• Related papers, such as source records, analyses,
surveys, and memos pertaining to the report
Folders within the case file should be arranged
chronologically by report control symbol.
FOLLOW-UP PROCEDURES
Established reports required by the command must
be given a follow-up review to determine whether they
continue to be needed. If they are needed, then the
review must determine whether they continue to meet
all the requirements in the most effective manner.
Elements used to make this determination will include
changing needs and situations, relationship to other
repor ts , poss ib le consol ida t ions , and new
developments in reporting devices and techniques.
A report must be reviewed before its expiration to
determine if it continues to meet requirements
efficiently. The report originator conducts this review
60 days before the third anniversary of i ts
administrative issuance, and the report must include
complete rejustification of the requirement.
One effective way of providing an annual review of
every report required by a command is to combine the
review with the annual review of command directives.
Each required report has a command directive as its
basis. Therefore, a complete review of that directive 3
months before the anniversary month of its issuance
date would provide the opportunity for an in-depth
look at any report listed in the directive. (This is also an
excellent time to accomplish a review of the local
forms used for these reports.)
In a review of the local forms, a copy of the report
form and a blank OPNAV Form 5214/10 covering the
report should be provided to the reviewing office along
with the applicable directive. A decision to modify,
cancel, or continue the existing directive would,
likewise, include a similar decision concerning any
report or form required by the directive.
During the origination or revision of directives, the
reports control point supervisor should verify the
approval of any report required by the directive. The
reports control manager and the forms manager should
approve any required report while the rough directive
is still in the review process. This is also the time for
the reports control point supervisor to verify that the
RCS and report title are specifically included in the
directive.
When a directive is to be cancelled, the control
symbol and title of any report previously required by
that directive are included in the canceling notice or in
the cancellation paragraph of the superseding
instruction. Cancelled reports must be routed through
the forms manager so that obsolete report forms can be
removed from case files.
PUBLISHING LISTS OF REPORTS
The reports control office should publish and
distribute a list of current and cancelled reports
required or prepared by the command. Organizational
units within the command are required to review the
list and notify the reports control office of any
7-3
discrepancies. Revised lists should be published
annually, with quarterly supplements as necessary.
List of Current Reports
The published list of current reports should include
the following information:
• RCS
• Title of the report
• Form number or format
• Frequency of submission
• Document requiring the report
• Specific office within the organization or the unit
outside the organization requiring the report
• Specific office(s) that prepare(s) the report
One copy of the list (usually a command notice)
should be maintained as a master by the petty officer
assigned to monitor reports submissions.
List of Cancelled Reports
A list of all reports cancelled during the
per iod covered by the i s suance shou ld be
appended to each revised list of current reports
and quarterly supplements. The document that
originally required the cancelled report should
also be listed.
An inventory of the reports (and forms) case
file should always be made, no matter how
efficiently the master list and case file were kept
current. This inventory should be made before a
new effective list of current and cancelled reports
is issued.
OVERDUE REPORTS
The most elaborate reports management system
that could be devised is only as good as the actions
taken to make sure reports are submitted and received
on time. The timeliness of reports can be achieved
through the use of a tickler system.
Tickler System
The tickler system provides an index to the
required reports and shows the submission date of
each. The manner in which a tickler file is made up
may vary with each command. It is suggested that you
use 5-inch by 8-inch cards with separators or tabs
marked as follows:
DAILY
WEEKLY (January through December)
MONTHLY
QUARTERLY
SEMIANNUALLY (1 through 31 for use with
current month)
ANNUALLY
WHEN OCCURRING (Situational)
The tabs or separators may be used as needed to
tailor the file to the activity. The separators are
generally placed in a 5-inch by 8-inch box (called the
tickler box). The report tickler file requires daily
attention if it is to be an effective aid.
In addition to being used as a reminder of report
dates, the tickler file may be used as a reminder of
action required for incoming mail (such as a reply that
may be required on an incoming letter) or nonreceipt
of a reply to an outgoing letter from your command.
An easier and more economical reminder of action
required on incoming mail is to attach the third copy of the
routing slip to the mail. In the case of outgoing mail, filing
a copy of the correspondence itself in the appropriate place
in the tickler box serves as a reminder of action required.
Notice to Departments
To make sure departments submit all reports when
due, a command should have a system for alerting them
in sufficient time before the actual due date. This may
be done in one or both of the following ways:
• Adding a list of all the reports due the following
week to the command’s weekly list of overdue
reports/correspondence. This is a recommended
practice for improving timeliness in reports
submissions.
• Providing a reports tickler card to offices
preparing reports. This can stimulate good
two-way communicat ion between the
departments concerned and the reports control
office.
FORMS
As a YN3 or YN2, you should be acquainted with
the Navy’s forms management system. This system is
7-4
set up to design, order, and account for forms used by
your command. As you become more senior and begin
to take on more responsibility, the management of
forms within a command may become part of your
duties.
For the Navy’s purpose, the term form is defined as
all printed or duplicated material, regardless of the
method of reproduction, that contains predetermined
blank spaces for the insertion of information by hand,
typewriter, or other business machine.
IMPORTANCE OF FORMS
The need for forms is well established. They are
vital to the effective management of your office and
your command because they provide information for
formulating policy, controlling and improving
operations, and evaluating performance. Operations
often depend on forms. Forms guide the movement of
materials , the performance of services, the
authorization for expenditures, and the payment of
money. They provide a basis for clerical and executive
actions; they serve as historical references and records.
They are the orders, financial accounts, and portions of
the reports by which government operates.
OBJECTIVES OF FORMS MANAGEMENT
The objectives of forms management at the
command level are as follows:
• To make sure necessary forms and related
procedures are developed and designed to make
the maximum contribution to the command’s
mission
• To eliminate unnecessary and duplicate forms
and, as appropriate, consolidate those serving
like or similar functions using, wherever
practical, the form of the higher echelon.
RESPONSIBILITIES FOR
ADMINISTRATION OF FORMS
MANAGEMENT
The Department of the Navy Forms Management
Program, SECNAVINST 5213.10 series, sets forth
principles, techniques, and methods in establishing
and administering the forms management program;
improving forms and related procedures through
analysis; designing forms to Navy standards; and
training personnel in forms management. It is
considered to be the primary guide for forms design
standards and criteria for the Department of the Navy
(DON).
The Chief of Naval Operations (CNO) exercises
overall supervision of the forms management program
for the DON, according to the policies and standards
established by the Secretary of the Navy. The CNO’s
responsibilities are the following:
• Develop and coordinate the overall program
• Serve as the single point of contact and liaison
with the Office of Secretary of Defense, other
components of the Department of Defense, the
General Services Administration, and other
federal agencies on forms management matters
• Provide related technical guidance and
assistance to the Office of the Secretary of the
Navy and the DON staff offices
• Develop and publish concepts, guides,
techniques, and information for conducting the
program, including standards of design and
analysis of forms and related procedures
Under the CNO, the Chief of Naval Material, and
the Commander, Naval Supply Systems Command, the
Document Automation and Production Service
(DAPS) has the following responsibilities:
• Provide for the printing and procurement of
forms, including liaison for stocking and
distribution
• Recommend consolidation or standardization of
existing forms wherever economy can be
realized
• Provide forms design service to ashore activities
and fleet commands that do not have such
capability or available service
• Provide forms design training for the DON
Each command is responsible for establishing and
maintaining a forms-management program. Forms
management positions must be established and staffed
with trained personnel. A clearing point must be
maintained to review and approve proposed forms,
formats, and directives or other issuances distributing
or requiring forms. In addition, design assistance and
guidance for forms and related procedures must be
provided.
7-5
ESTABLISHING AND OPERATING THE
FORMS MANAGEMENT FUNCTION
As the first step in establishing the function in the
activity, the CO issues a directive that states the
objectives of the function. The CO assigns
responsibility to one organizational unit for its
administration.
Locating and Staffing a Forms
Management Office
The forms management office should be
established on the same level, and usually within the
same organizational unit, as other management
functions for the following reasons:
• The establishment of this office is, and should be
considered as, an integral part of the activity’s
total management improvement effort.
• A study of forms normally involves change in
procedures, records systems, and reports or
other phases of management improvement.
• Forms management can and should complement
other management improvement programs.
• The analytical capabilities required for forms
analysis can be found most readily in an
organizational unit responsible for total
management improvement.
The number and complexity of the forms and
related procedures in an activity determine the number
of personnel assigned on a full-time or part-time basis
to the forms management function.
In a large activity, it may be beneficial to appoint a
forms management representative from each
department, division, or other organizational
component. Such representatives act as liaison with
the forms management officer. These representatives
assist the forms management officer in various
capacities. They may act as liaison for the submission
of proposed new or revised forms. They may be
responsible for assisting in reviews and analyses of
existing and proposed forms and related procedures
within their organizational units. They may often
design the final form. The operational knowledge
provided by the representatives in their liaison duties
speeds up the process of analysis and helps ensure
division acceptance of proposed improvement.
Operating the Forms Management Function
As the first step in the operation, the forms
management office must obtain a complete picture of
the forms situation of the activity. To do this, the forms
management office collects copies of and information
on all forms used in the activity. The forms include
those initiated by the activity and those prescribed by
other sources and used by the activity. These records
are numbered according to the Department of the Navy
File Maintenance Procedures and Standard Subject
Identification Codes, SECNAVINST 5210.11 series,
and arranged by function in a file. The file brings
together data in one place to simplify the evaluation,
combination, improvement, and elimination of forms.
Reviewing New or Revised Forms
Analysis is made not only of existing forms, but
also of all proposed new or revised forms. The
proposed forms and the directives prescribing them or
instructions for their use are submitted to the forms
management office for review before issue.
The forms management office should stress its
readiness and ability to assist in the developmental
stages of the new or revised form. By assisting in the
initial development of the form along with related
procedures, the forms management officer can more
readily understand problems that may arise and
contribute to the development of solutions.
Continuing Review of Forms
The forms management plan emphasizes a
continuing review of forms and related procedures,
preferably on an annual basis. To establish the most
effective new forms and procedures and to analyze and
improve existing forms and procedures, follow these
steps:
• Get all the facts; that is, collect all pertinent
information concerning the form and procedure
under study.
• Subject the facts to detailed analytical
questioning.
• Evaluate the results of such questioning and
develop the necessary solution to the problems
revealed by the questioning.
• Install and test the solutions.
• Follow up to see that the recommended solutions
are continuing in effectiveness.
7-6
FORMS MANAGEMENT RECORDS
Analyzing forms and their related procedures
requires the use of an accurate and workable record of
forms in the activity. This record is not the complete
solution to effective forms management operation, but
rather a tool with which information can be obtained
and systematic analyses can begin.
Collecting Samples of Forms
As discussed earlier, copies of all forms used in the
activity need to be collected. The most satisfactory
method of collecting the samples is by obtaining them
from all organizational components, despite the fact
that there will be duplicates.
Organizational components should submit a copy
of each form they use, both local and nonlocal. It is
essential that the organizational units write on each
form the name of the office using the form and the
estimated annual usage. They should also attach
copies of any directives that prescribe the form or
furnish information for its use. If the instructions for
the form are part of a manual or publication, only the
reference to the manual or publication need be noted.
Filing Forms by SSICs
When samples of forms have been collected, they
are identified and filed. The SSIC is used to identify
and number all the forms. When the forms are
identified and assigned SSICs, they should be placed in
one file. Identifying and filing forms by subject or
function bring together all those having similar
problems. This permits comparison of proposed and
existing forms with all other similar or related forms.
Thus, forms may be consolidated, standardized, or
eliminated if duplication exists.
Activities will gain maximum benefits from the
file by assigning one person the job of keeping the file
up to date. That person can then add new or revised
forms and weed out obsolete ones.
ARRANGEMENT AND CONTENTS
Local forms should be arranged and filed in
numerical order by SSICs. Nonlocal forms are filed in
folders labeled with their basic SSIC; that is, all
nonlocal forms in the 4700 subject group are filed
together in one folder. The folder is then placed in
numerical order in the file drawer.
A separate folder is prepared for each local form.
It is labeled with the originator’s authorized
abbreviation, the SSIC, the consecutive number, and
the title of the form. For example:
SIMA PAC 4700/1-Job Order
As mentioned previously, the folders are filed
numerically by SSIC and consecutive number behind
the folders containing nonlocal forms in the same
subject group. Dividers or dummy folders may be
labeled and used to separate subject groups for which
nonlocal forms are not available.
Each folder of local forms should contain the
following:
• A copy of the directive prescribing the form or
furnishing instructions for its use (or a reference
to the directive if it is in manual form or
otherwise unavailable)
• A copy of the approved design
• Printing requisitions and specifications
• A copy of the printed form and any subsequent
revisions
• A reproducible copy, if pertinent
• A record of the cost of the form; that is, printing,
designing, and procedural analysis costs
• Related papers , analyses , surveys, or
memoranda pertaining to the form or related
procedures; information on contemplated
revisions; or other data
CROSS-REFERENCE
Regardless of your efforts to consolidate related
information into one form to serve a variety of
purposes or functions, two or more forms may still be
required. Under this condition, similar SSICs will
probably be used (though not required) for each form.
Periodic review or the revision or cancellation of any
one of these related forms may require similar action
with the others. A cross-reference to such related
forms filed in their respective folders will prove
extremely helpful.
DISCONTINUED FORMS
When a form becomes obsolete or is replacd by
higher authority, the folder is transferred to a separate
file. This file is organized in the same manner as the
active file; that is, it is arranged by SSIC in numerical
order. The reason for the discontinuation of the form is
noted in the record before the folder is placed in the
discontinued file. Disposition of these files is
7-7
governed by the Navy and Marine Corps Records
Disposition Manual, SECNAVINST 5212.5 series.
SUMMARY
Personnel in organizational units with whom you
have contact concerning reports control and forms
management should be aware of your desire to
assist them as well as your need for their input
and cooperation in carrying out your functions.
Repor t s and forms management cannot be
accomplished by one person; it requires the active
involvement of everyone from the CO down to be
effective.
7-8
CHAPTER 8
SECURITY
A security clearance is a determination, made from
all available information, that an individual is eligible
for access to classified information to a specified level
or, in some cases, is eligible for assignment to other
positions of trust. The clearance tells you someone is
eligible for access; it does not give that person access
authorization. It is important to separate these two
processes: granting clearance and granting access. An
individual may remain eligible for access even though
the person’s present position does not require access to
classified information.
No person will be given access to classified
information unless a favorable determination has been
made of the person’s loyalty, reliability, and
trustworthiness. The initial determination is based on
a personnel security investigation (PSI). Only
commanders, commanding officers (COs), chiefs of
recruiting stations, and the Director of Central
Adjudication Facility are authorized to request PSIs on
personnel under their jurisdiction.
The Defense Security Service (DSS) or, where
specified, the Office of Personnel Management (OPM)
conducts or controls all PSIs for the Department of the
Navy. Requests for PSIs must be kept to the absolute
minimum. They will not be submitted on any civilian
or military personnel who will retire, resign, or
separate with less than 9 months of service remaining.
TYPES OF PERSONNEL SECURITY
INVESTIGATIONS
A PSI is an inquiry into an individual’s activities; it
is used for the specific purpose of making a personnel
security determination. Investigations such as those
conducted for current criminal activity, espionage,
compromise, or subversion have an impact on
employment, clearance, or assignment, but are not
classified as PSIs.
There are a total of eight PSI categories listed in
the Department of the Navy (DON) Personnel
Security Program (PSP) Regulation, SECNAVINST
5510.30 series. As a YN, you will probably only
work three of these: the National Agency Check
(NAC), Single-Scope Background Investigation
(SSBI), and Periodic Reinvestigation (PR).
NATIONAL AGENCY CHECK
An NAC is a search of the files of federal agencies
for information about the person being investigated.
The DSS conducts the check. An NAC includes, as a
minimum, a check of the Defense Clearance and
Investigations Index (DCII) and the FBI files. If either
of those checks reveals information that warrants
further study, the DSS checks the files of other
agencies.
A person who wishes to enter military service
undergoes an entrance NAC (ENTNAC). The
ENTNAC determines the suitability of an individual
for entry into the service.
The PSI request package for an NAC will be
submitted to DSS using the SF 85P, Questionnaire for
Public Trust Positions, and an FD 258, Applicant
Fingerprint Card.
SINGLE-SCOPE BACKGROUND
INVESTIGATION
The SSBI, conducted by the DSS, provides a
greater depth of knowledge than an NAC. Elements
covered in an SSBI include the subject’s education,
neighbors, foreign travel, foreign connections, and
organizational affiliations. DSS does not conduct a
subject interview as part of an SSBI, except to resolve
unfavorable or questionable information. An SSBI
also includes an NAC of the subject’s spouse or
cohabitant and any other members of the subject’s
immediate family 18 years of age or older who are U.S.
citizens other than by birth or who are not U.S. citizens.
The scope of an SSBI is 10 years before the
investigation or from the 18th birthday to the time of
the investigation, whichever is the shorter period;
however, at least the last 2 years must be covered. No
investigation may extend further back than the
subject’s 16th birthday. SSBIs are conducted only
when specifically required by CNO or higher
authority.
8-1
The SSBI request will be submitted to DSS using a
DD1879, DoD Request for Personnel Security
Investigation (original and two copies); SF 86,
Questionnaire for National Security Positions
(original and four copies); and FD 258, Applicant
Fingerprint Card (original and one copy).
PERIODIC REINVESTIGATION
A PR determines a subject’s continued eligibility
for access to classified information by reevaluating a
previous valid investigation of the person. PRs are
conducted every 5 years and should be initiated 4 years
6 months from the completion date of the last
investigation. PR elements include an NAC; a subject
interview; credit, employment, and local agency
checks; interviews of employers; and character
references, to include former spouses.
INVESTIGATIVE REQUIREMENTS
FOR A PERSONNEL SECURITY
CLEARANCE
The investigative requirements for a personnel
security clearance apply to positions involved with
access to classified information. The requirements are
based on the PSI prescribed for the specific
classificat ion level—Top Secret , Secret , or
Confidential—to be accessed in one’s everyday duties.
TOP SECRET
The investigative basis for a Top Secret clearance
is the completion of a favorable SSBI or PR. For those
who have continuous assignment or access to Top
Secret, critical sensitive positions, sensitive
compartmented information (SCI), Nuclear Weapon
Personnel Reliability Program (PRP) positions, and
other such programs (as outlined in chapter 6 of the
PSP), the SSBI must be updated every 5 years by a PR.
This PR must be submitted within 30 days following
granting of the clearance.
SECRET/CONFIDENTIAL
The investigative basis for a Secret or Confidential
clearance is a favorable ENTNAC for first-term
military enlistees. The ENTNAC remains valid
throughout the person’s enlistment, provided no break
in service greater than 12 months occurs. Secret and
Confidential clearances must be updated every 10 and
15 years, respectively. Members assigned to PRP and
some other sensitive programs must have their
clearances updated every 5 years by a PR.
NOTE: The Nuclear Weapon Personnel
Reliability Program (PRP), SECNAVINST
5510.35 series, a program that you, as a YN,
may frequently encounter, provides the
standards of individual reliability required for
personnel performing duties involving nuclear
weapons and components. PRP requires
commands to screen personnel before
transferring them to training leading to PRP
assignment. The investigative requirements
for PRP assignment are based on the position
designation. PRP positions are designated as
either critical or controlled.
Critical: The minimum investigative
requirement for initial assignment is a valid
SSBI completed within the past 5 years. This
requirement may be satisfied by a valid
favorable PR. If there is no investigation to
satisfy the requirement for initial assignment,
the command must request an SSBI. A PR is
required every 5 years.
Controlled: The minimum investigative
requirement for initial assignment is a valid
favorable SSBI completed within the past 5
years. This requirement may be satisfied by a
valid favorable ENTNAC, NAC, SSBI, or PR
completed within the past 5 years. When no
investigation has been conducted to satisfy the
requirements for initial assignment, the
command must request a new NAC.
When an individual is transferred from
one PRP assignment to another, the record of
prior investigation will be accepted in
rescreening the individual at the new
assignment.
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
CENTRAL ADJUDICATION FACILITY
The Department of the Navy Central Adjudication
Facility (DON CAF) was established to provide central
evaluation of individuals receiving security
clearances. This facility is the sole authority to grant,
deny, or revoke security clearances for all Department
of the Navy (DON) personnel. The DSS and the Office
of Personnel Management (OPM) forward all
completed PSIs to DON CAF. The facility then
determines eligibility for security clearances or
assignment to sensitive duties. Upon making a
favorable security clearance/eligibility determination,
DON CAF will notify the command by message, letter,
8-2
or Manpower Management System (MMS), as
appropriate.
REQUESTS FOR DON MILITARY
PERSONNEL
All requests for extensions of interim clearances,
security clearance revalidations, notification of
administrative downgrading or withdrawal of
clearances, and reports of derogatory information are
submitted to DON CAF via the Personnel Security
Action Request.
REVALIDATION UPON TRANSFER/
ACCESS TO SPECIAL ACCESS
PROGRAMS
When an individual who has a security clearance
transfers to a new command into a duty assignment
requir ing access to special access program
information, the gaining command revalidates the
security clearance and submits a Personnel Security
Action Request for clearance at the level needed by the
person to perform those duties.
INTERIM CLEARANCES
Interim clearances may be granted temporarily
(for 180 days) , pending complet ion of ful l
investigative requirements or revalidation of security
clearances from DON CAF. An extension may be
granted beyond the 180 days provided the agency
notifies DON CAF 30 days before the expiration of an
interim clearance. COs should send DON CAF a tracer
action using the Personnel Security Action Request. A
copy of these documents must be maintained in the
individual’s service record or security file until the
investigation and final clearance determination are
completed.
PERSONNEL SECURITY ACTION
REQUEST
The Personnel Security Action Request, as stated
previously, is used to request security determinations
from DON CAF. Complete instructions for completing
this request are on the back of the form. When the
command receives the answer from DON CAF, it is
attached to the member’s Record of Investigation,
Clearance, and Access, OPNAV 5520/20, and retained
in the member’s service record. Copies of all
correspondence relating to clearances may be obtained
for command security files.
CLASSIFIED INFORMATION
NONDISCLOSURE AGREEMENT, SF312
The primary purpose of the Classified Information
Nondisclosure Agreement, SF312, is to inform
individuals of the trust placed in them by their
authorized access to classified information. The
agreement also informs them of their responsibilities
to protect that information from unauthorized
disclosure and of the consequences that may result
from their failure to meet those responsibilities.
All persons with authorized access to classified
information are required to sign this form. The most
opportune time for a person to sign this form is during
preparation of the paperwork requesting clearance
authorization from DON CAF. Although the
information contained in this form is quite lengthy, the
individual should read the form in its entirety before
signing it.
The execution of the form must be personally
witnessed by the individual’s CO, executive officer,
security manager, or supervisor. The witnessing
official must sign and date the agreement at the time it
is executed. An OPNAV 5520/20 entry will be made to
indicate that the individual has executed an SF312.
Should the individual lose access to classified
information for any reason, the form will also be used
for security debriefing.
INFORMATION SECURITY
For the protection of the interests of the United
States, certain information is unavailable to other
countries. This information is given a classification
that determines how much protection it needs. The
level of classification is based on how much damage
would be caused if other countries could obtain it. This
section provides you with the categories of
classification, the rules regarding the safeguarding of
each level, and your responsibilities in handling
classified material.
CLASSIFIED MATERIAL
As discussed in chapter 2, the Department of the
Navy (DON) Information Security Program (ISP)
Regulation, SECNAVINST 5510.36 series, provides
the basis of the Navy’s program for safeguarding
classified information. It was written based on
requirements made at the national level and provides
the procedures and requirements we use on a daily
basis. From the Secretary of the Navy, to the Chief of
8-3
Naval Operations, to your CO, to your command
security manager, to you, this instruction lays down
specific responsibilities and procedures to protect
classified information. Every individual who acquires
access to classified material is responsible for
protecting it. As a YN, you will be directly involved in
this process and must be aware of the regulations given
in this element of the security manuals.
The purpose of the security program is to ensure
that official information is protected to the level and for
the period of time necessary. Essential policies and
procedures have been established to monitor the
Navy’s security program. The effectiveness of this
monitoring is ensured through the process of
identifying the information to be protected, defining a
progressive system for classification, downgrading the
level of classification, and, finally, declassifying the
information when appropriate.
The security of the United States, in general, and of
naval operations, in particular, depends upon the
success of the security program. Don’t let information
fall into the wrong hands through careless talk or
improper handling and safeguarding of written
information.
CATEGORIES OF CLASSIFIED
INFORMATION
Information is classified into three categories,
each category requiring its own level of protection:
Top Secret, Secret, and Confidential.
Top Secret
Top Secret is the designation applied only to
information or material the unauthorized disclosure of
which could reasonably be expected to cause
exceptionally grave damage to the national security.
Examples of exceptionally grave damage include
armed hostilities against the United States or its allies;
disruption of foreign relations vitally affecting the
national security; the compromise of vital national
defense plans or complex crypto logic and
communication intelligence systems; the revelation of
sensitive intelligence operations; and the disclosure of
scientific or technological developments vital to
national security.
Secret
Secret is the designation applied only to
information or material the unauthorized disclosure of
which could reasonably be expected to cause serious
damage to the national security. Examples of serious
damage include disruption of foreign relations
significantly affecting the national security;
significant impairment of a program or policy directly
related to the national security; revelation of
significant military plans or intelligence operations;
compromise of significant military plans or
intelligence operations; and compromise of significant
scientific or technological developments relating to
national security.
Confidential
Confidential is the designation applied to
information or material the unauthorized disclosure of
which could reasonably be expected to cause
identifiable damage to the national security.
Examples of identifiable damage include the
compromise of information that indicates strength of
ground, air, and naval forces in the United States and
overseas areas; disclosure of technical information
used for training, maintenance, and inspection of
classified munitions of war; and revelation of
performance characteristics, test data, design, and
production data on munitions of war.
NOTE: You will come across information marked
For Official Use Only. This is not a category of
classification under the information security program.
You should refer to the PSP for the requirements of
each type of investigation and the level of clearance
authorized by each.
CONTROL OF DISSEMINATION
The CO is responsible for controlling the
dissemination of classified material within the
command. The command security manager is
delegated the responsibility to ensure information is
issued and personnel are instructed on prevention of
unauthorized disclosure of classified information.
Steps must be taken to ensure that the existence,
contents, and whereabouts of classified information
are divulged only to those who are authorized access
and whose official duties require that knowledge.
Responsibility for determining who sees classified
information rests upon each individual who has
possession or knowledge of the information, not the
person who seeks the information. You must be totally
satisfied that you are providing information to a
properly authorized person.
8-4
ACCOUNTABILITY AND CONTROL
Regulations do not guarantee protection—
enforcing them does. The following procedures are
required by the security regulations, and one of your
responsibilities is to know and enforce these
accountability and control procedures. Remember, the
security program is a means, not an end.
Top Secret Accountability
Each copy of a Top Secret document is numbered
at origination with the copy number and total number
of copies created. For example:
Copy number 2 of 10 copies
Each copy of the document will include a list of
effective pages with a record for page checks. Further,
each page of Top Secret letters or messages is
numbered as shown below.
Page 1 of 15 pages
Top Secret documents cannot be reproduced
without permission of the issuing or higher authority.
When permission is granted, any copies made must
also be numbered. Always use the number of the
original the copies are made from as a part of the
numbering sequence. For example:
Copy 14/1 of 2 copies
The 14 indicates the fourteenth copy of the original.
Top Secret material is always transported hand to
hand and receipted for at each exchange.
The security manager or the Top Secret control
officer makes inventory for all Top Secret material at
least annually and at each change of command.
Top Secret Control
A Disclosure Record, OPNAV Form 5511/13,
identifying the document and all personnel who have
had access to the document, is maintained for each
individual document. The record of disclosure is
maintained for 2 years after the document is
transferred, downgraded to a lower classification, or
destroyed.
Secret Accountability
A command must establish administrative
procedures to record Secret material originated or held
by the command. The record can be in the form of a log,
a route slip file (Correspondence/Material Control
Form 5216/10), a serial fi le, or some other
administrative record.
Secret Control
The control procedures for Secret material must
balance security and operating efficiency. The normal
procedure is hand-to-hand transfer between
individuals, but receipt at each transfer within a
command is not required.
Confidential Accountability and Control
Procedures for protecting Confidential material
are less stringent than those for Secret material. There
is no requirement to maintain records of receipts,
distribution, or disposition of Confidential material.
Measures are required, however, to protect it from
unauthorized disclosure by controlling access and
ensuring proper marking, storage, transmission, and
destruction.
Serial Numbers
The Department of the Navy Correspondence
Manual, SECNAVINST 5216.5 series, prescribes that
classified correspondence be serially numbered by the
originator for each calendar year. A serial number is
one of a consecutive group of Arabic numerals
assigned to a specific piece of correspondence for
identification purposes. A separate consecutive group
of numbers is used for each security classification, and
this group of numbers is totally separate and distinct
from the unclassified correspondence serial file
numbers. Serial numbers of Confidential letters are
preceded by the letter C; those for Secret, by S; and for
Top Secret, by TS.
CUSTODIAL PRECAUTIONS
Classified material is not removed from the
physical confines of a command without the
knowledge and approval of the CO or an authorized
representative. When classified material is removed, a
complete list is prepared, signed by the individual
removing the material, and appropriately filed until the
material is returned.
8-5
Care During Working Hours
Each person in the Navy must take every
precaution to prevent deliberate or casual access to
classified information by unauthorized persons. The
following are precautions that must be followed:
• When classified documents are removed from
stowage for working purposes, the documents
are to be kept under constant surveillance or face
down or covered when not in use. At no time will
classified material be left unattended.
• Any items used to prepare classified material
must be destroyed or safeguarded according to
the classification of the material they are used to
produce. These items include drafts, carbon
sheets, carbon paper, correctable film typewriter
ribbons, fabric typewriter ribbons only used
once, plates, stencils, stenographic notes,
worksheets, and similar items. After the upper
and lower sections of a fabric typewriter ribbon
have been cycled through the typewriter at least
five times, the ribbon may be treated as
unclassified.
• Classified material, upon receipt, is opened by
the addressee or by persons specifically
authorized by the addressee in writing to open
material of the grade or classification involved.
• If, for any reason, a room must be vacated during
working hours, any classified material therein
must be stowed according to stowage
instructions for the classification involved.
Care After Working Hours
A system of security checks at the close of each
working day must be instituted to make sure that
classified material held by a command is properly
protected. Custodians of classified material must
make an inspection to ensure the following
requirements have been met:
• Burn bags are properly stowed or destroyed.
• The contents of wastebaskets that contain
classified material are properly stowed or
destroyed.
• Classified shorthand notes, carbon paper,
typewriter ribbons, rough drafts, and similar
papers are properly stowed or destroyed. As a
matter of routine during the day, such items must
be placed in burn bags as soon as they have
served their purpose.
Identification of the individual responsible for the
contents of each container of classified material must
be readily available. The individual so identified is
contacted in the event a container of classified material
is found open and unattended.
Care of Working Spaces
The necessary safeguards must be afforded to
buildings and areas in which classified information is
kept. Precautions must also be taken to minimize any
danger or inadvertent disclosure of classified material
in conversations. You must not discuss classified
information in public places.
Care During Emergencies
Commands are responsible for establishing
detailed procedures and responsibilities for the
protection of classified material in the case of natural
disasters, civil disturbances, or enemy action. Your
command’s emergency bill should provide for
guarding, removing, or destroying classified material
on a priority basis.
TRANSMISSION OF CLASSIFIED
MATERIAL
The term transmission refers to any movement of
classified material from one place to another. The
basic rule is that the material must be in the custody of
an appropriately cleared individual or in an approved
carrier system.
Transmission requirements are basic in nature.
Refer to the ISP for complete details.
Top Secret
Top Secret material cannot be mailed. It must be
hand-carried by the Armed Forces Courier System
(ARFCOS), the Department of State Courier System,
specifically cleared and designated personnel, or
transmitted by way of a fully protected cryptographic
system.
Secret
Secret material may be transmitted in the same
manner as Top Secret or mailed in the U.S. Postal
Service registered mail system.
8-6
Confidential
Confidential material may be transmitted by any
means suitable for Secret material. First-Class Mail
service may be used between DoD activities in the
United States or its territories. Material going to
overseas APO or FPO addresses is sent by registered
mail.
RECEIPT SYSTEM
Top Secret material is covered by a continuous
chain of receipts. Secret material, at a minimum, is
covered by a receipt between commands and other
authorized addressees. Receipts for Confidential
material are not required. The receipt form is attached
to or enclosed in the inner cover.
Postcard receipt forms are unclassified and are
used whenever practical. The form contains only such
information as is necessary to identify the material
being transmitted. Receipts are retained for a
minimum of 2 years.
When a flyleaf (page check) form is used with
classified publications, the postcard receipt is not
required.
The Record of Receipt, OPNAV Form 5511/10,
should be used in receipting for classified material.
PREPARATION FOR TRANSMISSION AND
SHIPMENT
Whenever classified material is transmitted, it
should be enclosed in two opaque, sealed envelopes or
similar wrappings, where size permits, except as
follows:
• Classified written material should be folded or
packed so that the text will not be in direct
contact with the inner envelope or container.
• The inner envelope or container shows the
address of the receiving activity; the highest
classification of the material enclosed including,
where appropriate, the Restricted Data marking;
and any special instructions. It should be
carefully sealed to minimize the possibility of
access without leaving evidence of tampering.
Attach the receipt form (if required).
• The outer cover should not bear a classification
marking, a listing of the contents divulging
classified information, or any other unusual data
or marks that might invite special attention to the
fact that the contents are classified. The outer
cover of Confidential material being transmitted
by United States Postal Service First-Class Mail
should be marked FIRST CLASS and be
endorsed POSTMASTER: DO NOT
FORWARD, RETURN TO SENDER.
Whenever the c lass i fied mater ia l be ing
transmitted is too large to prepare as described above,
it should be enclosed in two opaque, sealed containers,
such as boxes or heavy wrappings, or prepared as
follows:
• If the classified material is an internal
component of a packageable item of equipment,
the outside shell or body may be considered as
the inner enclosure.
• If the classified material is an inaccessible
internal component of a bulky item of equipment
that is not reasonably packageable (such as a
missile), the outside or body of the item may be
considered as the outer enclosure, provided the
shell or body is not classified.
• If the classified material is an item of equipment
that is not reasonably packageable and the shell
or body is classified, it should be draped with an
opaque covering that will conceal all classified
features. The coverings must be capable of
being secured so as to prevent inadvertent
exposure of the item.
• Specialized shipping containers, including
closed cargo transporters, may be used instead of
the above packaging requirements. In such
cases, the container may be considered to be the
outer wrapping or cover.
• Material used for packaging should be of such
strength and durability as to provide security
protection while in transit, to prevent items from
breaking out of the container, and to help detect
any tampering with the container.
The wrappings should conceal all classified
characteristics. Activities will provide for the stocking
of several sizes of cardboard containers and corrugated
paper. Packages must be sealed with tape that will
retain the impression of any postal stamp, preferably
brown paper tape. Bulky packages must be inspected
to determine whether the material is suitable for
mailing or whether you should transmit it by other
approved means.
Closed and locked compartments, vehicles, or cars
should be used for shipments of classified material
except when another method is authorized by the
8-7
consignor. In any event, individual packages weighing
less than 200 pounds gross should be shipped in a
closed vehicle.
ADDRESSEES
Classified material is normally addressed to a
recognized activity and not to an individual. Office
code numbers; office or division titles, such as
Training Division; or similar aids in expediting
internal routing may be used in addition to the
organization address.
For correct mailing addresses, consult the current
issue of the Standard Navy Distribution List, which
contains the official list of fleet and mobile units, their
administrative addresses, and the official list of shore
activities with complete administrative addresses.
The inner envelope or container must show the
address of the receiving activity.
An outer envelope or container must show the
complete and correct address and the return address of
the sender. However, the address may be omitted from
the outer enclosure for shipment in full truckload or
carload lots.
Care must be taken to make sure that classified
material intended only for the United States elements
of international staffs or other organizations is
addressed specifically to those elements.
STOWAGE
Classified material is stowed only at locations
where suitable facilities are available. The ISP details
the requirements for storing material at each level of
classification.
Do not store valuables such as money, jewelry, or
precious metals in the same containers as classified
material. They increase the risk of a container being
illegally opened or stolen.
For emergency purposes, the identity of persons
having access to the container and a symbol indicating
the relative priority of destruction are posted on the
container. In no case, however, should the level of
classified material inside the container be shown.
DESTRUCTION OF CLASSIFIED
MATERIAL
Classified material must be destroyed by burning,
melting, shredding, or other forms of mutilation that
prevent reconstruction of the material.
RECORDS OF DESTRUCTION
Top Secret and Secret material destruction must be
recorded. Use Classified Material Destruction,
OPNAV Form 5511/12, or any other type of record, as
long as it includes space for complete identification of
the material, number of copies destroyed, and date of
destruction.
Both Top Secret and Secret material require two
officials to witness the destruction and sign the
destruction report . Officials responsible for
destruction must have a clearance equal to or greater
than the material being destroyed. The record of
destruction is kept on file for 2 years.
When either Top Secret or Secret material is placed
in a burn bag for central destruction, the witnessing
official(s) should sign the destruction record at the
time the material is actually placed in the bag. Burn
bags are afforded the same protection as the highest
level of material they contain and must be handled by
appropriately cleared personnel.
SECURITY VIOLATIONS
Whether intentional or not, and whether material is
compromised or not, the fact that a procedure was not
followed or was incorrectly performed and could have
caused damage places the person responsible for the
compromise in line for disciplinary action.
Safeguarding classified material is a daily priority.
If a container is found open or unlocked, report it
immediately to someone in authority. A check must be
made as soon as possible to see if compromise was
possible.
If you receive classified material that was
transmitted incorrectly, notify the CO of the sending
unit with a Security Discrepancy Notice, OPNAV
Form 5511/24.
Finally, bring an improperly marked classified
document to the attention of the originator, also with
the Security Discrepancy Notice, OPNAV Form
5511/24.
SUMMARY
This chapter has introduced you to the basic
methods used to process personnel security clearances
and to classified material control. This area is of
extreme importance to the safeguarding of classified
material and, consequently, to the safety of your unit
8-8
and to the country. The best means of protecting our
country’s interests is to ensure only qualified
personnel are given access through a val id
investigative process.
This chapter provides basic information only. The
Department of the Navy (DON) Information Security
Program (ISP) Regulation, SECNAVINST 5510.36
series, and Department of the Navy (DON) Personnel
Security Program (PSP) Regulation, SECNAVINST
5510.30 series, provide detailed information, such as
specific preparation requirements for reports and visit
requests. YNs, no matter what their rank, should
become proficient with the contents and use of these
two extremely important instructions.
8-9
CHAPTER 9
LEGAL
As a Yeoman (YN) you will become extensivelyinvolved with all aspects of nonjudicial punishment,commonly called either NJP or mast. In this chapterwe discuss duties and procedures required before,during, and after NJP proceedings.
NONJUDICIAL PUNISHMENT
Although both commanding officers (COs) andofficers in charge (OICs) can conduct mast, we will useonly the abbreviation CO in this chapter. For adiscussion on the differences between masts held byCOs and OICs, see Article 15, Uniform Code ofMilitary Justice (UCMJ), and part V of the Manual forCourts-Martial (MCM), 2000.
The term nonjudicial punishment and theabbreviation NJP are used interchangeably. They referto certain limited punishments that can be awarded forminor disciplinary offenses by a CO to members of hisor her command. NJP proceedings are called“captain’s mast” or simply “mast.”
Article 15 of the UCMJ, part V of the MCM, 2000,and part B of chapter 1 of the Manual of the JudgeAdvocate General (JAGMAN) contain the basic lawsabout NJP procedures. The legal protection affordedan individual subject to NJP proceedings is morecomplete than is the case for nonpunitive measures,but, by design, is less extensive than for courts-martial.NJP is administrative and is nonadversarial in nature.When punishment is imposed, it is not considered aconviction, and when a case is dismissed, it is notconsidered an acquittal.
The word mast also is used to describe threedifferent types of proceedings: request mast,meritorious mast, and disciplinary mast. Requestmast is a hearing before the CO, at the request ofservice personnel, for making requests, reports,statements, and for airing grievances. Meritoriousmast is for the purpose of publicly and officiallycommending a member of the command fornoteworthy performance of duty. This chapterdiscusses disciplinary mast. When we use the term“mast,” that is what is meant.
Mast is a procedure used by the CO to inquire intothe facts surrounding minor offenses allegedlycommitted by a member of his or her command; toafford the accused a hearing as to the offense(s); and todispose of such charges by dismissing the charges,imposing punishment, or referring the case to acourt-martial.
NATURE AND REQUISITE OFNONJUDICIAL PUNISHMENT
NJP is a disciplinary measure more serious thanadministrative corrective measures, but less seriousthan trial by court-martial. NJP provides commanderswith an essential and prompt means of maintaininggood order and discipline, and also promotes positivebehavior changes in service members without thestigma of a court-martial conviction.
AUTHORITY TO IMPOSE
Authority to impose NJP under Article 15, UCMJ,may be exercised by a CO, an OIC, or by certainofficers to whom the power has been delegated by theSecretary of the Navy (SECNAV).
In the Navy and Marine Corps, billet designationsby the Chief of Naval Personnel and HeadquartersMarine Corps identify those persons who are COs. Sothe term “commanding officer” has a precise meaningand is not used arbitrarily.
The power to impose NJP is inherent in the officeand not in the individual. Thus, the power may beexercised by a person acting as CO, such as when theCO is on leave and the executive officer (XO) succeedsto command.
OICs exist in the naval service. An OIC is acommissioned officer appointed as an OIC of a unit bydepartmental orders, tables of organization, manpowerauthorizations, orders of a flag or general officer incommand, or orders of the senior officer present.
Ordinarily, the power to impose NJP cannot bedelegated. One exception is that a flag or generalofficer in command may delegate all or a portion of hisor her Article 15 powers to a principal assistant. Aprincipal assistant is a senior officer on a flag or
9-1
general officer’s staff who is eligible to succeed tocommand. This delegation must be made with theexpress approval of the Chief of Naval Personnel or theCommandant of the Marine Corps.
Additionally, where members of the naval serviceare assigned to a multiservice command, thecommander of such multiservice command mayappoint one or more naval units and, for each unit,designate a commissioned officer of the naval serviceas CO for NJP purposes over that unit. A copy of suchdesignation must be furnished to the Commander,Navy Personnel Command, or the Commandant of theMarine Corps, as appropriate, and to the JudgeAdvocate General (JAG).
No officer may limit or withhold the exercise ofany disciplinary authority under Article 15 bysubordinate commanders without the specificauthorization of SECNAV.
If a CO determines that his or her authority underArticle 15 is not enough to make a proper disposition ofthe case, he or she may refer the case to a superiorcommander for appropriate disposition. This situationcould arise either when the CO’s NJP powers are lessextensive than those of his or her superior, or when thestatus of higher authority would add force to thepunishment, as in the case of a letter of reprimand oradmonition.
PERSONS ON WHOM NJP MAY BEIMPOSED
A CO may impose NJP on all military personnel ofhis or her command. An OIC may impose NJP only onenlisted members assigned to the unit that he or she isin charge of.
At the time punishment is imposed, the accusedmust be a member of the command of the CO (or of theunit of the OIC) who imposes the NJP. A person is ofthe command or unit if he or she is assigned or attachedto it. This includes temporary additional duty(TEMADD) personnel. TEMADD personnel may bepunished either by the CO of the unit that they areTEMADD to or by the CO of the duty station that theyare permanently attached to. Note, however, that bothCOs cannot punish an individual under Article 15 forthe same offense. In addition, a party to anadministrative investigation remains a member ofthe command or unit that he or she was attached to atthe time of his or her designation as a party for the solepurpose of imposing a letter of admonition orreprimand as NJP.
Personnel of Another Armed
Force
Under present agreements between the armedforces, a Navy CO should not exercise NJP jurisdictionon Army or Air Force personnel assigned or attached toa naval command. As a matter of policy, return thesepersonnel to their parent-service unit for discipline. Ifthis is impractical and the need to discipline is urgent,NJP may be imposed, but a report to the Department ofthe Army or Department of the Air Force is required.See the Naval Mi l i tary Personnel Manual(MILPERSMAN), Article 1300–070, for theprocedures to follow.
Express agreements do not extend to Coast Guardpersonnel serving with a naval command, but otherpolicy statements say that the naval command shouldnot try to exercise NJP over such personnel assigned toits unit. Because the Marine Corps is part of theDepartment of the Navy, no general restriction extendsto the exercise of NJP by Navy commanders overMarine Corps personnel or by Marine Corpscommanders over Navy personnel.
Imposition of NJP on
Embarked Personnel
The CO or OIC of a unit attached to a ship for dutyshould, as a matter of policy, refrain from exercisinghis or her power to impose NJP and refer all suchmatters to the CO of the ship for disposition. Thispolicy does not apply to Military Sealift Command(MSC) vessels operating under masters or to organizedunits embarked on a Navy ship for transportation only.Nevertheless, the CO of a ship may permit a CO or anOIC of a unit attached to that ship to exercise NJPauthority.
Imposition of NJP on
Reservists
Reservists on active duty for training or, undersome circumstances, inactive duty for training, aresubject to the UCMJ and, therefore, subject to theimposition of NJP.
The offense(s) that the CO or OIC seeks to punishat NJP must have occurred while the member was onactive duty or inactive duty training. However, it is notnecessary that NJP occur (or the offense even bediscovered) before the end of the active duty or inactiveduty training period during which the alleged
9-2
misconduct occurred. In that regard, the officerseeking to impose NJP has the following options:
• He or she may impose NJP during the active dutyor inactive duty training when the misconductoccurred.
• He or she may impose NJP at a later period ofactive duty or inactive duty training (so long asthis is within 2 years of the date of the offense).
• He or she may request from the regularcomponent officer exercis ing generalcourt-martial jurisdiction (OEGCMJ) over theaccused an involuntary recall of the accused toactive duty or inactive duty training to imposeNJP.
• If the accused waives his or her right to bepresent at the NJP hearing, the CO or OIC mayimpose NJP after the period of active duty orinactive duty training of the accused has ended.
Punishment imposed upon persons who wereinvoluntarily recalled for imposition of NJP may notinclude restraint unless SECNAV approves the recall.
Right of an Accused to Demand Trial byCourt-Martial
Article 15a, UCMJ, and part V, para. 3, MCM,2000, provide another limitation on the exercise ofNJP. Except for a person attached to or embarked in avessel, an accused may demand trial by court-martialin lieu of NJP.
This right to refuse NJP exists up until the time ofimposition of NJP (that is, up until the CO announcesthe punishment). This right is not waived by theaccused having previously signed a report chitshowing that he or she would accept NJP.
The category of persons who may not refuse NJPincludes those persons assigned or attached to a vesselwho are on board for passage, or assigned or attachedto an embarked staff, unit, detachment, squadron,team, air group, or other regularly organized body.
The key time factor in determining whether or nota person has the right to demand trial by court-martialis the time of the imposition of the NJP and not the timeof the commission of the offense.
There is no power for a CO or an OIC to imposeNJP on a civilian.
OFFENSES PUNISHABLE UNDERARTICLE 15, UCMJ
Article 15 gives a CO power to punish individualsfor minor offenses. The term “minor offense” hasbeen the cause of some concern in the administration ofNJP.
Article 15, UCMJ, and part V, para. 1e, MCM, saythat a minor offense is misconduct normally not moreserious than that usually handled at an summarycour t -mar t ia l (SCM) (where the maximumpunishment is 30 days’ confinement). These sourcesalso say that the nature of the offense and thecircumstances surrounding its commission are alsofactors that should be considered in determiningwhether an offense is minor in nature.
The term “minor offense” ordinarily does notinclude misconduct that, if tried by a generalcourt-martial (GCM), could be punished by adishonorable discharge (DD) or confinement for morethan 1 year. The Navy and Marine Corps, however,have taken the position that the final determination ofwhether an offense is minor is within the sounddiscretion of the CO.
Cases Previously Tried in Civil Court
Sections 0108b and 0124c(2) of the JAGMANpermit the use of NJP to punish the accused for anoffense for which he or she has been
• tried (whether acquitted or convicted) by adomestic or foreign civilian court,
• diverted out of the regular criminal process for aprobationary period, or
• adjudicated by juvenile court authorities.
These sections are only applicable, however, ifauthority has been obtained from the OEGCMJ (usuallythe general or flag officer in command over thecommand desiring to impose NJP).
NJP may not be imposed for an act tried by a courtthat derives its authority from the United States, suchas a federal district court.
Cases in which a finding of guilt or innocence hasbeen reached in a trial by court-martial cannot be takento NJP.
9-3
Off-Base Offenses
COs and OICs may dispose of minor disciplinaryinfractions that occur on base or off base at NJP.Unless the off-base offense is a traffic offense or onepreviously adjudicated by civilian authorities, there isno limit on the authority of military commanders toresolve such offenses at NJP.
In areas not under mil i tary control , theresponsibility for maintaining law and order rests withcivil authority. The enforcement of traffic laws fallswithin the purview of this principle. Off-duty,off-installation driving offenses, however, showinability and lack of safety consciousness. Suchdriving performance does not prevent the use ofnonpunitive measures that could include denial ofon-installation driving privileges.
THE NJP PACKAGE
The NJP package, as we will refer to it, includesnumerous documents and forms, along with anyevidence on the case. As we will discuss, strictcompliance with filling out the forms is essential to aproper NJP proceeding.
REPORT AND DISPOSITION OFOFFENSE(S)
Your office may receive notification in a variety ofways that an offense has been committed. These wayscan include a shore patrol report, a verbal complaint bya victim, or a local report chit. Except when seriouscrimes are involved, charges are reduced to writing onthe Report and Disposition of Offense(s), NAVPERS1626/7, and processed in the manner prescribed by theform itself.
The NAVPERS 1626/7 is a one-shee t(back-and-front) form. It is not a substitute for acharge sheet, and it is not a substitute for the pretrialinvestigation required by Article 32, UCMJ. However,so long as the offense(s) remains in the group of casesto be handled by the CO at mast, this one form satisfiesmost paper work requirements of a mast proceeding.Among the functions the NAVPERS 1626/7 serves arethe following:
• It reports the offense(s).
• It records that the accused has been advised ofhis or her rights under Article 31, UCMJ.
• It serves as a preliminary inquiry report.
• It records the action of the XO at screening mast.
• It records that the accused has been advised ofthe right to refuse NJP (if that right exists underthe circumstances of the case).
• It shows the action of the CO at mast.
• It records that appeal rights have been explainedto the accused.
• It becomes a permanent record of the case in theUnit Punishment Book (UPB). No additionalrecord (such as 3 x 5 cards or a mast logbook) isneeded.
Remember, however, that the NAVPERS 1626/7does not include all the required premast advice thatmust be given to the accused according to theJAGMAN, section 0109.
PREPARATION INSTRUCTIONS
Regardless of how the commission of a minoroffense is brought to your attention, you will probablyneed to prepare the smooth NAVPERS 1626/7, anexample of which is found at figure 9–1. Let’s look atthe information that you will place on this form.
There are four distinct sections to the front ofNAVPERS 1626/7:
1. Report of offense: In this section, start withaddressing the report to the OIC or CO of theaccused. Fill in the date of the report. Type the nameof the accused in last name, first name, middle initialorder. Verify the social security number from theaccused’s service record and type it in. Type in thepresent rate of the accused and the branch and classof service. Designate the department or division thatthe accused is attached to. Fill in the place of theoffense. If there is more than one place, list allapplicable places of the offense(s). Show the date ofthe commission of the offense. If there is more thanone date, show all dates.
In the area entitled Details of the Offense, it is notmandatory that you type the offenses in the manner thatyou would on a charge sheet. However, this is goodpractice. If you always prepare a specification in fulldetail, you will not have to change it in the event thecharges are referred to a court-martial.
List military witnesses to the offense in order ofseniority, followed by civilian witnesses, if any. If awitness is attached to the same command as the
9-4
accused, it is only necessary to give the witness’division or department. If the witness is attached toanother command, identify that command completely.If a witness is a civilian, give the complete address,business and home, if available. Finally, be sure to getthe signature of the person placing the accused onreport.
2. Acknowledgment of rights: This sectionshows the acknowledgment of the accused having beeninformed of the nature of the accusation(s) against himor her and his or her right not to answer any questionsrelating to the offense. After the accused is formallyinformed of the accusations against him or her, thissection should be signed by the accused and the personinforming the accused of his or her rights. If the accusedrefuses to sign this section, that fact must be witnessedby the person informing the accused of the accusations,who will sign attesting to that fact.
3. Premast restraint: While this section is titled“premast restraint,” the only authorized forms ofrestraint are pretrial restraint and pretrialconfinement. You may order an individual into pretrialrestraint only if you are contemplating drafting chargesfor a court-martial. No form of restraint is authorizedfor charges that are intended for NJP.
4. Information concerning accused: Thissection shows information about the accused. Get theaccused’s service record before filling out this section toverify all the information. In the section Record ofPrevious Offense(s), list all NJPs and courts-martialduring the accused’s current enlistment.
PREMAST SCREENING
After you complete the front of the NAVPERS1626/7, the reverse side of the form must also becompleted. The sections, as shown in figure 9-2 (i.e.,Preliminary Inquiry Report, Action of ExecutiveOfficer, Right to Demand Trial by Court-Martial,Act ion of Commanding Officer, and Fina lAdministrative Action), are, by and large, self-explanatory. The information required in each sectionis detailed in the following paragraphs.
PRELIMINARY INQUIRY
The first step is to refer the report chit to an officeror a senior enlisted person for a preliminary inquirythat will later be screened by the XO.
At small commands, refer the cases to divisionofficers for the preliminary inquiry. At large
commands, the discipline officer or the legal officer isdelegated the authority to appoint the preliminaryinquiry officer (PIO). You need to fill in the name ofthe PIO at the top of the “Preliminary Inquiry Report”section before referring it to the PIO for action.
It is not the job of the PIO to develop a case againstthe accused. Rather, the PIO is to collect all availablefacts about the offense itself and about the backgroundof the accused. You should have a standard form thatthe PIO prepares for submission to the CO.
The suspect’s rights acknowledgement/statementcontains a suggested format that may be used byinvestigative personnel in cases in which criminalsuspects desire to waive their r ights onself-incrimination and to make statements. This formatis designed as a guide, and its use is not mandatory.However, you should provide the PIO with this form incase the accused desires to make a statement.
In addition to filling out a PIO’s report, the PIOcompletes this section by doing the following:
• Inserting a short résumé of the division officer’sopinion of the accused
• Listing the names of the witnesses whosepresence at mast is necessary to dispose of thecase
• Recommending disposition of the case
• Summarizing the evidence that supports therecommendation
The recommendation of the PIO is not binding on theCO.
After the PIO has completed his or her inquiryreport, all statements are sent to the CO for adetermination of whether disposition by NJP isappropriate.
PREHEARING ADVICE
If, after the preliminary inquiry, the CO determinesthat disposition by NJP is appropriate, the CO mustmake sure the accused is given the advice outlined inpart V, para. 4, MCM, 2000. The CO need not give theadvice personally but may assign this responsibility tothe legal officer, discipline officer, or other appropriateperson. The advice that must be given includes thefollowing:
CONTEMPLATED ACTION. This informs theaccused that the CO is contemplating the imposition ofNJP for the offense(s).
9-6
SUSPECTED OFFENSE(S). This describes thesuspected offense(s) to the accused. The descriptionshould include the specific article(s) of the UCMJ thatthe accused is alleged to have violated.
GOVERNMENT EVIDENCE. This advises theaccused of the information that the allegations arebased on. It also informs the accused that, uponrequest, he or she is allowed to examine all availablestatements and evidence.
RIGHT TO REFUSE NJP. Unless the accused isattached to or embarked in a vessel (in which case he orshe has no right to refuse NJP), this informs theaccused of his or her right to demand trial bycourt-martial in lieu of NJP. The accused must also beinformed
• of the maximum punishment imposable at NJP;
• that if he or she demands trial by court-martial,referral of the charges to trial by an SCM, anSPCM, or a GCM is possible;
• that he or she cannot be tried by a specialcourt-martial (SPCM) over his or her objection;and
• that at an SPCM or a GCM he or she has the rightto representation by counsel.
RIGHT TO CONFER WITH INDEPENDENTCOUNSEL. Because an accused who is not attachedto or embarked in a vessel has the right to refuse NJP,this informs the accused of his or her right to conferwith independent counsel about his or her decision toaccept or refuse the NJP. This advice must be given tomake sure the record of that NJP is admissible inevidence against the accused should he or she ever betried by court-martial. A failure to advise an accusedproperly of his or her right to confer with counsel, or afailure to provide counsel, will not, however, render theimposition of NJP invalid or make a ground for appeal.Therefore, if the command imposing the NJP desiresthat the record of the NJP be admissible forcourt-martial purposes, you must prepare the record ofthe NJP according to applicable service regulationsand show that the accused
• was advised of his or her right to confer withcounsel;
• either exercised his or her right to confer withcounsel or made a knowing, intelligent, andvoluntary waiver of this right; and
• knowingly, intelligently, and voluntarily waivedhis or her right to refuse NJP. All such waiversmust be in writing.
HEARING RIGHTS. The accused is entitled toappear personally before the CO for the NJP hearing ifhe or she did not demand trial by court-martial, or if theright to demand trial by court-martial is not applicable.At such a hearing the accused is entitled to
• be informed of his or her rights under Article 31,UCMJ;
• be accompanied by a spokesperson provided by,or arranged for, the member (the proceedingsshould not be unduly delayed to permit thepresence of the spokesperson, nor is thespokesperson entitled to travel or similarexpenses);
• be informed of the evidence against him or herrelating to the offense;
• be allowed to examine all evidence that the COwill rely on in deciding whether and how muchNJP to impose;
• present matters in defense, extenuation, andmitigation, orally, in writing, or both;
• have witnesses present. These witnesses mayinclude those adverse to the accused, uponrequest, if (a) their statements will be relevant,(b) they are reasonably available, (c) the cost oftheir appearance will not require reimbursementby the government, (d) their appearance will notunduly delay the proceedings, or (e) in the caseof a military witness, will not necessitate theirbeing excused from other important duties; and
• have the proceedings open to the public unlessthe CO determines that the proceedings shouldbe closed.
FORMS
The form that you must use to record that theaccused was informed of his or her prehearing rightswill depend upon the status of the accused.
The accused’s notification and election of rights asillustrated in appendixes A-1-b, A-1-c, and A-1-d ofthe JAGMAN, comply with the previous requirementsof prehearing advice to the accused.
Use appendix A-1-b when the accused is attachedto or embarked in a vessel.
9-8
Use appendix A-1-c when an accused is notattached to or embarked in a vessel and the commanddoes not afford the accused the right to consult with alawyer to assist the accused in deciding whether toaccept or reject NJP. In this case the record of NJP willnot be admissible for any purpose at any latercourt-martial.
Use appendix A-1-d when an accused is notattached to or embarked in a vessel and the commandaffords the accused the right to consult with a lawyerbefore deciding whether to accept or reject NJP.
The use and retention of the proper form isessential. Whatever form you use, attach it to theNAVPERS 1626/7 and retain it in the command’s UnitPunishment Book (UPB).
In the event punishment is imposed at captain’smast and appendix A-1-d is used, or the accused isrepresented by a lawyer at the hearing, you will need todocument the Booker rights advice on a page 13 of themember’s service record book. This is necessarybecause appendix A-1-d stays in the command’s UPB.If the member transfers out of the area and is latercharged with offenses that are referred to acourt-martial, the trial counsel (TC) can prove Bookerrights advice was given with the page 13. As anexample, the page 13 should state the following:
(Grade and name of accused) signed JAGManual, appendix A-1-d, before his or hercaptain’s mast which was held on (date ofcaptain’s mast). The accused [talked to alawyer before deciding whether to demandtrial by court-martial in lieu of captain’s mast][gave up his or her right to talk to a lawyerbefore deciding whether to demand trial bycourt-martial in lieu of captain’s mast]. Theaccused was advised that acceptance of NJPdoes not preclude further administrativeaction. In completing the remainder of theform, the accused did not demand trial bycourt-martial in lieu of captain’s mast.
If the accused is represented by a military orcivilian lawyer as a personal representative at his or hercaptain’s mast, the following example should be madeon a page 13:
(Grade and name of accused) receivedpunishment at captain’s mast on (date). Theaccused was represented by a lawyer.
If the member refuses to sign the forms, simplyrecord that you advised the member of his or her rights
but he or she declined to sign the forms. Note that themember must demand trial by court-martial and, if heor she fails to make such a demand, the command mayproceed with NJP. Once all prehearing advice is given,the accused is ready for the XO’s screening.
EXECUTIVE OFFICER’S SCREENING
The XO may screen a case by holding an informalhearing or may merely review the record of the accusedand the report chit. If the XO has been given the powerby the CO, he or she may dismiss the case, but maynever impose punishment.
At the XO’s screening mast, the accused is advisedagain of the right to refuse NJP and demand a trial bycourt-martial. At this point, the “Right to DemandTrial by Court-Martial” section of NAVPERS 1626/7can be signed by the accused if it was not signed before.Be sure to get the witness’signature in this section also.
Remember that Article 15, UCMJ, does not givethe right to refuse NJP to persons attached to vessels.Also remember that an accused not attached to orembarked in a vessel may elect at any time beforeimposition of NJP to refuse it and demand acourt-martial. It is, then, possible for an accused toelect not to demand trial by court-martial at the XO’sscreening but later at captain’s mast demand it,provided it is before any punishment is imposed.
Once the XO has conducted an inquiry, he or shehas the option of referring the case to mast ordismissing it. The XO fills in the “Action of ExecutiveOfficer” section, noting the action he or she has taken.If the case is referred to the CO for mast, a formalhearing is set up.
THE HEARING PROCEDURE
Captain’s mast is held at the time and place decidedon by the CO. The XO, legal officer, or disciplineofficer normally assists the CO. Additionally, amaster–at–arms will be present to keep order and callthe accused to mast. Your function will be to have theservice record of the accused and other associateddocuments available for the CO.
While local practices will come into play as far assetting up the mast and the formalities required,appendix A-1-e of the JAGMAN is the official guidefor the NJP proceedings.
HEARING REQUIREMENTS
Except as noted in the following paragraph, NJPcases must be handled at a hearing whereby the
9-9
accused is allowed to exercise the foregoing rights. Inaddition, there are other technical requirements aboutthe hearing and the exercise of the accused’s rights.
Personal Appearance Waived
Part V, para. 4c(2), MCM, 2000, provides that ifthe accused waives his or her right to appear personallybefore the CO, he or she may submit written matters forconsideration by the CO before the imposition of NJP.If the accused makes this election, inform the accusedof his or her right to remain silent and that any matterssubmitted may be used against him or her at a trial bycourt-martial.
Notwithstanding the accused’s expressed desire towaive his or her right to appear personally at the NJPhearing, he or she may be ordered to attend the hearingif the officer imposing NJP desires his or her presence.If the accused waives his or her personal appearanceand NJP is imposed, the CO must make sure theaccused is informed of the punishment as soon aspossible.
Hearing Officer
Normally, the officer who actually holds the NJPhearing is the CO of the accused. COs and OICs areallowed to delegate their authority to hold the hearingto another officer under extraordinary circumstances.These circumstances must be unusual and significantrather than matters of convenience to the commander.This delegation of authority should be in writing andthe reasons for it detailed. This delegation, however,does not include the authority to impose punishment.At such a hearing, the officer delegated to hold thehearing will receive all evidence, prepare asummarized record of matters considered, and send therecord to the officer having NJP authority.
Personal Representative
The burden of getting a representative is on theaccused. As a practical matter, the accused is free tochoose anyone he or she wantslawyer or anonlawyer, an officer or an enlisted person. Thisfreedom of the accused to choose a representative doesnot compel the command to provide lawyer counsel.Current regulations do not create a right to lawyercounsel at NJP, whereas such a right does exist atcourt-martial.
Representation by any lawyer who is willing andable to appear at the hearing is available to the accused.While a lawyer’s workload may prevent the lawyerfrom appearing, a blanket rule that no lawyers will be
available to appear at Article 15 hearings would appearto contravene the spiritif not the letterof the law. Itis, likewise, doubtful that a lawyer can lawfully beordered to represent the accused. It is fair to say thatthe accused can have anyone who is able and willing toappear on his or her behalf without cost to thegovernment. While a command does not have toprovide a personal representative, it should help theaccused get the representative he or she wants. In thisconnection, if the accused desires a personalrepresentative, he or she should be allowed areasonable time to get someone. Good judgmentshould be observed here, for such a period should beneither too short nor too long.
Witnesses
When the hearing involves controverted questionsof fact about the alleged offenses, witnesses should beavailable to testify if they are present on the same shipor base or are otherwise available at no expense to thegovernment. Thus, in a larceny case, if the accuseddenies that he or she took the money, the witnesses whocan testify that the accused did take the money shouldbe called to testify in person if they are available at nocost to the government. It should be noted, however,that no authority exists to subpoena civilian witnessesfor an NJP proceeding.
Public Hearing
The accused is entitled to have the hearing open tothe public unless the CO determines that theproceeding should be closed for good cause. The CO isnot required to make any special arrangements tofacilitate public access to the proceedings.
Publication of NJP Results
Authority to publish the results of NJP is grantedby the JAGMAN, section 0115. You may publish thename, rate, offense(s), and disposition of the offenderin the plan of the day (POD). Publish the results notlater than 1 month after the imposition of NJP. If theNJP is appealed, publish the results not later than 1month after the date the appeal is denied. If the POD isdistributed to military personnel only, you may includeall the details stated previously. If the POD isdistributed to other than military personnel, NJPresults may be published without the name of theaccused.
POSSIBLE ACTIONS BY THE CO AT MAST
Any action taken by the CO at mast must be notedin the “Action of the Commanding Officer” section of
9-10
the reverse side of NAVPERS 1626/7. Possible actionsinclude the following:
Dismissal With or Without Warning. Thisaction is taken if the CO is not convinced by theevidence that the accused is guilty of an offense ordecides that no punishment is appropriate in light ofthe accused’s record and other circumstances.Dismissal, whether with or without a warning, is notconsidered NJP, nor is it considered an acquittal.
Referral to an SCM, SPCM, or a PretrialInvestigation under Article 32, UCMJ. The COmay, at his or her sole discretion, refer the charge(s) toan SCM, an SPCM or an Article 32 investigation. Thiswill, of course, depend upon the severity of thecharges.
Postponement of action. The CO may postponeany action on the NJP pending further investigation orfor other good cause, such as a pending trial by civilauthorities for the same offense.
Imposition of NJP. The CO may impose NJP andaward any of the authorized punishments outlined inpart V, para. 5, MCM, 2000.
AUTHORIZED PUNISHMENTS
If convinced by the evidence that the accused isguilty of the offense(s) and he or she deemspunishment is appropriate, the CO has wide latitude toimpose punishment. There are, however, limitationsthat are placed on the CO based upon his or her rankand the status of the accused.
LIMITATIONS
The maximum imposable punishment in anyArticle 15, UCMJ, case is limited by several factorsthat include the following:
The grade of the imposing officer: COs in gradesO-4 to O-6 have greater punishment powers thanofficers in grades O-1 to O-3 (flag officers, generalofficers, and OEGCMJs have greater punishmentauthority than COs in grades O-4 to O-6).
The status of the imposing officer: Regardless ofthe rank of an OIC, his or her punishment power islimited to that of a CO in grades O-1 to O-3 (thepunishment powers of a CO are commensurate with hisor her permanent grade).
The status of the accused: Punishment authorityis also limited by the status of the accused (Is theaccused an officer or an enlisted person attached to orembarked in a vessel?).
Maximum punishment limitations apply to eachNJP action and not to each offense. Note that there is apolicy that all known offenses that the accused issuspected of should ordinarily be considered at a singleArticle 15 hearing.
MAXIMUM LIMITS—SPECIFIC
There are specific maximum limits on punishmentthat may be imposed on an individual. The accused’sstatus as an officer, a warrant officer, or an enlisted personwill determine on the type of punishment that may beimposed. Also, the rank of the official imposing thepunishment is a limiting factor on the amount and type ofpunishment that may be awarded. Table 9-1 outlines thelimits of authorized NJP punishments.
NATURE OF THE PUNISHMENT
There are eight specific types of punishment thatmay, under proper circumstances, be imposed as NJP.They are
• admonition and reprimand,
• arrest in quarters,
• restriction,
• forfeiture,
• extra duty,
• reduction in grade,
• correctional custody, and
• confinement on bread and water or diminishedrations.
Remember, there are limitations that are based upon theCO’s rank and the status of the offender.
Admonition and Reprimand
Admonition and reprimand are two forms ofcensure intended to express adverse reflection upon orcriticism of a person’s conduct. A reprimand is a moresevere form of censure than an admonition. Whenimposed as NJP, the admonition or reprimand isconsidered to be punitive, unlike the nonpunitiveadmonition and reprimand. Punitive censure forofficers must be in writing, although it may be eitheroral or written for enlisted personnel. Procedures forissuing punitive letters are detailed in the JAGMAN,section 0114. A sample punitive letter of reprimand isshown in the JAGMAN, appendix A-1-g.
9-11
9-12
Imposed upon: By: Punishment authorized:
Punitive admonition or reprimand.
Arrest in quarters for not more than 30consecutive days.
Restriction to specified limits, with or withoutsuspension from duty, for not more than 60consecutive days.
OEGCMJ, an officer ofgeneral or flag rank in
command, ordesignated principal
assistantForfeiture of not more than 1/2 of 1 month's payper month for 2 months.
Admonition or reprimand.
Any CO Restriction to specified limits, with or withoutsuspension from duty, for more than 30consecutive days.
Commissionedofficers and
warrantofficers
OICOICs do not have authority to impose NJP
upon officers.
Admonition or reprimand.
Confinement on bread and water or diminishedrations for not more than 3 consecutive days. (E-3 or below only, attached to or embarked on avessel.)
Correctional custody for not more than 30consecutive days. (E-3 or below only.)
Forfeiture of not more than 1/2 of 1 month's payper month for 2 months.
Reduction of one paygrade (E-6 and below).Reduction not imposable on Navy E-7 or
above or Marine Corps E-6 or above.
Extra duties for not more than 45 consecutivedays.
COs of the grade oflieutenant commander
(O-4) or above, or aprincipal assistant
Restriction to specified limits for not more than 60consecutive days.
Admonition or reprimand.
Confinement on bread and water or diminishedrations for not more than 3 consecutive days. (E-3 or below only, attached to or embarked on avessel.)
Correctional custody for not more than 7consecutive days. (E-3 or below only.)
Forfeiture of not more than 7 days' pay.
Reduction to the next inferior paygrade, if thegrade from which demoted is within the promotionauthority of the officer imposing the reduction.Reduction not imposable on Navy E-7 or
above or Marine Corps E-6 or above.
Extra duties for not more than 14 consecutivedays.
Enlistedpersonnel
COs of the grade oflieutenant (O3) or
below, or anycommissioned OIC
Restriction for not more than 14 consecutive days.
Table 9-1. Maximum Punishments
Arrest in Quarters
This punishment is imposable only on officers. Itis a moral restraint, as opposed to a physical restraint.It is similar to restriction, but has much narrowerlimits. The limits of arrest are set by the officerimposing the punishment and may extend beyondquarters. The term quarters includes military andprivate residences. The officer may be required toperform his or her regular duties as long as they do notinvolve the exercise of authority over subordinates.
Restriction
Restriction is the least severe form of deprivationof liberty. Restriction involves moral rather thanphysical restraint. The severity of this type of restraintdepends on its duration and the geographical limitsspecified when the punishment is imposed. A personundergoing restriction may be required to report to adesignated place at specified times, if reasonablynecessary to make sure the punishment is beingproperly executed.
Restriction ashore means that an accused will berestricted to the limits of the command except, ofcourse, at larger shore stations where the use ofrecreational facilities might be further restricted.Restriction and arrest in quarters are normally imposedby a written order detailing the limits thereof andusually requires the accused to log in at certainspecified times during the restraint. Article 1103 ofU.S. Navy Regulations, 1990, provides that an officerplaced in the status of arrest or restriction will not beconfined to his or her room unless the safety or thediscipline of the ship requires such action.
Forfeiture
Forfeiture means a permanent loss of entitlementto the pay forfeited. A forfeiture applies to basic payand to sea or foreign duty pay, but not to incentive payor allowances for subsistence or quarters. The amountof forfeiture of pay is expressed in whole dollaramounts, not in fractions, and shows the number ofmonths affected. An example of a properly statedforfeiture is to forfeit $50 pay per month for 2 months.
If the punishment includes both reduction,whether or not suspended, and forfeiture of pay, theforfeiture must be based on the grade the accused isreduced to. Forfeitures are effective on the dateimposed, unless suspended or deferred. Where aprevious forfeiture is being executed, that forfeiture
will be completed before any newly imposed forfeiturewill be executed.
Extra Duty
Extra duties involve the performance of duties inaddition to those normally assigned to the personundergoing the punishment. Various types of dutiesmay be assigned, including fatigue duties. The MCMprohibits extra duties that are a known safety or healthhazard, those that are cruel and unusual, or those thatare not sanctioned by the customs of the serviceinvolved.
When extra duties are imposed upon a petty officeror noncommissioned officer, the duties cannot bedemeaning to his or her rank or position. Theimmediate CO of the accused normally designates theamount and character of extra duty. Such dutiesnormally should not extend beyond 2 hours per day.Guard duty may not be assigned as extra duty. Extraduty is not performed on the individual’s Sabbath,although that day will count as if such duty wasperformed.
Reduction in Grade
Reduction in paygrade is limited to one grade onlyfor members in paygrades E-1 through E-6. E-7through E-9 personnel cannot be reduced in grade atNJP. The grade from which reduced must be within thepromotional authority of the CO imposing thereduction. See also the NAVMILPERSMAN, Article1450-010, for additional information on reduction.
Correctional Custody
Correctional custody is a form of physical restraintof a person during either duty or nonduty hours, orboth, and may include hard labor, extra duties, orfatigue duties. Awardees may perform military dutybut not watches and cannot bear arms or exerciseauthority over subordinates. Specific regulations foradministering correctional custody can be found inInstructions for Administering Correctional Custody,OPNAVINST 1640.7 series.
Time spent in correctional custody is not lost time.Correctional custody may not be imposed onpaygrades E-4 and above. To assist commanders inimposing correctional custody, correctional custodyunits (CCUs) have been established at major shoreinstallations. The local operating procedures for the
9-13
nearest CCU should be checked before correctionalcustody is imposed.
Confinement on Bread and Water orDiminished Rations
These punishments can only be awarded to E-3sand below if they are attached to or embarked in avessel. These punishments involve physicalconfinement and are equivalent to sol i taryconfinement because contact is allowed only withauthorized personnel.
A medical officer must first certify in writing thatthe accused will suffer no serious injury and that theplace of confinement will not harm the accused.Diminished rations is a restricted diet of 2,100calories per day, and instructions for its use are detailedin SECNAVINST 1640.9 series.
APPEAL FROM NJP
A member who is awarded NJP and who believesthe punishment unjust or disproportionate to theoffense has the right to appeal the award to higherauthority.
PROCEDURE
If punishment is imposed at NJP, the CO isrequired to make sure the accused is fully advised ofhis or her right to appeal. Refer to part V, para.4c(4)(B)(iii), MCM, 2000, and the JAGMAN, section0110e. An accused’s acknowledgement of appealrights should be signed by the accused and witnessed toprove that the accused was informed of his or herappeal rights. File this along with all the other papersin the accused’s case file in the UPB.
A person punished under Article 15 may appeal theimposition of such punishment through properchannels to the appropriate appeal authority. If,however, the offender is transferred to a new commandbefore filing his or her appeal, the immediate CO of theoffender at the time the appeal is filed should send theappeal directly to the officer who imposed thepunishment.
When the officer who imposed the punishment isin the Navy chain of command, the appeal willnormally be sent to the area coordinator authorized toconvene general courts-martial. A GCM authoritysuperior to the officer imposing punishment may,however, set up an alternate route for appeals.
When the area coordinator is not superior in rankor command to the officer imposing punishment, orwhen the area coordinator is the officer imposingpunishment, the appeal will be sent to the GCMauthority next superior in the chain of command to theofficer who imposed the punishment. An immediate ordelegated area coordinator who has authority toconvene GCMs may take action instead of an areacoordinator if he or she is superior in rank or commandto the officer who imposed the punishment.
For mobile units, the area coordinator with GCMauthority is the area coordinator most accessible to theunit at the time of sending the appeal.
When the officer who imposed the punishment isin the chain of command of the Commandant of theMarine Corps, the appeal will be made to the officernext superior in the chain of command to the officerwho imposed the punishment.
When the officer who imposed the punishment hasbeen designated a CO for naval personnel of amultiservice command, the appeal will be madeaccording to the JAGMAN.
A flag or general officer in command may, with theexpress prior approval of the Chief of Naval Personnelor the Commandant of the Marine Corps, delegateauthority to act on appeals to a principal assistant. Anofficer who has delegated his or her NJP power to aprincipal assistant may not act on an appeal frompunishment imposed by that assistant.
TIME
Appeals must be submitted in writing within 5days of the imposition of NJP, or the right to appeal iswaived in the absence of good cause shown. Theappeal period runs from the date the accused isinformed of his or her appeal rights. Normally, this isthe day NJP is imposed. If an appeal is submitted morethan 5 days after the imposition of NJP (less anymailing delays), the officer acting on the appealdetermines whether good cause was shown for thedelay in the appeal.
If it appears to the accused that good cause mayexist that would make it impossible or extremelydifficult to prepare and submit the appeal within the5-day period, the accused should immediately advisethe officer who imposed the punishment of theproblems and request an extension of time. The officerimposing NJP determines whether good cause was
9-14
shown and advises the accused whether an extension oftime is permitted.
UNIT PUNISHMENT BOOK
The UPB contains a record of all NJP hearingsconducted by a command—not just those in whichpunishment was awarded—and is required by theMILPERSMAN. The form that is used to record NJPhearings is the NAVPERS 1626/7. When all actionshave been completed on a particular NJP hearing, thespace provided in the “Final Administrative Action”portion of the NAVPERS 1626/7 that indicates whenthe case record is filed in the UPB should be filled out.Although there is no requirement to do so, it is goodadministrative practice to attach all relevantdocuments on that particular case to the NAVPERS1626/7.
There are no specific instructions as to the mannerin which these cases should be filed in the UPB;however, the suggested procedure is to file cases inalphabetical order, chronological order by date, or acombination of both.
LOG ENTRIES
The Standard Organization and Regulations of theU.S. Navy (SORM), OPNAVINST 3120.32 series,prescribes the log entry for mast results afloat. Such anentry should be substantially in the format for the PODentry, and you should provide this information to theofficer of the deck (OOD) for inclusion in the deck log.Although there is no Navywide requirement forlogbooks ashore, you will find that logs are kept ashorepursuant to local instructions. Unless these localinstructions require a different format, you shouldprovide information about the mast results to the OODin the same format that is used afloat.
SUMMARY
NJP is the lowest form of discipline available toCOs to aid them in maintaining good order anddiscipline within the Navy. It is important for you, as aYN, to keep abreast of all requirements and proceduresassociated with the proper administration of NJP, notonly because of its effect upon individuals, but also itseffect upon the Navy.
ADMINISTRATIVE INVESTIGATIONS
Almost every YN will have contact with anadministrative investigation, previously referred to as aJAGMAN investigation. The regulations that governthese investigations are contained in the Manual of theJudge Advocate General (JAGMAN) and JAGINST5830.1 series.
The primary purpose of an administrativeinvestigation is to provide the convening authority(CA) and reviewing authorities with adequateinformation upon which to base decisions. Anadministrative investigation searches out, develops,assembles, analyzes, and records all availableinformation about the matter under investigation. Asthe name indicates, these investigations are purelyadministrative in nature and not judicial, although theycan become the basis for judicial proceedings. Theinvestigation is advisory in nature only; the opinionsare not final determinations or legal judgments, nor arethe recommendations made by the investigating officer(IO) binding upon the convening or reviewingauthorities.
The type of investigation to be convened isdetermined by the purpose(s) of the inquiry, theseriousness of the issues involved, the time allotted forcompletion of the investigation, and the nature andextent of the powers required to conduct a thoroughinvestigation. This section will concentrate on themost common administrative investigations, thecommand investigation and the litigation-reportinvestigation. Courts of inquiry and boards of inquirywill also be discussed. Keep in mind, however, thatmany of the basic rules and principles discussed in thissection also apply to other types of investigations. Asis the case with any investigation, the primary functionof an investigation is to gather information. Commandinvestigations and litigation-report investigations donot have the power to designate parties and, therefore,do not have the collateral function of providing ahearing to a party.
TYPES OF INVESTIGATIONS
There are three types of adminis t ra t iveinves t iga t ions : command invest igat ions ,litigation-report investigations, and courts andboards of inquiry . The importance of anadministrative investigation cannot be stressedenough. It is not only an efficient management tool,but it can also be used in a wide variety of situations,ranging from proper disposition of claims to the timely
9-15
and accurate reply to public inquiry. Various directivesestablish requirements for conducting inquiries intospecific situations. The JAG Manual, however, is themost inclusive. Some incidents involve conducting aninquiry for several different purposes that can behandled by one investigation; others may not. The CAmust be careful to determine why an investigation isbeing conducted and what type of investigation willsatisfy legal requirements.
An officer in command is responsible for initiatinginvestigations of incidents occurring within his or hercommand or involving his or her personnel. If anofficer in command feels that investigation of anincident by the command is impractical, anothercommand can be reques ted to conduct theinvestigation.
If an incident requiring the convening of aninvestigation occurs at a place geographically distantfrom the command or the command deploys before aninvestigation can be completed, another command canbe requested to conduct the investigation. This requestshould be made to the area coordinator in whosegeographical area of responsibility the incidentoccurred.
A single investigation should be conducted into anincident involving more than one command. Theinvestigation should be convened by the officer incommand of any of the activities involved. Ifdifficulties arise concerning who should convene theinvestigation, the common superior of all commandsinvolved will determine who will convene it. If theconduct or performance of one of the officers incommand may be subject to inquiry (as in the case of acollision between ships), the common superior of allthe officers involved will convene the investigation.
Command Investigations
A command investigation is the most common ofthe administrative investigations and is used primarilyfor incidents that are of command interest only. Forexample, a command investigation would be used forthe following:
• Property losses other than damage to ordestruction of government quarters
• Death by apparent suicide of a military memberat a location under military control
• Aircraft incidents, groundings, floodings, fires,and collisions not determined to be a majorincident
Litigation-Report Investigations
When an incident or event is likely to result inclaims or civil litigation against or for the Departmentof the Navy, the primary purpose of the resultinginvestigation is to prepare to defend the legal interest ofthe United States. A command that has an incident thatmay fit into this category should consult with a judgeadvocate at the earliest possible time to determine ifthis type of investigation is warranted. Incidents of thisnature must be conducted under the direction andsupervision of a judge advocate and protected fromdisclosure to anyone who does not have a need to know.Information obtained under these circumstances isknown as attorney work product and is notconsidered discoverable evidence. If the investigationis not accomplished under JAG supervision andproperly protected, all materials gathered during theinvestigation become evidence that is available toanyone filing suit against the government.
A litigation-report investigation is unlike acommand investigation in that it must be conductedunder the supervision and direction of a judge advocateand must be forwarded to the Judge Advocate General.It is similar to a command investigation, however, inthat it may not investigate a major incident, designateparties, or involve a hearing.
Courts and Boards of Inquiry
Procedures for courts and boards of inquiry may befound in JAGINST 5830.1 series. These investigationsuse a hearing and are only appropriate wheninvestigating a major incident. A major incident isdefined as an incident that results in multiple deaths,substantial property loss, substantial harm to theenvironment, or a significant departure from theexpected level of professionalism, leadership, orjudgment.
Courts and boards of inquiry are conducted byhearing, may designate parties, and may subpoenawitnesses. A court of inquiry consists of at least threecommissioned officers, and a board of inquiry is madeup of at least one commissioned officer. Courts ofinquiry that have granted the parties those rightsrequired under Article 31, UCMJ, may be further usedas an Article 32 investigation if charges before ageneral court-martial are contemplated.
9-16
THE INVESTIGATORY BODY
Most command or litigation report investigationswill be conducted by a commissioned officer, but awarrant officer, senior enlisted person, or civilianemployee may also be used when the conveningauthority considers it appropriate. InvestigatingOfficers (IOs) must be those individuals who are bestqualified for the duty by reason of age, education,training, experience, length of service, andtemperament. Unless impractical, the IO should besenior to any person whose conduct or performance ofduty will be subject to inquiry. An expert mayparticipate as IO or for the limited purpose of using hisor her special experience. The report should makeclear any participation by an expert. Counsel is notappointed for command investigation; however,litigation reports are conducted under the directsupervision and direction of a judge advocate.
Courts of inquiry consist of at least threecommissioned officers and have appointed legalcounsel for the court. A court reporter will be assigned,as all testimony must be recorded verbatim and underoath. Boards of inquiry consist of one or morecommissioned officers and may have appointed legalcounsel for the court.
APPOINTING ORDER
Any officer in command may order a command orlitigation report investigation. For purposes of theJAGMAN, an officer in command means an officerauthorized to convene any type of court-martial orauthorized to impose disciplinary punishment underArticle 15, Uniform Code of Military Justice (UCMJ).This also includes officers in charge (OICs). Courtsand boards of inquiry must be convened by the generalcourt-martial convening authority or an individualdesignated by the Secretary of the Navy.
Form of Appointing Order
An appointing order must be in official letter form,addressed to the IO of the one-officer investigation.When circumstances warrant, an investigation may beconvened by an oral or message order. The IO mustinclude the signed, written confirmation of oral ormessage orders in the investigative report.
Purpose of Appointing Order
The appointing order serves several purposes. Itrecites the specific purpose(s) of the investigation,
gives explicit instructions as to the scope of the inquiry,and directs the IO to the required witness warnings.
These instructions help the IO accomplish all theobjects of the investigation, not just the CA’simmediate objectives. For example, in the case of avehicle accident involving a member of the navalservice, the following aspects, among others, may beaddressed:
• the CA who orders the investigation may beconcerned whether local procedures regardingthe use of government vehicles should bechanged and whether disciplinary action may bewarranted;
• the JAG may be concerned with a line-of-duty/misconduct determination; and
• the cognizant naval legal service office (NLSO)claims officer will be concerned with potentialclaims for or against the government.
Investigative Aspects
All administrative investigations are required tomake findings of fact. In the typical investigation, theappointing order directs the IO to conduct a thoroughinvestigation into all the circumstances connected withthe subject incident and to report findings of facts,opinions, and recommendations concerning thefollowing:
• The resulting damage
• The injuries to members of the naval service andtheir line of duty and misconduct status
• The circumstances attending the death ofmembers of the naval service
• The responsibility for the incident underinvestigation, including any recommendedadministrative or disciplinary action
• Claims for and against the government
• Any other specific investigative requirementsthat are relevant, such as those contained in theJAGMAN
During the course of the investigation, on advice ofthe investigative body or on his or her own initiative,the CA may broaden or narrow the scope of the inquiryby issuing supplemental directions amending theappointing order.
Unless specifically directed by the appointingorder, opinions or recommendations are not made. The
9-17
CA may require recommendations in general or inlimited subject areas.
The appointing order may direct that testimony orstatements of some or all witnesses be taken under oathand may direct that testimony of some or all witnessesbe recorded verbatim. When an administrativeinvestigation takes testimony or statements ofwitnesses under oath, it should use the oaths prescribedin JAGMAN 0212b.
Privacy Act Concerns
The Privacy Act requires that a Privacy Actstatement be given to anyone who is requested tosupply personal information in the course of aadministrative investigation when that informationwill be included in a system of records. Note thatwitnesses will rarely provide personal information thatwill be retrievable by a witness’name or other personalidentifier. Since such retrievability is the cornerstoneof the definition of system of records, in most cases thePrivacy Act will not require warning anyone, unlessthe investigation may eventually be filed under thatindividual’s name.
Social security numbers should not be included inadministrative investigation reports unless they arenecessary to precisely identify the individualsinvolved, such as in death or serious injury cases. If aservice member or civilian employee is asked tovoluntarily provide their social security number for theinvestigation, a Privacy Act statement must beprovided. If the number is obtained from othersources, the individual does not need to be providedwith a Privacy Act statement. The fact that socialsecurity numbers were obtained from other sourcesshould be noted in the preliminary statement of theinvestigation.
Warnings
If prosecution for a suspected offense under theUCMJ appears likely, the witness suspected of theoffense should be warned under Article 31(b), UCMJ,and JAGMAN 0170. Appendix A-1-m of theJAGMAN shows the proper form to be used. The IOshould collect all relevant information from all sourcesother than from those persons suspected of offenses,misconduct, or improper performance of duty beforeinterviewing the suspect.
A member of the armed forces, before being askedto provide any statement relating to the origin,
incurrence, or aggravation of any disease or injurysuffered, should be advised of the statutory right not tomake such a statement. Appendix A-2-f of theJAGMAN contains a proper warning format andwithout this warning the statements are invalid.
Time Limits
The appointing order directs completion of theIO’s report within 30 days of the date of the appointingorder. JAGMAN 0202c established the following timelimits for processing administrative investigations:
• The CA prescribes the time limit the fact-findingbody has to submit its investigation. This periodshould not normally exceed 30 days from thedate of the appointing order; however, thisperiod may be extended for good cause. Alwaysinclude requests and authorizations forextension as enclosures to the investigation.
• The CA and any subsequent reviewer each have30 days (20 days in death cases) to review theinvestigation. Reasons for exceeding these timelimits must be documented by the responsibleendorser, and deviations must be requested andapproved in advance by the immediate senior incommand who wil l next review theinvestigation.
INVESTIGATIONS REQUIRED BY OTHERREGULATIONS
If an investigation is required under the JAGMAN,it must be conducted in addition to any otherinvestigation required by other regulations. Situationsin which two investigations may be required are listedin JAGMAN Article 0208a.
An administrative investigation is not required ifthere is no reason for the investigation other thanpossible disciplinary action. To avoid interference, anadministrative investigation should not normallyproceed at the same time as a law-enforcement type ofinvestigation by the Federal Bureau of Investigations(FBI), NCIS, or local civilian law-enforcement units.
If an investigation is required for other thandisciplinary action, the IO should communicate withthe law-enforcement personnel, explaining the needfor the administrative investigation, and request thatthe police investigators keep him or her informed ofwhat information is obtained.
9-18
Other types of investigations that have additionalinstructions and guidance include the following:
• Safety investigations (OPNAVINST 5100.14series)
• Aircraft accident reports and aircraft mishapinvestigations (OPNAVINST 3750.6 series)
• Accidental injury to personnel (OPNAVINST5100.12 series)
• Admiralty (JAGINST 5880.1 series)
• Felonies involving both naval and civilianpersonnel (SECNAVINST 5820.1 series)
• Crimes involving exclusive NCIS jurisdiction(SECNAVINST 5520.3 series and OPNAVINST5450.97 series)
• Security violations (OPNAVINST 5510.1series)
• Stolen government property (SECNAVINST5500.4 series)
• Claims for or against the government (JAGINST5830.1 series)
• Postal violations (OPNAVINST 5112.6 series)
INVESTIGATIVE REPORT
The investigative report, submitted in letter form,consists of the following items:
• A preliminary statement
• Findings of fact
• Opinions
• Recommendations (will only be included ifdirected by the CA in the Appointing Order)
• Enclosures
Preliminary Statement
The purpose of the preliminary statement is toinform the convening and reviewing authorities that allreasonably available evidence was collected and thatthe directives of the CA have been met. Thepreliminary statement should refer to the appointingorder and set forth the following information:
• The nature of the investigation
• Any limited participation by a member and/orthe name of any individual who assisted and the
name and organization of any judge advocategeneral who assisted
• Any difficulties encountered in the investigationand the reasons for any delay
• If the evidence in the enclosures is in any waycontradictory, a factual determination in thefindings-of-fact section along with anexplanation of the basis for that determination(this explanation should be reserved for materialfacts)
• Any failure to advise individuals of their rights
• The fact that all social security numbers wereobtained from official sources
• An attorney work product statement when aclaim, or litigation by or against the UnitedStates, is reasonably possible
• Any other information necessary for a completeunderstanding of the case
Do not include a synopsis of facts, recom-mendations, or opinions in the preliminary statement.These should appear in the pertinent sections of theinvestigative report. It is not necessary for the IO toprovide an outline of the method used to obtain theevidence contained in the report. A preliminarystatement does not eliminate the necessity for makingfindings of fact. Even though the subject line andpreliminary statement may talk about the death of aperson in a car accident, findings of fact must describethe car, time, place of accident, identity of person, andother relevant information.
Findings of Fact
Findings of fact must be as specific as possible asto times, places, persons, and events. Each factcomprises a separate finding. Each fact must besupported by testimony of a witness, statement of theIO, documentary evidence, or real evidence attached tothe investigative report as an enclosure. Also, eachenclosure on which the fact is based must bereferenced. For example, the IO may not state, “Thecar ran over Seaman Doe’s foot,” without a supportingenclosure. He or she may, however, have Doe execute astatement such as, “The car ran over my foot.” Includethis statement as an enclosure and, in the findings offact, state, “The car ran over Seaman Doe’s foot,”referencing enclosure (X). When read together, thefindings of fact should tell the whole story of theincident without requiring reference back to theenclosures.
9-19
Opinions
Opinions are reasonable evaluations, inferences,or conclusions based on the facts. Each opinion mustreference the findings of fact supporting it. In certaintypes of investigations, the CA will require the IO tomake observations and provide opinions.
Recommendations
Recommendations are proposals derived from theopinions expressed, made when directed by the CA,and may be specific or general in nature. If correctiveaction is recommended, the recommendation shouldbe as specific as possible.
Enclosures
The first enclosure to the investigative report iseither the signed written appointing order and anymodifications, or the signed written confirmation of anoral or message appointing order. Include any requestsfor extensions of time as enclosures, in addition toletters granting or denying such requests.
JAGMAN 0229a requires the IO to properlyidentify all persons involved in the incident underinvestigation with complete name, grade or title,service or occupation, and station or residence. Thelist of enclosures is a suggested place for ensuringcompliance with that section.
Enclosures are listed in the order referenced in theinvestigative report. Separately number andcompletely identify each enclosure. Make eachstatement, affidavit, transcript of testimony,photograph, map, chart, document, or other exhibit aseparate enclosure. If the IO’s personal observationsprovide the basis for any finding of fact, a signedmemorandum detailing those observations should beattached as an enclosure. Enclose a Privacy Actstatement for each party or witness from whompersonal information was obtained as an attachment tothe individual’s statement. The signature of the IO onthe investigative report serves to authenticate all theenclosures.
Classification of Report
Because of the wide circulation of administrativeinvestigative reports, classified information should be
omitted unless inclusion is essential. When included,however, the investigative report is assigned theclassification of the highest subject matter contained init. Encrypted versions of messages are not included orattached to investigative reports where the content orsubstance of such message is divulged. To assist in theprocessing of requests for release of investigations andto simplify handling and storage, declassify enclosureswhenever possible. If the information in questioncannot be declassified but contributes nothing to thereport, consider removing the enclosure from theinvestigation with notification in the forwardingendorsement.
ACTION BY THE CONVENING ANDREVIEWING AUTHORITIES
The IO submits the administrative investigativereport to the CA, who reviews it and transmits it byendorsement to the appropriate superior officer. Theendorsement will accomplish one of the followingactions:
• Return the report for further inquiry or correctiveaction noting any incomplete, ambiguous, orerroneous action of the IO
• Forward the record, setting forth appropriatecomments, recording approval or disapproval, inwhole or in part, of the proceedings, findings,opinions, and recommendations
In line-of-duty/misconduct investigations, the CAis required to specifically approve or disapprove theline-of-duty/misconduct opinion.
SUMMARY
Your knowledge of the proper procedures involvedwith the conduct and preparation of the various typesof administrative investigations is an important aspectof your duties as a YN. Additional informationconcerning these investigations can be found inchapter II of the Manual of the Judge AdvocateGeneral and JAGINST 5890.1 series. Whenever youare involved with working on an administrativeinvestigation, you should take the time to review theapplicable sections of the JAGMAN and JAGINST5890.1 series to make sure all procedures and anyspecial requirements are followed.
9-20
CHAPTER 10
AWARDS
Awards are important symbols of recognition and ameans of publicly recognizing extraordinary,exceptionally meritorious, or conspicuouslyoutstanding acts of heroism and other acts of servicethat are above and beyond that normally expected.
In th is chapter we discuss how awardrecommendations are prepared using the informationcontained in the Navy and Marine Corps AwardsManual, SECNAVINST 1650.1 series.
POLICY CONSIDERATIONS
Awards are intended to recognize truly exceptionalperformance and valor. The value of an award is that itis given in cases only where it is clearly deserved.
Awards recognizing specific acts should be givenas soon as possible after the act occurred. Recognitionof sustained superior performance should normally begiven at the termination of the period during which thatperson demonstrated that performance, such as at theend of the person’s assigned tour of duty. A routineend-of-tour award IS NOT a part of the awards system.
ELIGIBLE PERSONNEL
Personnel eligible to receive awards includepersonnel in the naval service, the U.S. Marine Corps,reserve components, and the U.S. Coast Guard (whenthe Coast Guard or units thereof operate under thecontrol of the Navy). Also eligible are U.S. NavalAcademy midshipman and Naval Reserve OfficerTraining Corps (NROTC) midshipmen when servingon active duty.
Anyone who meets the eligibility criteria for anaward may be recommended for i t by anycommissioned officer senior to the individual beingrecommended.
AUTHORITY TO APPROVE THE NAVYAND MARINE CORPS ACHIEVEMENT
MEDAL
Per NAVADMIN 265/00, delegation of authorityto approve the Navy and Marine Corps Achievement
Medal was granted by CNO to the commanding officerlevel. This authority extends to both the end-of-tourand special-achievement (NAMs), and there are nolimitations to the number of awards issued by theawarding authority. This authority extends to allpersonnel permanently assigned to the command. Itdoes not, however, extend to other service personnel. Italso does not extend to foreign service personnel(SECNAV retains this authority).
RECOMMENDATION FOR AWARDS
As previously stated, a recommendation for anaward may be submitted by any commissioned officer,senior to the individual being recommended, havingknowledge of any act, achievement, or service whichmay warrant the award. A recommendation originatedby other than the commanding officer of the individualconcerned must be forwarded to the commandingofficer for endorsement.
TIMELINESS
An award recommendation must be submitted assoon as possible following the act, achievement, orservice upon which it is based if the awards system is tobe successful.
Submit a recommendation for meritorious servicewhen an individual’s detachment is anticipated. Whena reporting senior is being detached and feels that theservice of a subordinate merits recognition, thePersonal Award Recommendation Form, OPNAV1650/3, should be completed for the observed period.It should be retained within the command, pendingdetachment of the individual. If at the time the currentreporting senior feels the latter portion of theindividual’s tour merits recognition, the recommen-dation should be combined with the earlier one; if not,the recommendation of the predecessor should beforwarded for consideration on its own merits by theawarding authority empowered to approve the award.
An award for meritorious service terminating withretirement or separation should be processed so thatthe presentation may be made at the individual’scurrent duty station.
10-1
PREPARATION
Prepare recommendations for personal awards onOPNAV Form 1650/3. Instructions for the preparationof the awards form can be found in chapter 2 of theAwards Manual. When additional space is required,add sheets of standard size paper. Use a separate formfor each award being recommended.
SUMMARY OF ACTION
Since each award recommendation is evaluated onthe merits of the justification, this part of therecommendation is required in all cases. Avoidgeneralities and excessive use of superlatives. Presentan objective summary giving specific examples of theperformance and manner of accomplishing it, togetherwith the results and benefits derived.
NOTE: Some commands do not requiresummaries of action for NAMs. Localdirectives will govern in these cases.
CITATION
A proposed citation, which is a condensed versionof the summary of action, must accompany therecommendation. Although a citation is laudatory andformal, it must be factual and contain no classifiedinformation. Non-combat citations are limited to 22typewritten lines.
NOTE: Navy Commendation Medal andNavy and Marine Corps Achievement Medalcitations are printed on special citation paper.The citations are limited in length to 7½ lines.
Opening Sentence
The citation begins with a standard phrasedescribing the degree of meritorious, professional, orheroic service as specified in the Awards Manual foreach award, the duty assignment of the individual, theinc lus ive dates of serv ice on which therecommendation is based, and, if desired, a descriptionof operations of the unit to which the individual isattached.
Statement of Heroic/MeritoriousAchievement or Service
The second part of the citation identifies therecip ient by name, descr ibes speci fic dutyassignments, accomplishments, and the outstanding
personal attributes displayed. The description of theindividual’s achievements must show clearly that theywere sufficient to justify the award recommended. Ifduty was performed in combat, the citation should sostate.
Commendatory Remarks
The third part of the citation states that theoutstanding attributes, mentioned or implied,“reflected great credit upon him/herself and were inkeeping with the highest traditions of the United StatesNaval Service.”
SUBMISSION OF RECOMMENDATIONS
Two months should be al lowed for theadministrative processing of award recommendations.Allow 90 days if the award is submitted through alengthy chain of command or during the summermonths (late May through August).
Classified recommendations may be submitted;however, the highest classification which may behandled is SECRET. If information classified higherthan SECRET is essential, submit it separately.
Recommendations may be sent by message or faxonly in the most unusual circumstances, such as whenthe importance of a timely presentation justifiesspecial handling.
Address recommendations directly to theawarding authority having jurisdiction over theindividual at the time of the act or service. A list ofawarding authorities is provided in the AwardsManual.
Awarding authorities may take one of thefollowing actions:
• Approve the award
• Approve a lower award
• Disapprove the award
• Approve a higher award, if empowered to do so,or recommend a higher award to the appropriateauthority
• Return the award for further clarification orjustification
10-2
LETTERS OF APPRECIATION ANDCOMMENDATION
Letters of appreciation (LOA) and letters ofcommendation (LOC) are intended to promote morale.These kinds of letters are difficult to write. In mostcases they are tailored to the recipient and cannot bereused. These letters are normally given at thecommand level, but can be issued by the next higherechelon in the command’s chain of command.
In an LOA, begin by expressing thanks to theindividual. In an LOC, begin by commending theindividual for his or her support or accomplishments.Next, in both types of letters, summarize the type of
support or accomplishments that the individual isbeing recognized for. Then end by thanking or praisingthe individual once again. A penned postscript on theletter gives it a special meaning.
SUMMARY
This chapter has dealt with the most commonawards issued to personnel. The Awards Manual listsall other awards that may be issued, and detailedprocessing procedures. You will become very familiarwith this manual as you gain experience. Remember:When in doubt, go to the manual.
10-3
CHAPTER 11
OFFICER DISTRIBUTION CONTROL
REPORT (ODCR)
The Format and Procedures for Validating the
Officer Distribution Control Report (ODCR),
BUPERSINST 1301.40 series, is provided to assist
administrative officers in determining proper action to
take regarding personnel accounting events that occur
in the normal course of business at naval activities. As
you take on more responsibilities as a YN, you will be
required to work with ODCRs. You may be asked to
verify the ODCR, type ODCR letter correction
requests, type or prepare diary message reporting
system entries, or forward copies of the ODCR to
customer commands.
PREPARATION OF ODCR
COMNAVPERSCOM prepares an ODCR for each
naval activity with officer billets authorized and
officers on board in a temporary duty status. Officer
billet and assignment information in the ODCR
represents the computer data bank input by the Chief of
Naval Operations (CNO); COMNAVPERSCOM;
Enlisted Personnel Management Center (EPMAC);
Manpower, Personnel and Training Information
System (MAPTIS); Source Data System (SDS); and
various other sources.
COMNAVPERSCOM prepares the ODCR
monthly as a statement of account for Navy activities
with a routine system for verifying information
contained in the MAPTIS officer personnel data bank.
The information is used to determine and evaluate
officer personnel requirements.
VALIDITY OF THE ODCR
The validity of ODCR information depends upon
the t imely submiss ion of accura te da ta to
COMNAVPERSCOM through the Diary Message
Reporting System (DMRS), SDS, and other pertinent
reporting systems. Each activity should review its
ODCR thoroughly when it is received, and correct all
discrepancies found.
The ODCR reflects four specific types of
information: activity, administrative, personnel, and
fitness report. Two copies of the ODCR are distributed
to activities monthly. COMNAVPERSCOM distributes
microfiche copies of appropriate ODCRs to the unit
level via the type commanders.
DISTRIBUTION TO COMMANDS
When a Pay/Personnel Administrative Support
System (PASS) Detachment supports an activity, the
verification procedures described in this chapter are
the responsibility of the PASS Detachment. However,
it is still the responsibility of the unit commanding
officer (CO) to ensure that information on the ODCR is
correct. The supporting PASS Detachment will
provide a copy of the ODCR to the command. The CO
is responsible for validating the ODCR upon receipt,
and the senior YN is normally tasked to do so on behalf
of the commanding officer. If the data concerning an
officer are incorrect on the ODCR, the officer’s
individual record at COMNAVPERSCOM is also
incorrect.
VERIFICATION OF THE ODCR
Verify billet data and every item of officer data to
ensure that they are complete and current. Note
discrepancies and correct them following instructions
contained in Format and Procedures for Validating the
Officer Distribution Control Report (ODCR),
BUPERSINST 1301.40, enclosure (2). Error codes
will be printed on the ODCR as an aid in spotting
incorrect information. They do not cover all possible
errors on the ODCR. For SDS and DMRS
transactions, pay close attention to the ODCR date.
Transactions applied after that date will be on the next
ODCR.
For those activities supported by SDS, corrective
actions using DMRS and ODCR submission have been
replaced with the event entry capability. SDS is an
automated, closed-loop reporting system. Feedback
automatically updates the SDS mini-master record to
reflect headquarters processing. Because those data
are transmitted electronically, information contained
in the ODCR ( table 11-1) will reflect changes faster.
11-1
11-2
DATA ELEMENT INFORMATION REQUIRED
Activity Name The long activity title (26 positions maximum, including spaces).
Activity Code A 10-digit identification code assigned by BUPERS.
Manpower
Requirements Plan
(MARP)
The OPNAV four-digit code by which Navy activities are classified
functionally.
Activity Sponsor The Resource Sponsor controlling billets authorized and organization
manning for the activity.
Transaction
Number and Date
The current revision to the Activity Manpower Document (AMD), used to
record authorized billets on the ODCR.
Date of Report A six-digit (YYMMDD) date representing the last day of the month for which
the ODCR has been prepared.
Run Date A six-digit (YYMMDD) date representing the day the ODCR was created.
Page Sequential page number of the ODCR.
Desk Code A four-position alphanumeric code indicating the BUPERS organizational unit
responsible for the activity concerned.
Activity Mission
Code (AMC)
A two-position alphanumeric functional activity grouping code assigned and
used by PERS-4 for distribution purposes.
Unit Identification
Code (UIC)
A five-digit code assigned the activity by the Comptroller of the Navy.
Action Officer Desk
Code (AODC)
A two-position alphanumeric code identifying the action officer responsible for
data written for the activity, in the Qualitative Master Data sets.
Billet Sequence
Code (BSC)
A five-digit code assigned to each activity billet.
Billet Title A description of the officer’s primary duties. If two or more officers are filling
the same billet, BSC and title will only be above the first officer’s data line. If
the officer has been gained to a billet not authorized by the AMD, billet title
will read, “THIS BSC IS INVALID.”
Billet Phase
Indicator (BP)
If an asterisk is printed, it indicates that the officer’s orders were written using
the activity’s new—but not yet effective—10-digit code.
Augment Indicator
(AUG)
A one-position alphabetic code indicating the type of authorized billet:
R = Reimbursable B = Base billets
Billet Designator
(BILLET DESIG)
A four-digit designator code of the authorized billet.
Billet Grade (BILL
GR)
A one-position alphabetic code indicating the grade authorized for each billet.
Primary Navy
Officer Billet
Classification
(NOBC)
A four-digit code that identifies the occupational classification assigned to the
billet. The assigned NOBC is a general statement of the duties to be
performed.
Table 11-1.—Data Elements Contained in the ODCR
11-3
DATA ELEMENT INFORMATION REQUIRED
Billet Subspecialty A subspecialty code assigned to an officer, identifying advancededucation, functional training, and significant experience in variousfields and disciplines.
Functional Area Code(FAC)
An alphanumeric code used to identify a billet requiring specialconsideration in personnel assignment.
Current Allowance(CURR ALLOW)
Indicates current authorization, in three-digits, for the billet.
M+1 Indicates the manpower requirements 1 month after mobilization.
Last FITREPReceived
Shows the most recently received and accepted Regular orConcurrent/Regular O-6-and-below Fitness Report. Reports may befrom present or previous duty station. The data consists of threeelements:
From date: A four-digit (YYMM) fitness report date fromblock 14 of the FITREP
Type of Report: A two-position code indicating type of report
RG = Regular Report. X in block 17 of FITREPRF = Concurrent/Regular Report. Xs in blocks 17
and 18 of FITREP
To date: A four-digit (YYMM) date from block 15 of the FITREP
UIC Transfer (UIC TRF) Indicates to the UIC that an officer is being transferred from or assignedto, if under orders.
Activity Where Assigned An item consisting of a maximum of 13 spaces that may be used todisplay data concerning the status of the officer involved.
Security Code Contains member’s security clearance eligibility, member’s currentsecurity clearance authority, and date member’s investigation wascompleted (YYMM).
Officer Subspecialty(SUBSPECIALTY) 1
A five-digit primary subspecialty code assigned to an officer, identifyingadvanced education, functional training, and significant experience invarious fields and disciplines.
Aviation CommissionDate and SubmarineService Control Date(ACD/SSCD)
ACD = A six-digit date (YYMMDD) that identifies a constructive dateto indicate total commissioned service, active or reserve, forall aviation commissioned officers.
SSCD = A six-digit date (YYMMDD) that represents the last time thesubmarine service indicator was changed.
Aviation Status Indicatorand Submarine StatusIndicator (ASI/SSI)
ASI = A one-position alphabetic code that shows the current statusof an Aviation Officer’s Career Incentive Pay (ACIP)entitlement status.
SSI = A one-position alphabetic code that indicates certaincategories of entitlement to Submarine Duty Incentive Pay.
Aviation Service EntryDate and SubmarineService Entry Date(ASED/SSED)
ASED = The six-digit date (YYMMDD) that an aviation officer firstreported to an activity having aircraft in which basic flighttraining was received.
SSED = The six-digit date (YYMMDD) that a submarine officergraduates from sub school.
Table 11-1.—Data Elements Contained in the ODCR—Continued
11-4
DATA ELEMENT INFORMATION REQUIRED
Order Status (ORD) A one-position alphabetic code representing present order status.
Officer’s Name The officer’s name will not exceed 21 characters, including spaces. It will
consist of all of the last name and as much of the rest of the name as
possible.
Officer Sea Air
Mariner (OSAM)
OSAM will be indicated by an asterisk (*) following the officer’s name.
Social Security
Number
A nine-position code, that is a unique identification of the member and his or
her social security account.
Exceptional Family
Member
A one-position code identifying the category assigned to each enrolling
service member. Detailers use this information when negotiating future
assignments. THERE ARE NO OTHER CAREER IMPACTS.
Primary
Aeronautical
Designator (PAD)
A one-position code used internally in BUPERS to classify officer personnel in
the Navy aeronautical organization.
Sex A one-position alphabetic code.
M = Male F = Female
Designator (DESIG) A four-digit code used to group billets and officers by categories for personnel
accounting and administrative purposes, and to identify the status of officers.
Grade on Board
(GR on BD)
A one-position alphabetic grade code of officer on board.
Date of Rank A four-digit (YYMM) date of incumbent’s present grade.
Estimated Loss
Code/Date
The estimated date (YYMM) that the officer will be a loss to active naval
officer strength. A one-letter loss code indicating reason for the loss precedes
the date. Not all officers will have an estimated loss code and date.
Date Assigned Billet A four-digit (YYMM) date assigned to the officer’s current primary billet.
Estimated Date of
Detachment (EST
DATE DETACH)
A four-digit (YYMM) date representing the estimated date of detachment for
an officer who has written orders.
Date Reported or
Estimated Date of
Arrival (EDA)
A six-digit (YYMMDD) date for an officer who has reported on board. The
EDA will be shown as four digits (YYMM) for an officer who has not yet
reported.
Projected Rotation
Date (PROJ ROT
DATE)
A four-digit (YYMM) date that is a planned rotation date used only as a
planning aid, and subject to change by BUPERS.
Accounting
Category Code
(ACC)
A three-digit code indicating the accounting category in which officers are
carried in active-duty accounts.
Duty Status Effective
Date (DSED)
A four-digit date (YYMM) that reflects the most recent change to a member’s
onboard duty status, as indicated in the ACC entry.
Family Co-Location
Identifier
A one-position alphabetic code may appear immediately after the DSED to
broadly identify family members of an active duty sponsor.
Table 11-1.—Data Elements Contained in the ODCR—Continued
11-5
DATA ELEMENT INFORMATION REQUIRED
Number of
Dependents
Residing in
Sponsor’s
Household
A one-position code that identifies the total number of authorized family
members residing at the same current duty station and local address as the
active duty sponsor.
Date Dependent(s)
Arrived at
Overseas Station
(DATE DOS)
A four-digit (YYMM) date indicating the date the officer’s dependent(s) arrived
at the overseas station.
Dependent(s) on
Station Overseas
(DOS)
A one-digit code that identifies the number of authorized
(command-sponsored) dependents living on station or nonrotating ship
homeported overseas.
Primary and
Secondary
Dependency Code
(DEP)
A two-position code to identify the type and number of dependents. The first
position identifies primary dependents (spouse and children) or marital status.
The second position identifies the secondary dependents (dependent parent).
A blank in either position indicates no qualified dependents in that category.
Aviation Billet
Indication (ABI)
A one-position code that indicates an officer’s current operational flying
status, if applicable.
Months of
Operational Flying
(MOF)
The total number of months of operational flying that qualifies the officer for
the 12- and 18-year gates.
Security Date (SEC
DATE)
The type of security clearance performed on member, and the date on which
the member’s current security clearance was granted (YYMM).
Officer
Subspecialty
(SUBSPECIALTY) 2
A five-digit secondary subspecialty code assigned to an officer identifying
advanced education, functional training, and significant experience in various
fields and disciplines, if applicable.
Nuclear
Commission Date
(NCD)
A six-position date (YYMMDD) equal to the first day a member served on
active duty as a commissioned officer.
Nuclear Status
Indicator (NSI)
A one-position alphabetic code that indicates the officer’s entitlement to
Nuclear Officer Incentive Pay (NOIP).
Nuclear Service
Control Date
(NSCD)
A six-digit date (YYMMDD) that gives the effective date associated with the
NSI.
Table 11-1.—Data Elements Contained in the ODCR—Continued
DATA ELEMENTS CONTAINED
IN THE ODCR
Data elements are listed in the order they appear on
the ODCR, reading from left to right starting with
“Activity Name” in the upper-left corner of the
heading, and ending with “NSCD” in the lower-right
corner of the heading. Use table 11-1 for guidance in
completing the data elements of the ODCR.
ODCR MAINTENANCE
Keep the ODCR current by posting changes as they
occur. That is a valuable asset to personnel
management and will reduce the time required for the
monthly verification.
Make pen changes to the ODCR for each item
pertaining to an individual that is changed. Line
through obsolete data and write the new data in the
same column. In the right margin of the report, write
the date the correction was made. Upon receipt of the
new ODCR, transcribe pen changes from the old report
that have not yet been applied to the new ODCR.
SUMMARY
The ODCR is a very important document that aids
in the detailing of officer personnel. The accuracy of
this document is vital to this purpose. It could be one of
the most important documents you ever deal with.
Don’t guess! If you have a question, ask your
supervisor.
11-6
CHAPTER 12
OFFICER SERVICE RECORDS
In this chapter we discuss officer service records.
Both local documents and the service record
maintained by Commander, Naval Personnel
Command (COMNAVPERSCOM) are covered. As a
Yeoman, no matter where you are assigned, there is a
good possibility that you will be required to work with
officer-related documents.
CREATION, MAINTENANCE, AND USE
OF OFFICER SERVICE RECORDS
Per NAVADMIN 229/00, the Officer Service
Record will no longer be maintained for officers on
full-time active duty. The permanent record is
maintained at COMNAVPERSCOM in microfiche
format.
NAVADMIN 229/00 did not e l iminate
requirements to prepare and forward documents that
were previously filed in the Officer Field Service
Record (OSFR), but it did redefine the distribution
requirements for those documents. Local Personnel
Offices/PSDs will maintain the following forms and
ensure compliance with Privacy Act guidelines
contained in SECNAVINST 5211.5 series:
• NAVPERS 1070/602, Dependency Application/
Record of Emergency Data.
• DD93, Record of Emergency Data.
• SGLV-8286, Servicemembers’ Group Life
Insurance Election and Certificate.
• SGLV-8285, Request for Insurance, if
applicable. (Mail originals to NAVPERSCOM
(PERS-313C1).)
OFFICER PERMANENT PERSONNEL
RECORD
The permanent officer record is maintained in the
Commander, Naval Personnel Command
(COMNAVPERSCOM) in Electronic Military
Personnel Records System (EMPRS). Documents that
ref lec t an officer ’s charac ter, profess ional
qualifications, fitness for service, performance of
duties, entitlements, and that affect or influence a
member’s career and benefits will be filed therein, per
BUPERSINST 1070.27 series.
Documents filed in the officer permanent
personnel record are placed in 1 of 18 categories
based on the type of information in the document.
Each category is assigned a unique field code to
allow grouping of or control access to documents by
type. When printed to microfiche, documents are
printed on one of six microfiche. The following
outlines categories of documents filed on each
microfiche:
• Fiche No. 1
01. Not used
02. Latest photograph
03. Fitness reports and attachments
04. Medals, awards, and citations
• Fiche No. 2
05. Educational data
06. Qualifications data
07. Appointments, promotions
08. Reserve status
09. Service determination, separation,
retirement, casualty, death
10. Miscellaneous professional history data
• Fiche No. 3
11. Security investigations, clearances, personal
history statement
12. Record of emergency data
13. Record changes
14. Personal background data
15. Miscellaneous personal data
• Fiche No. 4
16. Orders
• Fiche No. 5
17. Privileged information, adverse material,
family advocacy program, medical boards,
physical evaluation boards, prisoner of war
(POW) data, etc.
• Fiche No. 6
18. Enlisted record for officer with prior
enlisted service.
12-1
Access to the record of an officer is normally
limited to the officer concerned, an agent or a
representative of the officer specifically authorized in
writing, COMNAVPERSCOM, personnel who are
required to review military service records in the
performance of their official duties, boards convened
by the Department of the Navy, courts-martial, and as
directed by a court order signed by a judge.
Any information that is rightfully placed in the
official record of an officer may not be removed except
by special authorization of SECNAV. Once submitted
to COMNAVPERSCOM, an official document
becomes the property of the Navy Department and is
not subject to change. A document may be amended or
supplemented by correspondence forwarded via
official channels. In such cases, the forwarding
correspondence must be made a part of the document
being amended or supplemented.
STANDARD FILING SEQUENCE
When documents are submitted or received on
behalf of an officer, they are filed in the service record
on the side and in the sequence indicated in table 12–1.
Not all of the documents listed apply to all officers.
Normally, only the current copy of each document is
filed. In the table, a “T” identifies documents to be
removed from the field service record and returned to
the officer upon permanent change of station transfer.
SUMMARY
The information in this chapter was intended to
provide you with a overview of the officer service
record. Although it has covered the most important
and most frequently occurring documents, there are
other documents you may encounter. For additional
information beyond the scope of this chapter, refer to
the MILPERSMAN 1070-040.
12-2
12-3
LEFT SIDE
File in sequence, with the item designated “a” on top.
RIGHT SIDE
File in sequence, with the item designated “a” on top.
a. NAVPERS 5510/1, Record Identifier for Personnel Reliability
Program
a. NAVPERS 1070/613, Administrative Remarks
b. OPNAV 5211/9, Record of Disclosure, Privacy Act of 1974 b. NAVPERS 1070/605, History of Assignments
c. NAVPERS 5510/3, Personnel Reliability Program Screening and
Evaluation Record
c. NAVPERS 1301/51, Officer Data Card
d. OPNAV 5520/20, Certificate of Personnel Security Investigation,
Clearance and Access
d. NAVPERS 1070/125, Limited Duty/Warrant Officer History
Card
e. (T) Official correspondence from current command (e.g., Letters of
Appreciation and Commendation, temporary designation letters)
e. NAVRES 1301/4, Officer Qualification Questionnaire
f. Current PCD orders and all endorsements f. NAVPERS 1210/5, Officer Qualifications Questionnaire
g. NAVRES 1321/1, Officer Application/ Orders for Inactive Duty
Training, or
g. NAVCOMPT 3072, Dependency Station Action
h. NAVRES 1321/2, Inactive Duty Training Orders:
Termination/Cancellation Modification
h. SGLV-8286, Servicemen’s Group Life Insurance Election and
Certificate
i. (T) Certificates from Navy schools, training, and correspondence
courses
i. DD 1172, Application for Uniformed Services Identification
Card/DEERS Enrollment (current copy only)
j. Personal and Unit Award Citations j. NAVPERS 1070/602, Dependency Application/Record of
Emergency Data
k. Letters of permanent warfare designation, significant qualifications,
special duty assignments, and incentive pay
k. NAVPERS 1070/10, Officer Photograph Submission Sheet
l. OPNAV 5350/1, Drug and Alcohol Abuse Statement of
Understanding
l. DD 214, Certificate of Release or Discharge from Active Duty
(ALL)
m. DD 2366, Montgomery GI Bill (MGIB) Act of 1984 m. NAVPERS 1200/1, Ready Reserve Transfer
Request/Service Agreement
n. OPNAV 1780/1, Statement of Understanding—Selected Reserve
Educational Assistance Program
n. NAVPERS 1421/7, Delivery of Temporary/ Permanent
Appointment (present grade)
o. DD 2384, Selected Reserve Educational Assistance Program (GI
Bill) Notice of Basic Eligibility
o. NAVPERS 1000/22, Acceptance and Oath of Office (ALL)
p. SF 85P, Questionnaire for Public Trust Positions p. NAVCRUIT 1000/20, Officer Appointment, Acceptance and
Oath of Office (ALL)
q. SF 86, Questionnaire for National Security Positions q. NAVPERS 1070/74, Officer’s Report of Home of Record and
Place from Which Ordered on a Tour of Active Duty
r. DD 398-2, Personnel Security Questionnaire (National Agency
Checklist), or
s. DD 1879, Request for Personnel Security Investigation (PSI) (if PSI
pending)
t. DD 398, Personnel Security Questionnaire (BI/SBI)
u. NAVPERS 1070/877, Statement of Service
v. NRPC 1820/6, Notification of Eligibility for Retired Pay at Age 60
w. NAVCRUIT Forms, Officer Program Statement/ Service
Agreement
x. DD 1934, Geneva Conventions Identification Card for Medical and
Religious Personnel who Serve in or Accompany the Armed Forces
(may be placed in envelope and stapled to inside, left cover)
Table 12–1.—Standard Filing Sequence
CHAPTER 13
TRAVEL, LEAVE PROCEDURES, AND PAY ANDALLOWANCES
Travel, leave, and pay are subjects very close to the
heart of every Sailor and crucially important to the
management of day-to-day business in the U.S. Navy.
Records attendant to these areas of Navy life must be
perfectly executed. It is the YN’s responsibility to see
that this happens. In virtually every job to which you
may be assigned, you will be required to type, verify,
complete, forward, and perform various other actions
with regard to forms and reports in these areas. This
chapter gives you a basic coverage of travel, leave, and
pay. If you pay special attention to the topics covered
and refer to the publications mentioned as resources,
the information will serve you well throughout your
career.
TRAVEL
Temporary additional duty (TEMADD) is the
term used when an individual travels to a command or
geographical area that is not the individual’s
permanent duty station. Travel may be for training,
attending seminars, performing duties essential to the
mission of the permanent duty station, sports
competitions, and many other purposes. This section
covers general procedures used for completing and
processing TEMADD orders.
TEMADD Travel Orders, NAVPERS Form
1320/16, must be prepared for the individual on
TEMADD to be reimbursed for personal expenses,
travel arrangements and payments, and so that proper
authority is aware of the individual’s status.
TEMADD TRAVEL ORDER FORM
The parent command of the individual prepares the
NAVPERS 1320/16 before the performance of travel.
A block-by-block description follows in table 13-1.
NO-COST TEMADD ORDERS
There are times when an individual will be
authorized to travel to a TEMADD station for the
individual’s own convenience and at the individual’s
own expense. The orders are prepared the same way,
with the exception of blocks 2, 4, 17, 18, and 19. Enter
N/A in these blocks for no-cost TEMADD orders.
Block 21 must contain a statement to the individual
that restates the fact that no claim may be made for
funds. Local directives will provide you with the exact
wording required by your TEMADD fund controller.
PROCESSING COMPLETED TEMADD
ORDERS
When the individual completes the TEMADD
assignment, the orders must be liquidated in order to
reimburse the individual for authorized expenses
incurred or to determine if the individual owes the
government money; that is, if expenses incurred are not
equal to or greater than advances paid to the individual.
The Travel Voucher or Subvoucher, DD Form 1351-2,
is used for this purpose. The individual is primarily
responsible for completing this form, but may need
your assistance.
Most of the entries on the form are self-
explanatory. However, some explanation for item 1
under the Mode of Travel and Reason for Stop columns
is needed.
The entries for these blocks are found in block 25a
on the reverse side of DD Form 1351-2. For brevity’s
sake, the types of travel and reasons for stopping are
given in two letter codes. For travel, first you
determine the means of travel used, and enter the letter
code in blocks numbered 1 through 4, then the mode of
travel, and enter the appropriate letter code in blocks 5
through 10. Likewise, the reason for stop codes is
found in block 25b.
By looking at the unshaded and shaded areas, you
can see that each mode of travel entry is adjacent to a
departure (DEP) line entry, and each reason for stop
entry is adjacent to an arrival (ARR) entry. Indicate in
the appropriate blocks on the left side of block 1 the
dates and times the individual departed and arrived at
each stop during the TEMADD assignment. The
center of the block indicates the command and
geographical location of the TEMADD stops. The
means of travel and the reason for stop codes are
entered in the appropriate unshaded column.
13-1
13-2
BLOCK NAME INFORMATION REQUIRED
1. From Insert the complete name and address of the activity issuing TEMADDorders.
A 15-position alphanumeric number constructed as follows:
POSITION
1 N (for Navy)
2 thru 6 The UIC of the command originating the orders
7 and 8 Last two numbers of the fiscal year
9 and 10 TO (for travel orders)
2. Standard DocumentNo.
11 thru 15 The alphanumeric (excluding the letters I and O) serialnumber, using the TANGO number found in block 4.
e.g., N3250696TO00001
3. To Enter traveler's rank/grade, name and address (normally duty station).Some activities also require the phrase "and no others" on the lineimmediately following the name, preventing the addition of unauthorizedpersonnel on the orders.
4. TANGO No. The number that is used to identify the order when the standard documentnumber is not applicable. Only one TANGO number is assigned to eachtravel order. The last three are assigned sequentially throughout the fiscalyear, beginning with "001." Do not duplicate the number during the fiscalyear. Check with your supervisor or local TEMADD order directives to findout where you obtain TANGO numbers.
5. SSN/Designator Enter the person's SSN and designator.
6. Date Enter the date the orders are prepared.
7. Ref Enter any references that direct the travel of the individual or are pertinentto the purpose of the TEMADD.
8. Individual Or GroupTravel
Enter an "X" if the member is traveling individually, or as part of a group.
9. Proceed On Or About Enter the anticipated date on which the individual is required to commencetravel. This block is to be used only for directive-type orders.
10. Authorized ProceedOn Or About
Used when authorization-type orders are issued. In no case will the datefor commencement of travel be shown in both blocks 9 and 10 of the sameorder.
11. Approximate NumberOf Days
Indicate the number of days it is anticipated the member will be away fromthe duty station.
12. Estimated Date OfReturn
Enter the date the individual is expected to complete the TEMADDassignment and return to the permanent duty station.
13. Itinerary Enter the commands and geographical locations where the member is toreport during the course of the TEMADD assignment, beginning with thepermanent duty station. List the TEMADD station(s) in the order they willbe visited, if there is more than one; end with the phrase "and return."
14. TEMADD,TEMADDCON,TEMADDINS
Enter an "X" to indicate the type of TEMADD to which the individual isassigned.
15. Reason For Travel A brief, plain language description of the basic reason for the TEMADD,such as the name of a seminar being attended, an operational exercise,and so forth.
16. Authorized To VisitSuch AdditionalPlaces As May BeNecessary
This block should be used when the itinerary shown in block 13 is not firmand it is anticipated that the traveler may have to visit other activities in thesame geographical areas listed in block 13. The use of this block should beavoided whenever possible.
Table 13-1.—TEMADD Travel Order Form Entries
13-3
BLOCK NAME INFORMATION REQUIRED
17. Fiscal DataAccountingClassification
The complete Accounting Classification Code, consisting of nine codingelements and the standard document number and its constructions can befound in the Officer Transfer Manual, NAVPERS 15559A, chapter 2.
18. Estimated Cost Enter the estimated costs of transportation, per diem, miscellaneousexpenses, and the grand total in this block. The source of these estimatesvaries depending on local practice. Most personnel support detachments(PSDs) have a travel section that can arrange and provide transportationcosts for getting the member to the TEMADD duty station(s). If theindividual is to travel via a private vehicle, enter the total mileage allowancehere. Per diem rates are found in the Joint Federal Travel Regulations(JFTR). Miscellaneous expenses cover such things as rental automobiles,taxi fares, training fees, and so forth.
This is also a 15-character alphanumeric number. The positions are asfollows:
POSITION
1 3 (for Navy)
2 thru 7 The TANGO number
8 N
9 thru 13 The UIC of the parent command
19. CustomerIdentification Code
14 and 15 7A
e.g., 3800001N325067A
20. Item Listing a pertinent item number from the reverse side of the NAVPERS1320/16 brings the individual's attention to any requirements or restrictionsconnected with the TEMADD assignment. Listing the item number here inblock 20 is a time-saving device since most of the items are general innature and pertain to the majority of TEMADD assignments.
21. AdditionalComments AndInstructions
Use this area to list requirements and restrictions that are not contained inthe item numbers used in block 20. This area can also cover rentalautomobile authorization, mode of travel, and use of government quarters.Once again, check with the directives of the local TEMADD fund managerto obtain any standard phrases that may be required in this block.
22. Security Clearance Complete this block if the individual's TEMADD duties will require access toclassified material.
23. AuthenticatingSignature
The commanding officer can delegate this responsibility within thecommand. Check with your supervisor or command directives for theproper official to enter in this block.
24. TransportationRequest/NIACTransportationAuthorizationFurnished
The office issuing any transportation tickets or authorizations for paymentwill enter the appropriate identifying numbers and itinerary in this block.
25. Copy To List official titles of the commands that have a need for copies of theTEMADD orders.
Table 13-1.—TEMADD Travel Order Form Entries Continued
The requirements for the number of copies to be
prepared and the distribution of the copies are subject
to local practice. The personnel support detachment
(PSD) servicing your command will have specific
directives for you to use in liquidating TEMADD
orders.
LEAVE
Leave authorizes an individual to be absent from
the place of duty. All members earn 30 days leave per
year, and they are officially encouraged to use the
entire 30 days. All personnel must be provided the
opportunity to take leave annually, with the
opportunity for at least one period of about 14
consecutive days.
ENTITLEMENTS
Leave is earned at the rate of 2.5 days per month for
all personnel on active duty in the Navy, except for the
following periods:
• Active duty of less than 30 consecutive days
• Active duty for training, with pay, of less than 30
consecutive days
• Lost time
• Excess leave or other periods in a nonpay status
The individual’s monthly Leave and Earnings
Statement (LES) and the commanding officer’s leave
listing received from the Defense Finance Accounting
Service-Cleveland Center (DFAS-CL) are used to
determine how many days of leave personnel have
accrued. Both of these documents give a total balance
of accrued leave as of the end of the statement’s
reporting period and how many days have been used
during the current fiscal year. Since these reports are
forwarded monthly, you need to add only the number
of days earned in the current month to the total number
of days reported on the statement to determine the
up-to-date leave balance.
TRAVEL TERMS
There are a number of terms related to leave with
which you should become familiar.
EARNED LEAVE. Leave accrued to a member as
of any given date. You can have a negative number of
days’ leave accrued (called “in the hole”). A negative
amount of leave must not exceed the amount of leave
that would normally be earned during the remaining
period of obligated service. (See Excess Leave.)
ADVANCE LEAVE. Leave granted to a member
before a member earns it. This gives the result of a
negative leave balance. Advance leave should not be
granted unless the member has sufficient service
obligation to earn it back.
ANNUAL LEAVE. Leave granted within a
command’s normal leave program; also called
ordinary leave.
CONVALESCENT LEAVE. A period of
authorized absence granted to members who are under
medical care. Such leave is part of the treatment
prescribed and is NOT charged to the member’s leave
entitlement.
EMERGENCY LEAVE. Leave granted for a
personal or family emergency that requires the
member’s presence. This is the only instance where
granting leave that would become excess leave would
be considered.
EXCESS LEAVE. Leave granted in excess of
earned leave and advance leave during which the
individual is not entitled to pay and allowances.
Generally, a minus leave balance at the time of release
from active duty, discharge, desertion, or death is
considered excess leave. Normally, a member is
required to pay the government back when an excess
leave balance exists at separation.
LEAVE AUTHORIZATION
The Leave Request/Authorization, NAVCOMPT
Form 3065, is used to request, authorize, and report
leave that is not included with orders. Sections 1 and 3
through 22 of the NAVCOMPT Form 3065 are
completed by the individual requesting the leave.
MILPERSMAN Article 1050-090 provides the
guidelines concerning granting of leave and
determining if a day is counted as leave against the
member’s account. The member cannot commence
leave before the end of the member’s working hours on
a day of duty or that day will count as a leave day. If the
member has no regular duties on that day, such as a
weekend day, the leave can commence at any hour and
the day will not be counted as a day of leave. The day of
return from leave is counted as a day of leave, except
when such return is made at or before the
commencement of the member’s normal working
hours.
13-4
LEAVE PROCEDURES
MILPERSMAN Article 1050-100 gives detailed
procedures to be followed when personnel request,
depart on, and return from leave. Instructions for the
assignment of the leave control number in Block 2 of
the NAVCOMPT Form 3065, distribution of the copies
of the NAVCOMPT Form 3065, and leave tickler
procedures are also given.
PAY AND ALLOWANCES
Pay is broken down into three types: basic,
special, and incentive. You should learn these three
types of pay and, in general, the requirements for
entitlement. The actual amount of pay may change
from year to year, depending on Congressional
budgetary actions. Current amounts are given in
changes to the listed manuals. Another main source of
information for current pay rates is your local
disbursing office. It is in your best interest that you
maintain a good working relationship with the
personnel serving in the disbursing office.
BASIC PAY
Basic pay is a monthly salary earned by all
personnel on active duty, based on the paygrade and the
number of years of service. Service counted for basic
pay purposes consists of active and inactive service for
certain military organizations. Medical and Dental
Corps officers receive credit for their training as
civilians. The Department of Defense Financial
Management Regula t ion (DODFMR), DOD
7000.14-R, part one, chapter 1, lists the creditable
service used for computing basic pay.
SPECIAL PAYS
Entitlement to special pays is linked to the
member’s status, professional qualifications, or duty
assignment. Special pays are broken down in part one
of the DODFMR.
INCENTIVE PAYS
Many members may also be entitled to incentive
pay. Incentive pay is also referred to as hazardous
duty pay since this type of pay is given to members
whose duty subjects them to abnormal hazards.
Incentive pays are contained in part two of the
DODFMR.
ALLOWANCES
An allowance is an amount of money paid to a
member to provide for facilities, services, or goods,
such as food (subsistence) or government quarters,
when they are not provided by the Navy, or to offset
some additional living expenses created by a
service-related duty requirement. The following
allowances are found in part three of the DODFMR:
• Basic Allowance for Subsistence (BAS)
• Basic Allowance for Housing (with or without
dependents) (BAH)
• Family Separation Housing (FSH)
• Clothing Monetary Allowances—Enlisted
Member
• Officers’ Uniform and Equipment Allowance
• Personal Money Allowance
Eligibility for allowances is not quite as evident
from the title as most pays are. BAH entitlement can be
earned by claiming a variety of different types of
dependents or, for a single member, where he or she is
stationed. There are two levels of FSH payments,
depending on the circumstances of the separation.
Check these out carefully in the DODFMR so you are
aware of all the combinations that can create an
entitlement.
MISCELLANEOUS PAYMENTS
Part four of the DODFMR gives the various
reasons where a member may receive one of the above
pay or allowances outside of normal payment
procedures. A member may receive a pay before
earning it (such as advance basic pay in connection
with a permanent change of station) or be given an
allowance ahead of actual entitlement (such as advance
BAS given before a member goes on leave). A member
may be mentally incompetent or physically
unavailable (missing, MIA, or POW), but entitlement
continues and dependents still need to be provided for.
Chapters 1 through 3 of part four of the DODFMR
provide this information.
Members separating from the service may be
entitled to certain other payments. Chapter 4 of part
four of the DODFMR also provides information on pay
given for leave not used before separation, severance
pay, money due to a member if a contract agreement
with the Navy was canceled, and other instances.
13-5
TRAVEL ALLOWANCES
The pays and allowances given above are derived
from the DODFMR and are usually paid on a regular
basis to a member or are based on a regularly received
pay or allowance. When a member and/or dependents
are required to travel or move, on either a temporary or
permanent basis, and have been issued orders placing
them in a travel status, there exists another set of
allowances that are paid to offset expenses created by
the move.
The expenses incurred as a result of temporary or
permanent travel or moves are divided into the
following categories:
• Transportation costs can be offset in three
ways: by a flat mileage allowance, by transportation
furnished by the government in a government vehicle,
or by a Transportation Request that can be used to
purchase tickets for travel on commercial carriers
(airlines, railroads). The mileage allowance is payable
to both the member and dependents, with the rate per
mile based on the status of the individual. An official
table of distances is used to determine the number of
miles between the different duty stations.
• Lodging and food allowances are reimbursed to
the member for this expense as a combination of BAS
and per diem. Per diem is a daily rate that varies widely
with geographical location. Payment of per diem is also
affected by the availability and use of government
quarters and messing facilities. The amount payable as
dislocation allowance (DLA) is equal to 21
2 months of
the entitled member’s basic allowance for housing.
Some overseas stations where temporary family
lodging costs are high will have a temporary lodging
allowance that takes the family’s expenses into account
during the course of a permanent change of station
move.
• Miscellaneous cost is the catchall for expenses
not covered by any of the above listed allowances. One
example would be taxi fare from an airport to a hotel
when the member is on a temporary additional duty trip.
SUMMARY
This chapter briefly discussed travel, leave
procedures, and pay and allowances. As a YN, in the
customer service area, you will be asked questions
about these topics. Since these topics ultimately affect
a person’s pay, be careful of your response. If you
aren’t sure of your answer, or can’t find it in writing,
talk to your supervisor.
13-6
CHAPTER 14
TECHNICAL ADMINISTRATION
As a Yeoman, you will be asked to prepare many
different types of correspondence and documents.
These are in addition to the ones that have previously
been discussed in foregoing chapters. This chapter
covers those assignments that are governed by local
policy and may be different from those that you are
familiar with and have performed at past duty stations.
Most of these assignments will be handed to you in a
“rough” (hand-written, double-spaced from a
typewriter or computer printout) form. Most of the
time, your supervisor will make a copy of the
document, make changes to it, and ask you to prepare
the rough into a smooth copy. The following are
examples of some of the kinds of documents you will
be asked to prepare.
• School quota requests
• Manpower authorization change requests
• Officer social roster
• Designation letters
• Recall bills
• Muster reports
• Command telephone directories
• Command history
• Inspection results
• Command SORM
• Speeches
• Liberty passes
• Plan of the day/week
• Welcome aboard letters
• Frocking letters
• Responses to letters of indebtedness
• Statement of service
• Casualty documents
These are just some of the documents you may be
asked to prepare. Most of them are governed by local
policy; that is, they are prepared according to the
wishes of the local commanding officer or other
official. Keep in mind, though, that you will more
times than not have a ready reference or example of the
document right in your office. If you can’t find an
example to follow, and one isn’t given to you, ask your
supervisor for assistance. Make it your business to
become familiar with local policy governing these
documents so you are prepared whenever you are
asked to perform a task.
OFFICER/CHIEF PETTY OFFICER
FITNESS REPORTS
The Navy Per formance Evaluat ion and
Counseling System, BUPERSINST 1610.10 series, is
the only authority used to prepare officer fitness
reports (FITREPs) and should be consulted in every
phase of preparation.
Navy Regulations require that records be
maintained on officers and chief petty officers “which
reflect their fitness for the service and performance of
duties.” FITREPs form a primary basis for selecting
officers for advanced training, specialization or
subspecialization, duty assignment, promotion, and
command.
FITREPs are subject to the Privacy Act of 1974.
Report drafters and reporting seniors may maintain
notes and records of performance for their personal use
as memory aids, provided these materials are
safeguarded to prevent unauthorized disclosure, are
not circulated to anyone else, and are used openly
while counseling the officer. Reporting seniors should
retain copies of FITREPs for at least 5 years. If
requested, additional copies of FITREPs may be
provided to the officer reported on but may not be given
or shown to any other unauthorized person.
Commands should maintain logs of FITREPs
submitted and periods covered but may not, under any
circumstances, retain copies, preparation notes,
worksheets, or any other documents relating to
FITREPs in command files.
You will be required to type forms in conjunction
with FITREPs. The requirements for confidentiality
are very strict. You must become acquainted with the
regulations regarding FITREPs and conform with
14-1
them very carefully. You will be given drafts to type
and they must be done very accurately. It will pay off
for you to learn how to do FITREPs neatly and with no
errors.
ENLISTED EVALUATIONS
The Navy Per formance Evaluat ion and
Counseling System, BUPERSINST 1610.10 series, is
the only authority used in the preparation of enlisted
evaluations (EVALs) and should be consulted in every
phase of preparation.
Navy Regulations require that records be
maintained on enlisted persons “which reflect their
fitness for the service and performance of duties.”
Enlisted performance EVALs are used in many
personnel actions, including advancement in rate,
selection for responsible assignments and specialized
training, award of the Good Conduct Medal,
qualification for retention and reenlistment, and
characterization of service upon discharge.
EVALs must cover, day for day, all periods of
enlisted service on active duty or in drilling Reserve
programs, except during initial entry training.
As with officer FITREPs, EVALs are very
important documents in a military person’s career.
You must handle them with utmost caution and
confidentiality.
MAINTENANCE OF OFFICE
EQUIPMENT
You are required to be able to operate a
typewriter/computer and office duplicating machines.
You should know how to give proper routine care to
any machine you operate and should make that care a
habit. You should acquaint yourself with the
instruction manuals that came with your equipment.
Other kinds of maintenance may be dictated by local
policy. Consult with your supervisor and those
individuals in your office who are responsible for
equipment maintenance for assistance.
SUMMARY
As stated previously in this chapter, you will be
asked to perform various tasks of a routine nature.
Keep in mind as you travel from one command to the
next, that all commands, although similar in nature,
will have their own differences. The one thing that has
been stressed in this NRTC is, if you don’t know, ASK.
You are not expected to know everything; no one does.
14-2
APPENDIX l
GLOSSARY
ABBREVIATION–A shortened form of a written
word or phrase used in place of the whole.
ACCESS–The ability and opportunity to obtain
knowledge or possession of classified information.
ACRONYM–A word formed from the initial letter or
letters of each of the successive parts or major
parts of a compound term.
ACTIVITY–An organizational unit designated to
perform a specific mission or function.
ALLOWANCE–Monetary entitlement paid to a
member to provide for facilities, services, or
goods.
BAH–Basic allowance for housing.
BAS–Basic allowance for subsistence.
BUMED–Bureau of Naval Medicine
BUPERS–Bureau of Naval Personnel.
CA–Convening authority, used in naval justice
matters.
CACO–Casualty Assistance Calls Officer.
CACP–Casualty Assistance Calls Program.
CENTRALIZED FILES–A filing system wherein
the official files of a command are maintained in
one centralized location.
CHNAVPERS–Chief of Naval Personnel.
CLASSIFIED MATERIAL–Any matter, document,
product, or substance on or in which classified
information is recorded or embodied.
CLASSIFYING–As used in correspondence filing,
the process of determining the correct subject
group codes under which correspondence should
be filed.
CLEARANCE–As used in relation to classified
information, an administrative determination by
competent authority that an individual is eligible
for access to classified information of a specific
classification category.
CODING–As used in correspondence filing, the
process of writing the file number or codes on the
papers to be filed.
CONFIDENTIAL–The security classification
category used to identify material the unauthorized
disclosure of which could reasonably be expected to
cause damage to the national security.
DECENTRALIZED FILES–A filing system
wherein the official files of a command are
maintained in the department having primary
responsibility for the subject matter of the files.
DIRECTIVE–An instruction, notice, or change
transmittal.
DOD–Department of Defense.
DON CAF–Department of the Navy Central
Adjudicating Facility.
DODFMR–Department of Defense Military Pay and
Allowance Entitlements Manual.
DON–Department of the Navy.
DON ISP–Department of the Navy Information
Security Program.
DON PSP–Department of the Navy Personnel
Security Program.
DSS–Defense Security Service.
DTG–Date-time group.
ENLTRANSMAN–Enlisted Transfer Manual.
EPMAC–Enlisted Personnel Management Center.
EVAL–Enlisted performance evaluation report.
FITREP–Officer fitness report.
FOUO–For Official Use Only.
FSH–Family separation housing.
GCM–General court-martial, used in naval justice
matters.
JAGMAN–Manual of the Judge Advocate General.
JFTR–Joint Federal Travel Regulations.
AI-1
JULIAN DATE–The consecutive day of the calendar
year.
LES–Leave and earnings statement.
MANMED–Manual of the Medical Department.
MAPTIS–Manpower, Personnel, and Training
Information System.
MCM–Manual for Courts-Martial, United States.
MILPERSMAN–Naval Military Personnel Manual.
NAC–National agency check.
NAVCOMPT–Navy Comptroller.
NAVMEDCOM–Naval Medical Command.
NEC–Navy Enlisted Classification Code.
NJP–Nonjudicial punishment.
NTI–Navy Travel Instructions.
ODCR–Officer Distribution Control Report.
OFFTRANSMAN–Officer Transfer Manual.
PASS–Pay/Personnel Administrative Support System.
PAY–Monetary entitlement based on professional
services performed by a member.
PER DIEM–The allowance authorized to cover the
cost of quarters, subsistence, and other necessary
incidental expenses related to travel.
PR–Periodic reinvestigation.
PRP–Personnel Reliability Program.
PSD–Personnel Support Detachment.
PSI–Personnel security investigation.
RATE–The military rate of an enlisted person, such as
PO3, CPO, MCPO.
RATING–The professional rating of an enlisted
person, such as Yeoman, Personnelman,
Quartermaster.
SCM–Summary court-martial, used in naval justice
matters.
SDSPROMAN–Source Data System Procedures
Manual.
SECRET–The security classification category used to
identify material the unauthorized disclosure of
which could reasonably be expected to cause
serious damage to the national security.
SNDL–Standard Navy Distribution List.
SORM–Standard Organization and Regulations of the
U.S. Navy.
SPCM–Special court-martial, used in naval justice
matters.
SSBI– Single-Scope Background Investigation.
TEMADD–Temporary additional duty.
TICKLER–System used to remind report preparer
when recurring reports are due.
TOP SECRET–The security classification category
used to identify material the unauthorized
disclosure of which could reasonably be expected
to cause exceptionally grave damage to the
national security.
UCMJ–Uniform Code of Military Justice.
UPB–Unit Punishment Book.
ZIP CODE–Zone improvement plan; a five- or
nine-digit number that identifies each postal
delivery area in the United States.
AI-2
APPENDIX II
REFERENCES USED TO DEVELOP THE
TRAMAN
NOTE: Although the following references were current when this NRTC was published, their
continued currency cannot be assured. Therefore, you need to be sure that you are studying the latest
revision.
Chapter 1
Navy Customer Service Manual, NAVEDTRA 14056, Naval Education and Training Command,
Pensacola, FL, 1993.
Navy Enlisted Manpower and Personnel Classifications and Occupational Standards, NAVPERS
18068F, Commander, Naval Personnel Command, Washington, DC, 2001.
Chapter 2
Decedent Affairs Manual, NAVMEDCOMINST 5360.1, Chief Bureau of Medicine and Surgery,
Washington, DC, 1987.
Department of Defense Military Pay and Allowances Entitlements Manual (DODFMR), DODFMR
7000.14R, Comptroller of the Department of Defense, Washington, DC, 1996.
Department of the Navy Correspondence Manual, SECNAVINST 5216.5D, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1996.
Department of the Navy Directives Issuance System, SECNAVINST 5215.1C, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1970.
Department of the Navy File Maintenance Procedures and Standard Subject Identification Codes
(SSIC), SECNAVINST 5210.11D, Secretary of the Navy, 1987.
Department of the Navy Forms Management Program, SECNAVINST 5213.10D, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1992.
Department of the Navy Information Requirements (Reports) Management Program, SECNAVINST
5214.2B, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1988.
Department of the Navy (DON) Information Security Program (ISP) Regulation, SECNAVINST
5510.36, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1999.
Department of the Navy (DON) Personnel Security Program (PSP) Regulation, SECNAVINST
5510.30A, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1999.
Department of the Navy Social Usage and Protocol Handbook, OPNAVINST 1710.7, Chief of Naval
Operations, Washington, DC, 1979.
Diary Message Reporting System Users Manual (DMSRMAN), 1080#1 UM-02, Enlisted Personnel
Management Center, New Orleans, LA, 1996
Enlisted Transfer Manual (TRANSMAN), NAVPERS 15909G, Navy Personnel Command, Millington,
TN, 1998.
Format and Procedures for Validating the Officer Distribution Control Report (ODCR), BUPERSINST
1301.40, Bureau of Naval Personnel, Washington, DC, 1995.
AII-1
Joint Federal Travel Regulations (JFTR), NAVSO P-6034, Per Diem Travel, and Transportation
Allowance Committee, Department of Defense, Washington, DC, 1995.
Manual for Courts-Martial (MCM), United States, 2000.
Manual of Advancement, BUPERSINST 1430.16D, Chief of Naval Personnel, Washington, DC, 1991.
Manual of Navy Officer Manpower and Personnel Classifications, Volumes I and II, NAVPERS 15839I,
Commander, Naval Personnel Command, Washington, DC, 2001.
Manual of the Judge Advocate General (JAGMAN), JAGINST 5800.7C, Judge Advocate General,
Alexandria, VA, 1990.
Manual of the Medical Department (MANMED), NAVMED P-117, Chief, Bureau of Medicine and
Surgery, Washington, DC, 1996.
Naval Military Personnel Manual (MILPERSMAN), NAVPERS 15560C, Commander, Naval Personnel
Command, Millington, TN, 2001.
Naval Telecommunications Procedures and Users Manual (NTP-3J), Naval Computer and
Telecommunications Command, Washington, DC, 1997.
Navy and Marine Corps Awards Manual, SECNAVINST 1650.1F, Office of the Secretary, Washington,
DC, 1991.
Navy and Marine Corps Records Disposition Manual, SECNAVINST 5212.5D, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1998.
Navy Casualty Assistance Calls Program (CACP) Manual, BUPERSINST 1770.3, Chief of Naval
Personnel, Washington, DC, 1995.
Navy Performance Evaluation and Counseling System, BUPERSINST 1610.10, Bureau of Naval
Personnel, Washington, DC, 1995.
Navy Stock List of Forms and Publications, NAVSUP P-2002, Naval Aviation Support Office,
Philadelphia, PA, Quarterly.
Officer Transfer Manual, NAVPERS 15559B, Commander, Naval Personnel Command, Millington, TN,
1998.
Register of Commissioned and Warrant Officers of the United States Naval Reserve NAVPERS 15009,
Bureau of Naval Personnel, Millington, TN. (Available on BUPERS CD-ROM or from
BUPERS website only.)
Register of Retired Commissioned and Warrant Officers, Regular and Reserve, of the United States Navy,
NAVPERS 15939, Bureau of Naval Personnel, Millington, TN. (Available on BUPERS
CD-ROM or from BUPERS website only.)
Temporary Additional Duty (TEMADD) Travel Management Control, BUPERSINST 4650.19, Chief of
Naval Personnel, Washington, DC, 1995.
United States Navy Regulations, 1990, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1990.
United States Navy Uniform Regulations, NAVPERS 15665I, Commander, Naval Personnel Command,
Millington, TN, 2001.
U.S. Navy Travel Instructions (NTI), NAVSO P-1459, Office of the Comptroller, Washington, DC, 1992.
Chapter 3
Department of the Navy Correspondence Manual, SECNAVINST 5216.5D, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1996.
AII-2
Department of the Navy File Maintenance Procedures and Standard Subject Identification Codes
(SSIC), SECNAVINST 5210.11D, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1987.
Standard Naval Distribution List (SNDL), OPNAVNOTE 5400, Chief of Naval Operations, Washington,
DC, 2001.
Chapter 4
Department of the Navy Correspondence Manual, SECNAVINST 5216.5C, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1983.
Navy Official Mail Management Instructions, OPNAVINST 5218.7B, Chief of Naval Operations,
Washington, DC, 1998.
Navy Telecommunications Procedures and Users Manual (NTP-3J), Naval Computer and
Telecommunications Command, Washington, DC, 1997.
Standard Naval Distribution List (SNDL), OPNAVNOTE 5400, Chief of Naval Operations, Washington,
DC, 2001.
Standard Organization and Regulations of the U.S. Navy (SORM), OPNAVINST 3120.32C, Chief of
Naval Operations, Washington, DC, 1994.
Chapter 5
Department of the Navy Correspondence Manual, SECNAVINST 5216.5C, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1983.
Department of the Navy File Maintenance Procedures and Standard Subject Identification Codes
(SSIC), SECNAVINST 5210.11D, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1987.
Naval Telecommunications Procedures and Users Manual (NTP-3J), Naval Computer and
Telecommunications Command, Washington, DC, 1997.
Navy and Marine Corps Records Disposition Manual, SECNAVINST 5212.5D, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1998.
Standard Organization and Regulations of the U.S. Navy (SORM), OPNAVINST 3120.32C, Chief of
Naval Operations, Washington, DC, 1994.
Chapter 6
Department of the Navy, Directives Issuance System, SECNAVINST 5215.1C, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1970.
Standard Naval Distribution List (SNDL), OPNAVNOTE 5400, Chief of Naval Operations, Washington,
DC, 2001.
Chapter 7
Department of the Navy Information Requirements (Reports) Management Program, SECNAVINST
5214.2B, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1988.
Department of the Navy File Maintenance Procedures and Standard Subject Identification Codes
(SSIC), SECNAVINST 5210.11D, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1987.
Department of the Navy Forms Management Program, SECNAVINST 5213.10D, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1992.
AII-3
Navy and Marine Corps Records Disposition Manual, SECNAVINST 5212.5D, Secretary of the Navy,
Washington, DC, 1998.
Chapter 8
Department of the Navy (DON) Information Security Program (ISP) Regulation, SECNAVINST
5510.36, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1999.
Department of the Navy (DON) Personnel Security Program (PSP) Regulation, SECNAVINST
5510.30A, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1999 .
Standard Naval Distribution List (SNDL), OPNAVNOTE 5400, Chief of Naval Operations, Washington,
DC, 2001.
Chapter 9
Legalman, NAVEDTRA 14135, Naval Education and Training Command, Pensacola, FL, 1994.
Manual for Courts-Martial (MCM), United States, 2000.
Manual of the Judge Advocate General (JAGMAN), JAGINST 5800.7C, Judge Advocate General,
Alexandria, VA, 1990.
Naval Military Personnel Manual (MILPERSMAN), NAVPERS 15560C, Commander, Naval Personnel
Command, Millington, TN, 2001.
Standard Organization and Regulations of the U.S. Navy (SORM), OPNAVINST 3120.32C, Chief of
Naval Operations, Washington, DC, 1994.
United States Navy Regulations, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1990.
Chapter 10
Navy and Marine Corps Awards Manual, SECNAVINST 1650.1F, Secretary of the Navy, Washington,
DC, 1991.
Chapter 11
Format and Procedures for Validating the Officer Distribution Control Report (ODCR),
BUPERSINST1301.40, Chief of Naval Personnel, Washington, DC, 1995.
Chapter 12
Naval Military Personnel Manual (MILPERSMAN), NAVPERS 15560C, Commander, Naval Personnel
Command, Millington, TN, 2001.
Chapter 13
Department of Defense Military Pay and Allowances Entitlements Manual (DODFMR), DODFMR
7000.14R, Comptroller of the Department of Defense, Washington, DC, 1996.
Naval Military Personnel Manual (MILPERSMAN), NAVPERS 15560C, Commander, Naval Personnel
Command, Millington, TN, 2001.
Officer Transfer Manual, NAVPERS 15559B, Navy Personnel Command, Millington, TN, 1998.
AII-4
Chapter 14
Navy Performance Evaluation and Counseling System, BUPERSINST 1610.10, Chief of Naval
Personnel, Washington, DC, 1995.
United States Navy Regulations, Secretary of the Navy, Washington, DC, 1990.
AII-5
Assignment Questions
Information: The text pages that you are to study are
provided at the beginning of the assignment questions.
1
ASSIGNMENT 1
Textbook Assignment: "The Navy Yeoman," chapter 1, pages 1-1 through 1-12; and "Official Publications
and Directives," chapter 2, pages 2-1 through 2-7.
1-1. Which of the following statements best
defines the Navy's occupational standards
(OCCSTDs)?
1. Minimum standards of knowledge
only
2. Minimum standards of knowledge and
skill
3. Maximum standards of knowledge
only
4. Maximum standards of knowledge and
skill
1-2. Which of the following terms best
describes the word Yeoman?
1. A secretary
2. An administrator
3. An administrative assistant
4. A receptionist
1-3. During general quarters, which of the
following duties might a Yeoman perform?
1. Messenger
2. Phone talker
3. Status board writer
4. Each of the above
1-4. Aboard ship, what office is responsible for
maintaining the ship's master instructions?
1. Captain's office
2. Ship's office
3. Operations office
4. Weapons office
1-5. Who maintains the ship's office?
1. Administrative officer
2. Supply officer
3. Executive officer
4. Operations officer
1-6. The general appearance of an office can be
greatly affected by which of the following
actions?
1. Working one job at a time
2. Sweeping the floor
3. Putting things away
4. Emptying the trash
1-7. Of the following ways to arrange desks in
an office, which one is NOT the proper
way?
1. Everyone has enough light
2. Everyone is in a position to assist
customers
3. Some individuals have their backs to
the reception area
4. There is enough space to move around
1-8. To qualify for YN3, you must pass a
performance test by typing a minimum of
how many words per minute?
1. 25
2. 30
3. 35
4. 40
2
1-9. To qualify for YN2, you must pass a
performance test by typing a minimum of
how many words per minute?
1. 25
2. 30
3. 35
4. 40
1-10. As a yeoman, for which NEC can you
qualify?
1. YN-2514
2. YN-2513
3. YN-2512
4. YN-2511
1-11. Of the following paygrades, which one is
NOT authorized entry into the Legalman
rate?
1. E-2
2. E-3
3. E-4
4. E-5
1-12. Information on Navy schools may be
obtained from which of the following
publications?
1. MILPERSMAN
2. CANTRAC
3. Advancement Manual
4. ENLTRANSMAN
1-13. What is a Yeoman's most important
quality?
1. Voice
2. Appearance
3. Attitude
4. Personality
1-14. Taking pride in your appearance and acting
militarily correct will improve working
relationships.
1. True
2. False
1-15. What is the one trait looked for, required,
and even demanded of a Yeoman?
1. Assertiveness
2. Honesty
3. Aggressiveness
4. Intelligence
1-16. Of the following ratings, which one is NOT
responsible for providing direct service to
personnel?
1. HM
2. BM
3. YN
4. PN
1-17. The structure of the Navy tends to foster
which of the following attitudes in its
members?
1. Personal
2. Impersonal
3. Positive
4. Negative
1-18. People are people, and you can't change
human nature.
1. True
2. False
3
1-19. If you feel you cannot assist an irate
customer, what should you do?
1. Ask the customer to leave until you
can assist them
2. Ask the customer to have a seat in the
back of the office until he/she calms
down
3. Bring the problem to the attention of
your supervisor
4. Yell back at the customer to show
him/her how it feels
1-20. You must serve a customer who is
emotionally upset. In these circumstances,
what is the best approach to take?
1. Detached and stern
2. Calm and confident
3. Enthusiastic and easygoing
4. Composed and skeptical
1-21. You should react to an unpleasant customer
in which of the following ways?
1. Keep the contact as impersonal as
possible
2. Concentrate on the problem
3. Ignore the person's manner and
attitude
4. Each of the above
1-22. When you jump to a conclusion, you are
actually making a decision based on which
of the following factors?
1. Apathy
2. Rudeness
3. Misunderstanding
4. Incomplete information
1-23. When a contact point representative reacts
adversely to a customer, the representative
is most often reacting to which of the
following characteristics of the customer?
1. Speech
2. Attitude
3. Gestures
4. Appearance
1-24. The assumption that an individual
possesses certain characteristics because of
ethnic origin defines what term?
1. Jumping to conclusions
2. Stereotyping
3. Prejudice
4. Racism
1-25. Which of the following characteristics
interferes with effective communication?
1. Cultural differences
2. Physical problems
3. Speech habits
4. Each of the above
1-26. When a customer is having difficulty
understanding, which of the following
speech habits should increase
understanding?
1. Speaking very quickly
2. Speaking more distinctly
3. Speaking in an exaggerated accent
4. Speaking in the customer's dialect
1-27. When a customer requests something that
must be denied, your agreement with a
customer on current Navy policy could
increase which of the following customer
reactions?
1. Anger
2. Irritation
3. Loss of respect
4. Resentment or frustration
1-28. The duties, responsibilities, authority,
distinctions, and relationships of various
commands, officials, and individuals are
outlined in which of the following
publications?
1. Standard Organization and Regulations
of the U.S. Navy
2. Naval Military Personnel Manual
3. Manual of the Judge Advocate General
4. United States Navy Regulations
4
1-29. Who is responsible for making changes to
U.S. Navy Regulations?
1. Secretary of Defense
2. Secretary of the Navy
3. Chief of Naval Operations
4. Chairman, Joint Chiefs of Staff
1-30. What publication issues regulations and
guidance governing the conduct of all U.S.
Navy members?
1. Manual of the Judge Advocate General
2. Manual for Courts-Martial
3. Standard Organization and Regulations
of the U.S. Navy
4. U.S. Navy Regulations
1-31. Under the authority of the Military Justice
Act, who issued the Manual for Courts-
Martial?
1. Secretary of Defense
2. Secretary of the Navy
3. Chief of Naval Operations
4. President of the United States
1-32. Information concerning limitation on
punishments imposed at NJP is contained
in which of the following publications?
1. Corrections Manual
2. U.S. Navy Regulations
3. Manual for Courts-Martial
4. Naval Military Personnel Manual
1-33. Instructions regarding the procedures to
follow in conducting administrative
investigations are contained in which of the
following publications?
1. Manual for Courts-Martial
2. Manual of the Judge Advocate General
3. U.S. Navy Regulations
4. Naval Military Personnel Manual
1-34. The Navy Military Personnel Manual
(MILPERSMAN) is issued under what
authority?
1. Manual of the Judge Advocate General
2. Manual for Courts-Martial
3. Standard Organization and Regulations
of the U.S. Navy
4. U.S. Navy Regulations
1-35. Changes and distribution of the Military
Personnel Manual are approved by whom?
1. Secretary of the Navy
2. Chief of Naval Personnel
3. Deputy Chief of Naval Personnel
4. Secretary of Defense
1-36. Which of the following authorities covers
the protection of classified information in
the U.S. Navy?
1. U.S. Navy Regulations
2. Navy Correspondence Manual
3. Naval Military Personnel Manual
4. DON Information Security Program
1-37. The DON Information Security Program
Regulation is issued by whom?
1. Chief of Naval Operations
2. Director, Naval Intelligence
3. Director, Naval Criminal Investigative
Service
4. Secretary of the Navy
1-38. The DON ISP contains procedures for
classifying, marking, and handling of
classified information.
1. True
2. False
5
1-39. The Manual for the Navy Casualty
Assistance Calls Program (CACP) is also
known as what instruction?
1. JAGINST 1770.1
2. BUPERSINST 1770.3
3. NAVMEDCOMINST 1770.1
4. CACPINST 1770.1
1-40. What authority publishes the Decedent
Affairs Manual?
1. Naval Personnel Command
2. Secretary of the Navy
3. Bureau of Medicine and Surgery
4. Chief of Naval Personnel
1-41. The Manual of Navy Officer Manpower
and Personnel Classifications is issued in
how many volumes?
1. One
2. Two
3. Three
4. Four
1-42. Which publication contains a lineal list of
officer personnel?
1. Navy Register
2. Officer Transfer Manual
3. Officer Distribution Control Report
4. Manual of the Navy Officer Manpower
and Personnel Classifications
1-43. The U.S. Navy Uniform Regulations is
prepared and distributed by whom?
1. Secretary of Defense
2. Secretary of the Navy
3. Chief of Naval Personnel
4. Chief of Naval Operations
1-44. The purpose of the Officer Transfer Manual
is to improve awareness of distribution
procedures and to make the assignment
process more efficient.
1. True
2. False
1-45. The Joint Federal Travel Regulations
(JFTR) is issued in a total of how many
volumes?
1. One
2. Two
3. Three
4. Four
1-46. What volume of the JFTR applies to all
federal civilian employees?
1. One
2. Two
3. Three
4. Four
1-47. The U.S. Navy Travel Instruction (NTI) is
issued jointly by which of the following
agencies?
1. CNO and Comptroller of the Navy
2. CNO and COMNAVPERSCOM
3. SECNAV and SECDEF
4. CNO and SECNAV
1-48. What manual is issued for the information,
guidance, and compliance of all personnel
in the administration of military pay?
1. DODPM
2. SDSPROMAN
3. MILPERSMAN
4. ENLTRANSMAN
6
1-49. What volume of the SDSPROMAN
provides details for terminal operation and
event reporting?
1. I
2. II
3. III
4. IV
1-50. The Passenger Transportation Manual
consists of nine chapters. As a YN, you
should familiarize yourself with which of
the following chapters?
1. Chapters 1, 2, and 3
2. Chapters 2, 4, and 5
3. Chapters 3, 4, and 5
4. Chapters 4, 5, and 6
1-51. Of the following manuals, which one
provides information on retirement
ceremonies?
1. Naval Military Personnel Manual
2. Enlisted Transfer Manual
3. Social Usage and Protocol Handbook
4. Navy and Marine Corps Awards
Manual
1-52. What authority covers matters pertaining to
decorations and medals?
1. Navy and Marine Corps Awards
Manual
2. Navy Social Usage and Protocol
Handbook
3. Naval Military Personnel Manual
4. U.S. Navy Regulations
1-53. What instruction covers the ordering,
custody, and disposition of Navywide
examinations?
1. BUPERSINST 1430.16
2. SECNAVINST 5210.11
3. OPNAVINST 3120.32
4. OPNAVINST 5510.1
1-54. The Navy Standard Subject Identification
Codes (SSIC) are used for which of the
following purposes?
1. Classifying subjects
2. Identifying directives
3. Setting up filing systems
4. Each of the above
1-55. To which of the following publications
should you refer to find the proper
addressing of mail to an activity of the
Department of the Navy?
1. SSIC
2. SNDL
3. NAVSO
4. DODPM
1-56. Of the following results, which is/are the
goals of the Records Disposal Act?
1. Preservation of records
2. Destruction of temporary records
3. Retirement and transfer of records
4. All of the above
1-57. To what part or table of SECNAVINST
5215.1 should you refer for information on
preparation and maintenance of directives?
1. Part I
2. Part II
3. Table 1
4. Table 2
1-58. Which of the following instructions ensures
that Navy forms provide needed
information effectively, efficiently, and
economically?
1. SECNAVINST 5121.5
2. SECNAVINST 5213.10
3. SECNAVINST 5214.2
4. SECNAVINST 5215.1
7
1-59. Which of the following instructions sets
forth the policy and responsibilities for the
management of information requirements
of the Department of the Navy?
1. SECNAVINST 5212.5
2. SECNAVINST 5213.10
3. SECNAVINST 5214.2
4. SECNAVINST 5215.1
1-60. When new forms and publications are
needed, the supply department prepares a
DOD Single Line Item Requisition System
Document, DD Form 1348.
1. True
2. False
8
ASSIGNMENT 2
Textbook Assignment: "Correspondence/Message System," chapter 3, pages 3-1 through 3-23; "Processing
Correspondence Messages," chapter 4, pages 4-1 through 4-6; and
"Correspondence/Message Files and Disposal," chapter 5, pages 5-1 through 5-10.
2-1. How many types of naval correspondence
are there?
1. Five
2. Six
3. Three
4. Four
2-2. Copies to each "Via" addressee and "Copy
to" addressee can be prepared as an original
document to keep cost down on paper
supplies.
1. True
2. False
2-3. Except for the top of letterhead paper and
the bottom of the last page, what size
margin is required at the top, bottom, and
sides of a naval letter?
1. 1 inch
2. ½ inch
3. ¾ inch
4. 1 ½ inch
2-4. You are preparing a standard Navy letter
and "In reply refer to" is not printed on the
letterhead. In what position should the
sender's symbols start?
1. First line below letterhead, 1 inch from
the right edge
2. First line below letterhead, ½ inch
from the right edge
3. Second line below letterhead, 2 inches
from the right edge
4. Second line below letterhead, 2½
inches from the right edge
2-5. In which of the following circumstances is
it mandatory that a naval letter be
serialized?
1. When the letter is addressed outside
the command
2. When the letter is addressed inside the
command
3. When the letter contains adverse
material
4. When the letter contains classified
material
2-6. On what day should a standard naval letter
be dated?
1. Day the letter is prepared in the rough
2. Day the letter is prepared in the
smooth
3. Day the letter is submitted for
signature
4. Day the letter is signed
2-7. In what position on a standard letter should
a special postal service designation be
typed or stamped?
1. Right margin on the first line below
the date
2. Right margin on the second line below
the date
3. Left margin on the first line below the
date
4. Left margin on the second line below
the date
9
2-8. If a standard letter has two "Via"
addressees, which of the following number
or letter sequences is correct?
1. (a) (b)
2. (1) (2)
3. a. b.
4. 1. 2.
2-9. Usually, the subject line of a letter is about
how many words?
1. 10 words or less
2. 10 words or more
3. 15 words or less
4. 15 words or more
2-10. Of the following letter configurations,
which one is the correct way to identify a
reference in the reference line of a standard
letter?
1. (A)
2. (a)
3. A
4. a
2-11. When an enclosure to a letter is being sent
under separate cover, how should it be
identified in the enclosure line of the letter?
1. SC
2. S.C.
3. (SC)
4. (sep cover)
2-12. The signature page of a letter must contain
at least how many lines of text?
1. One
2. Two
3. Three
4. Four
2-13. What is the proper placement of the
signature information on a standard naval
letter?
1. At the center of the page, two lines
below the last line of text
2. At the center of the page, four lines
below the last line of text
3. Ending flush with the right margin,
two lines below the last line of text
4. Ending flush with the left margin, four
lines below the last line of text
2-14. The page number of a standard letter should
be centered at the top of the page ½ inch
from the top edge.
1. True
2. False
2-15. What type of stationery is used for the first
page of a joint letter?
1. Letterhead of the senior originating
command
2. Plain bond
3. Letterhead of the activity having the
greatest interest in the subject
4. White manifold
2-16. Where are the words JOINT LETTER
typed?
1. One line above the SSIC information,
left margin
2. One line above the SSIC information,
centered
3. One line below the date
4. Two lines below the date
10
2-17. When a multiple-address letter is mailed,
photocopies of the letterhead copy with
signature are authorized.
1. True
2. False
2-18. Same-page endorsements are appropriate in
which of the following conditions?
1. A minimum of three lines of
endorsement text must appear on the
signature page of the basic letter
2. The basic correspondence and the
endorsement must bear the same
security classification
3. The endorsement comments are brief
and few or no record copies are
required
4. The originator has requested a reply
within 3 working days
2-19. What type of paper should be used for a
new-page endorsement?
1. Letterhead
2. Plain bond
3. White tissue
4. Yellow tissue
2-20. A third "Via" addressee's endorsement
should be identified in which of the
following ways?
1. ENDORSEMENT THREE
2. THIRD ENDORSEMENT
3. ENDORSEMENT (3)
4. ENDORSEMENT (C)
2-21. The basic letter contains three references.
You are preparing a first endorsement that
contains a reference not mentioned in the
basic letter. How should you identify the
new reference?
1. (a)
2. (d)
3. (1)
4. (4)
2-22. There are four different formats used for
memorandums.
1. True
2. False
2-23. Of the following types of memoranda,
which one is the most formal?
1. Printed memorandum form
2. Plain-paper memorandum
3. Letterhead memorandum
4. Memorandum for
2-24. On a business letter, the address should
always be placed on the second line below
the date.
1. True
2. False
2-25. In a business letter, which of the following
complimentary closings should be used?
1. Sincerely
2. Yours truly
3. Truly yours
4. Sincerely yours
2-26. The signature block on a business letter
should start how many lines below the
complimentary close?
1. Five
2. Six
3. Three
4. Four
2-27. In a naval message, which of the following
examples is the correct format for a date-
time group?
1. 01FEB28 1030Z
2. 28FEB01 1030Z
3. 281030Z FEB 01
4. 1030Z 28FEB01
11
2-28. A ROUTINE naval message should be
processed within a maximum of how many
hours?
1. 5
2. 6
3. 3
4. 4
2-29. A PRIORITY message should be processed
within a maximum of how many hours?
1. 5
2. 6
3. 3
4. 4
2-30. An IMMEDIATE message should be
processed within a maximum of how many
minutes?
1. 10
2. 20
3. 30
4. 40
2-31. A FLASH message is processed as fast as
possible with an objective of less than how
many minutes?
1. 10
2. 15
3. 20
4. 25
2-32. Of the following special-handling
markings, which one is NOT commonly
found on a naval message?
1. SPECAT
2. LIMDIS
3. PASS To
4. PERSONAL FOR
2-33. Special delivery instructions should follow
which of the following elements of a naval
message?
1. TO
2. FROM
3. SUBJ
4. SSIC
2-34. For clarity, textual material in a message
may be indented a maximum of how many
spaces?
1. 10
2. 15
3. 20
4. 25
2-35. The authorized message addresses of the
various components of the Department of
Defense are located in (a) what publication
and (b) are updated how many times a
year?
1. (a) SNDL, encl (1)
(b) once
2. (a) SNDL, encl (2)
(b) twice
3. (a) MAD
(b) three times
4. (a) MAD
(b) four times
2-36. Who is presumed to be the originator of a
naval message?
1. Commanding officer
2. Administrative officer
3. Executive officer
4. Public affairs officer
2-37. Of the following individuals, which one
actually composes the naval message?
1. Signer
2. Drafter
3. Releaser
4. Originator
12
2-38. When a naval message is prepared, what
individual makes sure the drafter has met
the requirements of NTP-3?
1. Signer
2. Drafter
3. Releaser
4. Originator
2-39. Official mail, when sent through the postal
system, is transmitted in an envelope that is
metered or bears USPS stamps.
1. True
2. False
2-40. When you type the address on envelopes,
you should always make sure you double-
space.
1. True
2. False
2-41. Where should the address be positioned on
an envelope?
1. Centered up and down, 2 inches from
the left edge
2. Centered up and down, 2 inches from
the right edge
3. One-third the length of the envelope
from the left side, and halfway down
from the top
4. One-third the length of the envelope
from the right side, and halfway down
from the top
2-42. When you type an address on an envelope,
what is the maximum number of spaces you
may leave between the last letter of the
state and the first digit of the ZIP Code?
1. Seven
2. Six
3. Five
4. Four
2-43. To have a continuous chain of receipts for a
letter you are mailing, what class/type of
mail service should you use?
1. First class
2. Registered
3. Certified
4. Express
2-44. If you are assigned to the Captain's office,
you will be handling all the official mail for
the ship.
1. True
2. False
2-45. As mail Yeoman, you open an envelope
addressed to your ship. Inside you find an
inner envelope marked SECRET. What
should you do with the inner envelope?
1. Open it and log it in the classified mail
log
2. Deliver it unopened to the executive
officer
3. Deliver it unopened to the security
manager
4. Deliver it unopened to the
commanding officer
2-46. Action correspondence may be tracked by
correspondence control slips.
1. True
2. False
2-47. After the required blocks on a
correspondence control slip are filled in
you should then pass it to whom?
1. Mail Yeoman
2. Office supervisor
3. Executive officer
4. Postal clerk
13
2-48. What is the purpose of the second sorting
of incoming official mail?
1. To separate congressional mail from
priority mail
2. To separate routine mail from
nonroutine mail
3. To determine who is receiving official
4. To facilitate logging of all incoming
2-49. A mail control form may be used for which
of the following additional purposes?
1. As a mail log
2. As a follow-up record
3. As a cross-reference sheet
4. Each of the above
2-50. When a number of letters are addressed to
the same activity, they should be sent in the
same envelope.
1. True
2. False
2-51. What is the quickest form of formal written
communications in the Navy?
1. E-mail
2. Message
3. Memorandum
4. Naval letter
2-52. In regard to centralized and decentralized
files, you would most likely keep what type
(a) on a destroyer and (b) at a large shore
command?
1. (a) Centralized
(b) decentralized
2. (a) Decentralized
(b) centralized
3. (a) Centralized
(b) centralized
4. (a) Decentralized
(b) decentralized
2-53. Control and responsibility for filing
systems are assigned to one or two YNs.
1. True
2. False
2-54. In decentralized filing systems, should
uniform filing practices be followed? If so,
who is responsible?
1. Yes; the office supervisor
2. Yes; the YN who opens the mail
3. Yes; the division leading chief
4. No
2-55. Of the following size documents, which
one does NOT require a specialized file
cabinet?
1. 8½ x 11
2. 10½ x 13
3. 11 x 14
4. 12 x 14
2-56. Standard file folders are available in a total
of how many sizes?
1. One
2. Two
3. Three
4. Four
2-57. Of the following types of folders, which
one spaces the labels across the drawer so
that a label will not be hidden by the folder
in front of it?
1. One cut
2. Straight cut
3. One-third cut
4. Two-thirds cut
14
2-58. A Navy letter carries a subject
identification number of 8510. What is the
major subject group of this letter?
1. Logistics
2. General material
3. Ordnance material
4. Operations and readiness
2-59. Of the following subject identification
codes, which one pertains to civilian
personnel?
1. 5000
2. 8000
3. 10000
4. 12000
2-60. A document should be cross-referenced
under which of the following
circumstances?
1. When it contains more than one
subject
2. When two or more subject codes are
used within the document
3. When enclosures are separated from
the basic correspondence
4. Each of the above
2-61. If a document is to be removed from a file,
it must be accounted for, and the identity of
the person holding it must be recorded.
1. True
2. False
2-62. On a chargeout record, you should show
which of the following information?
1. Identification of the material removed
2. Name and location of the person
borrowing the material
3. Date that the material was removed
4. All of the above
2-63. When files are not efficiently managed, it
can result in lost time and reduced
effectiveness.
1. True
2. False
2-64. Messages are filed in which of the
following ways?
1. By SSIC
2. By subject
3. By originator
4. Numerically in DTG order
2-65. Messages are usually destroyed how many
days after the release date?
1. 30
2. 45
3. 60
4. 90
2-66. Because of their importance, what authority
governs the disposition of your files?
1. Congress
2. Secretary of Defense
3. Secretary of the Navy
4. Chief of Naval Operations
2-67. Instructions that schedule the destruction of
Navy records are issued by whom?
1. Secretary of Defense
2. Secretary of the Navy
3. Chief of Naval Operations
4. Commander, Naval Personnel
Command
2-68. What term identifies all written material,
documents, publications, charts, and
messages addressed to or sent from a
command?
1. Official record
2. Official journal
3. Official register
4. Official correspondence
15
2-69. What authority governs the general
procedures pertaining to disposal of federal
government records?
1. Congress
2. National Archives
3. Secretary of the Navy
4. General Services Administration
2-70. What article of Navy Regulations prohibits
withdrawal or destruction of official
records without proper authority?
1. 1126
2. 1127
3. 1128
4. 1129
2-71. While at sea, unclassified and classified
records should be destroyed by burning.
1. True
2. False
2-72. What form is used to forward retention
material to a federal records center?
1. Chargeout record
2. Transmittal sheet
3. Cross-reference sheet
4. Records transmittal and receipt
16
ASSIGNMENT 3
Textbook Assignment: "Directives Issuance System," chapter 6, pages 6-1 through 6-8; "Reports and Forms
Management Programs," chapter 7, pages 7-1 through 7-8.
3-1. What instruction covers the Navy's
Directives Issuance System?
1. SECNAVINST 5213.1
2. SECNAVINST 5214.1
3. SECNAVINST 5215.1
4. SECNAVINST 5216.1
3-2. An instruction, notice, or change transmittal
is best described by which of the following
terms?
1. Order
2. Directive
3. Formal letter
4. Formal memorandum
3-3. Information that is essential to the effective
administration or operation of activities can
best be described by which of the following
terms?
1. Notice
2. Directive
3. Instruction
4. Change transmittal
3-4. An instruction remains in effect until
superseded or otherwise cancelled by
whom?
1. The drafter
2. The originator
3. The directives control point
4. The directives control officer
3-5. Usually, a notice will remain in effect for
how long?
1. Less than 3 months, but not longer
than 6 months
2. Less than 6 months, but not longer
than 12 months
3. Less than 9 months, but not longer
than 18 months
4. Less than 12 months, but not longer
than 18 months
3-6. On a notice, cancellation determinations are
indicated at the top right corner in which of
the following ways?
1. Canc:
2. Canc FRP:
3. Canc frp:
4. CANC FRP:
3-7. A change transmittal describes the nature of
the changes and gives directions for making
them.
1. True
2. False
3-8. Which of the following means should be
used to verify the completeness and
accuracy of a master set of instructions?
1. Checklist
2. Distribution list
3. Cross-reference sheet
4. Weekly transmittal sheet
17
3-9. A directive issued by one authority in
conjunction with one or more other
authorities is known by which of the
following terms?
1. Multiple addressee directive
2. Message-type directive
3. Letter-type directive
4. Joint directive
3-10. A page change to an instruction or notice is
issued by which of the following means?
1. Revision
2. Change transmittal
3. Weekly transmittal sheet
4. Special distribution list
3-11. What authority makes the initial
distribution of directives to all ships and
stations?
1. Secretary of the Navy
2. Chief of Naval Operations
3. Navy Publications and Printing
Service
4. Naval Personnel Command
3-12. What authority administers the Directives
Issuance System?
1. Secretary of the Navy
2. Chief of Naval Operations
3. Bureau of Naval Personnel
4. Naval Personnel Command
3-13. The official by whose authority and under
whose title a directive is issued is known as
the
1. drafter
2. issuing authority
3. commanding officer
4. directives control officer
3-14. How often should an issuing authority
conduct a review of organizational
directives?
1. Monthly
2. Quarterly
3. Semiannually
4. Annually
3-15. Which of the following is a function of a
command directives control point?
1. Analyze directives
2. Evaluate the system's operations
3. Make recommendations or
improvements
4. Each of the above
3-16. Aboard ship, who is usually the directives
control point?
1. Executive officer
2. Personnel officer
3. Administrative officer
4. Ship's secretary
3-17. At a shore activity, who is usually the
directives control point?
1. Commanding officer
2. Executive officer
3. Administrative officer
4. Administrative supervisor
3-18. For classified directives, the control point
maintains locator cross-reference sheets.
1. True
2. False
3-19. Official case files are filed in which of the
following ways?
1. By date
2. By SSIC
3. By subject
4. By originator code
18
3-20. Of the following items, which one is NOT
placed in the official case folder for a
directive?
1. Signature copy
2. Double-spaced rough
3. Cross-reference sheet
4. Revision of the basic instruction
3-21. Instructions received by your command
should be filed in what order?
1. Issuing authority, consecutive number,
and SSIC
2. Consecutive number, SSIC, and
issuing authority
3. SSIC, issuing authority, and
consecutive number
4. SSIC, consecutive number, and issuing
authority
3-22. An instruction that has been temporarily
loaned out should usually be returned
within how many days?
1. 5
2. 7
3. 3
4. 10
3-23. Of the following notations, which one
should be used to enter a change on the first
page of a directive?
1. Change 1
2. Ch: One
3. CH: 1
4. Ch-1
3-24. Which of the following instructions gives
direction for an effective reports
management program?
1. SECNAVINST 5213.2
2. SECNAVINST 5214.2
3. SECNAVINST 5215.2
4. SECNAVINST 5216.2
3-25. A single office with each Navy command
should be designated as the reports control
point.
1. True
2. False
3-26. At a shore command, who is normally the
reports control manager?
1. Administrative officer
2. Executive assistant
3. Executive officer
4. Senior Yeoman
3-27. A report should be reviewed by the report
originator 30 days before the fourth
anniversary of the issuance date of the
report.
1. True
2. False
3-28. Reports not approved for extension are
automatically cancelled on the third
anniversary date.
1. True
2. False
3-29. If an information requirement should be
cancelled, what method is used to cancel
the requirement?
1. Notice transmittal
2. Change transmittal
3. Instruction format
4. Standard letter format
19
3-30. If an information requirement remains
valid, a change transmittal (a) should be
submitted within how many days before the
expiration date and (b) should extend the
approved period for a maximum of how
many years?
1. (a) 30 (b) 3
2. (a) 30 (b) 5
3. (a) 60 (b) 3
4. (a) 60 (b) 5
3-31. Which of the following timing and
frequency requirements for reports should
be used when an event occurs or a
condition changes?
1. As-required report
2. Situation report
3. Recurring report
4. One-time report
3-32. Information that is collected, stored,
retrieved, and submitted when requested
defines what type of report?
1. As-required report
2. Status report
3. One-time report
4. Recurring report
3-33. A report that conveys essentially the same
type of information at prescribed intervals
is known as what type of report?
1. Status report
2. Revised report
3. Recurring report
4. As-required report
3-34. A report that is not subject to
documentation and symbolization
procedures is known as what type of
report?
1. Exempt report
2. Internal report
3. Licensed report
4. Computer-generated report
3-35. Who maintains the inventory of recurring
reports at an activity?
1. Forms manager
2. Reports control manager
3. Administrative assistant
4. Directives control officer
3-36. An annual review of a report may be
combined with the annual review of the
command directive used as the basis for the
report.
1. True
2. False
3-37. To ensure obsolete files are removed from
case files, reports should be routed through
whom?
1. Forms manager
2. Security manager
3. Ship's secretary
4. Senior Yeoman
3-38. How often should the reports control
officer publish and distribute a revised list
of current and cancelled reports?
1. Monthly
2. Quarterly
3. Semiannually
4. Annually
3-39. To be an effective aid, how often should a
report tickler file be checked?
1. Daily
2. Weekly
3. Monthly
4. Quarterly
20
3-40. Forms are vital to the effective
management of your command because
they provide information for which of the
following purposes?
1. Formulating policy
2. Controlling operations
3. Movement of materials
4. Each of the above
3-41. Who develops and coordinates the overall
forms management program within the
Navy?
1. Secretary of the Navy
2. Chief of Naval Operations
3. Secretary of Defense
4. Chief of Naval Personnel
3-42. Each command is responsible for
establishing and maintaining a forms-
management program.
1. True
2. False
3-43. What is the first step in establishing a
forms-management system within an
activity?
1. Design new forms
2. Cancel all forms in use
3. Review forms for duplication
4. Issue a directive that states the
objective of the forms management
function
3-44. The number and complexity of the forms
and procedures in an activity should have
no bearing on the number of personnel
assigned to the forms management
function.
1. True
2. False
3-45. A forms management office should take
which of the following actions as a first
step in the operation of a forms
management office?
1. Design new forms
2. Collect copies of all forms
3. Review forms for duplication
4. Cancel all local forms in use
3-46. Which of the following steps apply to the
continuing effort to keep forms and
procedures up-to-date?
1. Obtain and analyze the facts
2. Evaluate and develop solutions
3. Install solutions and follow up
4. All of the above
3-47. When the forms control file is established,
what information should be written on the
copies of the forms that have been
collected?
1. Name of the person who designed the
form
2. Name of the office using the form and
the estimated annual usage
3. How often the form is used
4. How many copies are prepared
3-48. Which of the following items should be
included on the label of a local form folder?
1. Title of form
2. Consecutive number
3. Originator's abbreviation
4. All of the above
3-49. Your efforts to consolidate related
information should always result in the use
of one single form to serve a variety of
purposes or functions.
1. True
2. False
21
3-50. When a form becomes obsolete or is
replaced, what should be the disposition of
the form folder?
1. Destroy it because it has served its
purpose
2. Transfer it to a separate file, with the
reason for discontinuation noted
3. File it in the folder with the form that
replaced it
4. Leave it in the SSIC file
22
ASSIGNMENT 4
Textbook Assignment: "Security," chapter 8, pages 8-1 through 8-9; "Legal," chapter 9, pages 9-1 through
9-14.
4-1. The initial determination of a person's
loyalty, reliability, and trustworthiness is
based on what investigation or check?
1. SSBI
2. NAC
3. SBI
4. PSI
4-2. In the DON Personnel Security Program,
there is/are a total of what number of
personnel security investigation categories?
1. 1
2. 2
3. 6
4. 8
4-3. Which of the following agencies conducts
the NAC?
1. OPNAV
2. DSS
3. DCII
4. FBI
4-4. A person who enters military service
undergoes which of the following agency
checks?
1. SSBI
2. PR
3. NAC
4. ENTNAC
4-5. Which of the following documents is/are
required to process an NAC?
1. Questionnaire for Public Trust
Positions (SF 85P) only
2. Applicant Fingerprint Card (FD 258)
only
3. Both 1 and 2 above
4. Request for Personnel Security
Investigation (DD 1879)
4-6. Which of the following checks is NOT
made during a standard SSBI?
1. NAC of subject's spouse
2. Subject interview
3. Inquiries of local agencies
4. Employment and credit history
4-7. With reference to an SSBI, no investigation
should extend further back than the
subject's 18th birthday.
1. True
2. False
4-8. A single-scope background investigation
(SSBI) is conducted only when specifically
required by whom?
1. COMNAVPERSCOM
2. CHNAVPERS
3. SECNAV
4. CNO
4-9. A periodic reinvestigation (PR) determines
a subject's continued eligibility for access
to classified information.
1. True
2. False
23
4-10. When should a PR be initiated?
1. 4.5 years from completion of the last
investigation
2. 5 years from completion of last
investigation
3. Every 3 years
4. Every 4 years
4-11. Which of the following checks may be used
as the investigative basis for a Top Secret
clearance?
1. PSI
2. PR only
3. SSBI only
4. PR or SSBI
4-12. The investigative requirements for the
personnel reliability program (PRP) is
based on which of the following factors of
the position?
1. Knowledge
2. Location
3. Paygrade
4. Sensitivity
4-13. What authority is authorized to grant, deny,
or revoke security clearances for all
Department of the Navy personnel?
1. OPNAV
2. SECNAV
3. BUPERS
4. DON CAF
4-14. Of the following methods that could be
used to notify a command of a favorable
security clearance, which one should DON
CAF NOT use?
1. Letter
2. Message
3. Secure telephone
4. Manpower Management System
4-15. Normally, interim clearances are granted
for a maximum of how many days?
1. 90
2. 120
3. 180
4. 240
4-16. Which of the following forms is used to
request security determinations from DON
CAF?
1. Personnel Security Action Request
2. Record of Investigation, Clearance,
and Access
3. Classified Information Nondisclosure
Agreement
4. Request for Personnel Security
Investigation
4-17. Which of the following forms is used to
record a clearance granted by DON CAF?
1. OPNAV 5510/10
2. OPNAV 5520/20
3. OPNAV 5510/20
4. OPNAV 5520/30
4-18. Of the following individuals, which one is
NOT authorized to witness the execution of
the Classified Information Nondisclosure
Agreement?
1. Commanding officer
2. Executive officer
3. Security manager
4. Leading Yeoman
4-19. Which of the following is NOT a category
of classification?
1. For Official Use Only
2. Confidential
3. Top Secret
4. Secret
24
4-20. The disclosure of information that could
cause exceptionally grave damage to
national security should carry what
classification?
1. Secret
2. Top Secret
3. Confidential
4. Guarded
4-21. The disclosure of information that could
cause serious damage to national security
should carry what classification?
1. Secret
2. Top Secret
3. Confidential
4. Sensitive
4-22. The disclosure of information that could
cause identifiable damage to national
security should carry what classification?
1. Secret
2. Top Secret
3. Confidential
4. Interim
4-23. Who is responsible for controlling the
dissemination of classified material within
the command?
1. Command security manager
2. Administrative officer
3. Executive officer
4. Commanding officer
4-24. Who is delegated the responsibility to
ensure personnel are instructed on
prevention of unauthorized disclosure of
classified information?
1. Command security manager
2. Administrative officer
3. Commanding officer
4. Executive officer
4-25. Top Secret documents cannot be
reproduced without the permission of
which of the following authorities?
1. Department head
2. Security manager
3. Commanding officer
4. Issuing or higher authority
4-26. After a Top Secret document has been
transferred, downgraded, or destroyed, the
record of disclosure should be maintained
for how many years?
1. 1
2. 2
3. 3
4. 5
4-27. There is no requirement to maintain records
of receipts, distribution, or disposition on
which of the following types of classified
material?
1. Secret
2. Top Secret
3. Confidential
4-28. Which of the following instructions
prescribes that classified correspondence be
serially numbered by the originator for each
calendar year?
1. SECNAVINST 5215.1
2. SECNAVINST 5216.5
3. OPNAVINST 5215.1
4. OPNAVINST 5216.5
4-29. At least how many times must the upper
and lower sections of a fabric typewriter
ribbon be cycled before it can be treated as
unclassified?
1. Five
2. Seven
3. Three
4. Nine
25
4-30. A system of security checks at the close of
each working day must be instituted to
make sure that classified material held by a
command is properly protected.
1. True
2. False
4-31. Which of the following classes of classified
material should not be mailed?
1. Secret
2. Top Secret
3. Confidential
4. Guarded
4-32. Receipts for classified material should be
maintained for a minimum of how many
years?
1. 1
2. 2
3. 3
4. 4
4-33. Whenever classified material is transmitted,
it should be enclosed in two opaque, sealed
envelopes.
1. True
2. False
4-34. How many officials are required to witness
the destruction of Top Secret and Secret
material?
1. One
2. Two
3. Three
4. Four
4-35. The basic laws of NJP may be found in
what section of the Manual for Courts-
Martial?
1. Part I
2. Part II
3. Part III
4. Part V
4-36. Which of the following statements is
correct concerning NJP?
1. It is a forum for command members to
air grievances
2. The legal protection is less extensive
than it is for nonpunitive measures
3. It provides commanders with a means
for promoting positive behavior
changes
4. All NJP authority must be delegated
by SECNAV
4-37. No officer may limit the Article 15
authority of a subordinate commander
without the specific approval of what
official?
1. CNO
2. SECDEF
3. SECNAV
4. COMNAVPERSCOM
4-38. May Reserve personnel recalled to active
duty for imposition of NJP receive
punishment involving restraint? If so,
under what circumstances?
1. Yes; when the CO of the Reserve
center approves the recall
2. Yes; when SECNAV approves the
recall
3. Yes; when recalled to active duty for a
period longer than the period of
restraint
4. No
4-39. At what time does a member's right to
refuse the imposition of NJP terminate?
1. When he or she signs the report chit
accepting mast
2. When he or she signs the rights
acknowledgment form before the mast
3. When he or she appears before the CO
4. Up until the punishment is announced
26
4-40. The term "minor offense" means
misconduct not more serious than that
usually handled at which of the following
forums?
1. Summary court-martial
2. Special court-martial
3. General court-martial
4. Trial court-martial
4-41. Who makes the final determination as to
whether or not an offense is considered
minor?
1. Legal officer
2. Senior resident, NCIS
3. Executive officer
4. Commanding officer
4-42. The Report and Disposition of Offense(s),
NAVPERS Form 1626/7, should be
processed in the manner prescribed on the
form itself.
1. True
2. False
4-43. The NAVPERS Form 1626/7 serves all
EXCEPT which of the following functions?
1. Records premast restraint
2. Serves as a preliminary inquiry report
3. Records that appeal rights have been
explained to the accused
4. Includes all premast advice that must
be given to the accused
4-44. In what order should witnesses be listed on
the NAVPERS Form 1626/7?
1. Civilian witnesses, then military
witnesses in order of seniority
2. Military witnesses, then civilian
witnesses in alphabetical order
3. Military witnesses by seniority, then
civilian witnesses
4. Military and civilian witnesses in the
order of involvement in the offense
4-45. If an accused refuses to sign the section of
the NAVPERS Form 1626/7 that
acknowledges the accusation(s) against him
or her, what action should be taken?
1. Any of the witnesses listed on the form
may sign attesting to that fact
2. The person informing the accused of
the accusations should sign attesting to
that fact
3. The accused should be given a direct
order to sign the form
4. The form is forwarded without the
accused's signature and no notations
are made
4-46. What appendix of the JAGMAN illustrates
the notification and election of rights that
should be used when an accused is
embarked in a vessel?
1. A-1-a
2. A-1-b
3. A-1-c
4. A-1-d
4-47. The XO may screen a case either by
holding an informal hearing or imposing
punishment after reviewing the report chit
and the record of the accused.
1. True
2. False
4-48. The results of NJP may be published in the
plan of the day not later than how many
months after the imposition of NJP?
1. 1
2. 2
3. 3
4. 6
27
4-49. Which of the following actions may be
taken by a CO at mast?
1. Referral to an Article 32 pretrial
investigation
2. Dismissal of the case with a warning
3. Postponement of the action pending
further investigation
4. Each of the above
4-50. Regardless of the rank of an OIC, his or her
NJP power is limited to that of a CO in
what range of paygrades?
1. W1 to O2
2. O1 to O2 only
3. O2 to O3 only
4. O1 to O3
4-51. Which of the following NJP punishments
may be awarded to an E-3 enlisted accused
by an OIC?
1. Correctional custody for 14 days
2. Correctional custody for 7 days
3. Restriction for 15 days
4. Forfeiture of one-half of one month's
pay for 1 month
4-52. What is the maximum number of specific
punishments that may be imposed at mast?
1. Five
2. Six
3. Seven
4. Eight
4-53. Procedures for issuing punitive letters may
be found in which of the following
publications?
1. MCM
2. JAGMAN
3. MILPERSMAN
4. U.S. Navy Regulations, 1990
4-54. Which of the following statements is
correct concerning extra duties?
1. Guard duty may not be assigned as
extra duty
2. Extra duties cannot be demeaning to
the accused's rank or position
3. Extra duties should not extend beyond
2 hours per day
4. Each of the above
4-55. An appeal to NJP must be submitted in
writing within how many days of the
imposition of NJP?
1. 5
2. 7
3. 10
4. 14
4-56. Which of the following types of NJP
hearings should be entered in the unit
punishment book?
1. Only NJP hearings that refer cases to
court-martial
2. Only NJP hearings that impose
punishment that affects pay
3. Only NJP hearings that impose
punishment
4. All NJP hearings
28
ASSIGNMENT 5
Textbook Assignment: "Legal," chapter 9, continued, pages 9-14 through 9-19; "Awards," chapter 10, pages
10-1 through 10-3; "Officer Distribution Control Report (ODCR)," chapter 11,
pages 11-1 through 11-6; "Officer Service Records," chapter 12, pages 12-1 through
12-3; "Travel, Leave Procedures, and Pay and Allowances," chapter 13, pages 13-1
through 13-6; "Technical Administration," chapter 14, pages 14-1 through 14-2.
5-1. The regulations that govern administrative
investigations are found in what
publication?
1. MCM
2. SORM
3. JAGMAN
4. MILPERSMAN
5-2. An administrative fact-finding body
searches out, develops, assembles,
analyzes, and records all available
information about the matter under
investigation.
1. True
2. False
5-3. If an incident occurs at a place
geographically distant from a command, a
request for another command to convene
the investigation would be submitted to
what individual?
1. General court-martial convening
authority
2. Common superior of both commands
3. Area coordinator
4. CO of command requested to convene
investigation
5-4. For which of the following events would a
command investigation NOT be
appropriate?
1. Aircraft accidents
2. Damage to government quarters
3. Groundings
4. Floodings
5-5. Which type of investigation must be
conducted under the direction and
supervision of a judge advocate?
1. Litigation report
2. Command investigation
3. Preliminary inquiry
4. Board of inquiry
5-6. Of the following terms, which does NOT
describe a major incident?
1. Multiple deaths
2. Substantial property loss
3. Significant departure from leadership
4. Minor harm to environment
5-7. A court of inquiry consists of a minimum
of how many commissioned officers?
1. Six
2. Five
3. Four
4. Three
5-8. During which of the following types of
investigations is testimony taken under oath
and all proceedings recorded?
1. Command investigations
2. Courts of inquiry
3. Litigation reports
4. Boards of inquiry
29
5-9. Of the following personnel, who may order
a command investigation?
1. Executive officer only
2. Aide to a flag officer only
3. Judge advocate only
4. Any officer in the command
5-10. An appointing order should be in which of
the following forms?
1. Official letter only
2. Official letter addressed to the JAG
3. Official letter addressed to the IO
4. Official letter addressed to the
department head
5-11. What must be provided if a service member
is asked to provide his or her social security
number for an investigation?
1. Privacy Act statement
2. Formal request from JAG
3. Formal request from IO
4. Formal request from the CA
5-12. The appointing order directs the completion
of the IO's report within a maximum of
how many days?
1. 14
2. 21
3. 30
4. 45
5-13. The CA has a maximum of how many days
to review a death investigation?
1. 10
2. 15
3. 20
4. 30
5-14. Additional instruction and guidance on
safety investigations can be found in which
of the following directives?
1. OPNAVINST 5100.14
2. OPNAVINST 5100.12
3. OPNAVINST 3750.6
4. OPNAVINST 5112.6
5-15. Which of the following items is NOT
required in every administrative
investigation?
1. Preliminary statement
2. Findings of fact
3. Recommendations
4. Opinions
5-16. Of the following items, which one should
NOT be included in a preliminary
statement?
1. Nature of the investigation
2. Difficulties encountered
3. Failure to advise individuals of their
rights
4. Synopsis of facts, recommendations,
or opinions
5-17. What is the first enclosure in an
investigative report?
1. Opinions
2. Recommendations
3. Findings of fact
4. Appointing order
5-18. Upon completion of an investigation, the
IO should submit his/her investigation to
whom?
1. CA
2. JAG
3. TYCOM
4. OPNAV
30
5-19. Award recommendations are prepared
using which of the following instructions?
1. OPNAVINST 1560.1
2. OPNAVINST 1650.1
3. SECNAVINST 1560.1
4. SECNAVINST 1650.1
5-20. Awards recognizing specific acts should be
given within 60 days after the act occurred.
1. True
2. False
5-21. Per NAVADMIN 265/00, the number of
command-authorized Navy and Marine
Corps Achievement Medals is limited by
which, if any, of the following factors?
1. There are no limitations on the number
of awards issued by the command
2. The total number of billets in the
command
3. The number of officers assigned to the
command
4. The number of enlisted assigned to the
command
5-22. An award recommendation should be
prepared on which of the following
OPNAV forms?
1. 1650/2
2. 1650/3
3. 1650/4
4. 1650/5
5-23. A proposed non-combat citation is limited
to a total of how many typewritten lines?
1. 20
2. 22
3. 24
4. 25
5-24. The normal processing time for an award
recommendation should be what maximum
number of days?
1. 15
2. 30
3. 60
4. 120
5-25. What is the intent behind letters of
appreciation and commendation?
1. To promote morale
2. To promote harmony
3. To reward individuals only
4. To accelerate advancement only
5-26. Information pertaining to the Officer
Distribution Control Report (ODCR) is
contained in which of the following
instructions?
1. BUPERSINST 1301.1
2. BUPERSINST 1401.2
3. BUPERSINST 1401.30
4. BUPERSINST 1301.40
5-27. An ODCR is prepared for each naval
command by which of the following
activities?
1. EPMAC
2. MAPTIS
3. NAVFINCEN
4. COMNAVPERSCOM
5-28. How often is the ODCR prepared?
1. Monthly
2. Quarterly
3. Semiannually
4. Annually
31
5-29. When pen changes to an ODCR are made,
in what part of the report should you place
the date the correction was made?
1. Left margin
2. Right margin
3. Over the corrected data
4. Under the corrected data
5-30. A description of an officer's primary duties
can be found in what data element of an
ODCR?
1. Desk code
2. Billet title
3. Activity mission code
4. Billet phase indicator
5-31. The security code data element on an
officer's ODCR consists of all EXCEPT
which of the following information?
1. Member's pay entry base date
2. Member's security clearance eligibility
3. Member's current security clearance
authority
4. Completion date of member's last
investigation
5-32. An officer's name should not exceed a total
of how many characters on an ODCR,
including spaces?
1. 20
2. 21
3. 22
4. 23
5-33. What data element of an ODCR is indicated
by an asterisk following the officer's name?
1. PAD
2. OSAM
3. DESIG
4. ASED/SSED
5-34. Which data element of an ODCR reflects
an officer's current operational flying
status?
1. MOF
2. ACD
3. ABI
4. AUG
5-35. The permanent officer record in microfiche
format is maintained by which of the
following activities?
1. COMNAVPERSCOM
2. NAVPERS
3. CHNAVPERS
4. COMNAVCRUITCOM
5-36. On officer record microfiches, which fiche
numbers contain, respectively, (a) reserve
status, and (b) privileged information?
1. (a) 2 (b) 4
2. (a) 3 (b) 4
3. (a) 2 (b) 5
4. (a) 3 (5) 5
5-37. Information rightly placed in the official
record of an officer may not be removed
except by which of the following
authorities?
1. OPNAV
2. COMNAVPERSCOM
3. SECNAV
4. CHNAVPERS
5-38. The acceptance and oath of office is filed
on the right side of an officer's service
record.
1. True
2. False
32
5-39. The certificate of personnel security
investigation, clearance and access is filed
on the left side of an officer's service
record.
1. True
2. False
5-40. What authority contains detailed
information on officer service records?
1. SORM
2. SDSPROMAN
3. MILPERSMAN
4. OFFTRANSMAN
5-41. When an individual travels to a command
or geographic area that is not the
individual's permanent duty station, what
official Navy acronym should be used?
1. TEMDUINS
2. TEMADD
3. TAD
4. TDY
5-42. What NAVPERS form is used to prepare
TEMADD travel orders?
1. 1320/12
2. 1320/14
3. 1320/16
4. 1320/18
5-43. The complete accounting classification
code and the standard document number
and its construction can be found in which
of the following manuals?
1. SDSPROMAN
2. MILPERSMAN
3. OFFTRANSMAN
4. ENLTRANSMAN
5-44. Which of the following DD forms is used
to liquidate a travel claim?
1. 1351-1
2. 1351-2
3. 1351-3
4. 1351-4
5-45. Entries for mode of travel and reason for
stops can be found in what block(s) on the
reverse side of a travel voucher?
1. Block 25a only
2. Block 25b only
3. Both blocks 25a and 25b
4. Block 25c
5-46. All members of the Navy should be
encouraged to use their full leave
entitlement each year.
1. True
2. False
5-47. For which of the following time periods are
members NOT authorized to earn leave?
1. Active duty for less than 30 days
2. Active duty for training, with pay, for
less than 30 days
3. Lost time
4. Each of the above
5-48. Navy members are advised of their leave
balance each month by which of the
following methods?
1. Memoranda prepared by command
personnel officers
2. Memoranda prepared by command
disbursing officers
3. Leave and earnings statements
prepared by the Navy Finance Center
4. Leave lists prepared by
COMNAVPERSCOM
33
5-49. Of the following types of leave, which one
is NOT charged against a member's leave
entitlement?
1. Earned
2. Advance
3. Emergency
4. Convalescent
5-50. Ordinary leave is requested and authorized
on which of the following forms?
1. NAVCOMPT Form 3065
2. NAVCOMPT Form 3067
3. DD Form 1624
4. DD Form 398
5-51. Which of the following MILPERSMAN
articles gives detailed procedures for
personnel to follow when they request,
depart on, and return from leave?
1. 1040-200
2. 1050-100
3. 1050-250
4. 1060-100
5-52. Military pay is broken down into a total of
three parts. What are they?
1. Basic, travel, and combat
2. Basic, incentive, and travel
3. Basic, special, and incentive
4. Basic, combat, and proficiency
5-53. What term identifies an amount of money
paid to a member to provide for food,
quarters, or services when they are not
provided by the Navy?
1. Allowance
2. Incentive
3. Special pay
4. Miscellaneous pay
5-54. Expenses incurred as a result of temporary
or permanent moves may fall into which of
the following travel allowance categories?
1. Miscellaneous
2. Transportation
3. Lodging and food
4. Each of the above
5-55. Your supervisor may ask you to prepare
which of the following documents in a
"rough" form?
1. Inspection results
2. School quota requests
3. Welcome aboard letters
4. Each of the above
5-56. Which of the following is the only authority
that should be used in the preparation of
officer fitness reports?
1. NAVMILPERSMAN
2. Navy Regulations
3. BUPERSINST 1610.10
4. BUPERSINST 1616.9
5-57. Officer fitness reports form a primary basis
for selecting officers for advanced training,
duty assignment, promotion, and command.
1. True
2. False
5-58. Reporting seniors should retain copies of
FITREPs for at least how many years?
1. 5
2. 2
3. 3
4. 4
34
5-59. Which of the following is the only authority
that should be used in the preparation of
enlisted evaluations?
1. BUPERSINST 1611.17
2. BUPERSINST 1610.10
3. Navy Regulations
4. NAVMILPERSMAN
5-60. Which of the following recommendations is
true regarding routine office machine
maintenance?
1. Know how to give routine care to any
machine you operate
2. Acquaint yourself with equipment
instruction manuals
3. Understand other kinds of local
maintenance policy
4. Each of the above